US4672537A - Data error detection and device controller failure detection in an input/output system - Google Patents

Data error detection and device controller failure detection in an input/output system Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US4672537A
US4672537A US06/727,614 US72761485A US4672537A US 4672537 A US4672537 A US 4672537A US 72761485 A US72761485 A US 72761485A US 4672537 A US4672537 A US 4672537A
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
bus
data
memory
device controller
map
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Expired - Lifetime
Application number
US06/727,614
Inventor
James A. Katzman
Joel F. Bartlett
Richard M. Bixler
William H. Davidow
John A. Despotakis
Peter J. Graziano
Michael D. Green
David A. Greig
Steven J. Hayashi
David R. Mackie
Dennis L. McEvoy
James G. Treybig
Steven W. Wierenga
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Tandem Computers Inc
Original Assignee
Tandem Computers Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Tandem Computers Inc filed Critical Tandem Computers Inc
Priority to US06/727,614 priority Critical patent/US4672537A/en
Priority to US07/052,095 priority patent/US4807116A/en
Application granted granted Critical
Publication of US4672537A publication Critical patent/US4672537A/en
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical
Expired - Lifetime legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F7/00Methods or arrangements for processing data by operating upon the order or content of the data handled
    • G06F7/76Arrangements for rearranging, permuting or selecting data according to predetermined rules, independently of the content of the data
    • G06F7/78Arrangements for rearranging, permuting or selecting data according to predetermined rules, independently of the content of the data for changing the order of data flow, e.g. matrix transposition or LIFO buffers; Overflow or underflow handling therefor
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/07Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
    • G06F11/08Error detection or correction by redundancy in data representation, e.g. by using checking codes
    • G06F11/10Adding special bits or symbols to the coded information, e.g. parity check, casting out 9's or 11's
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/07Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
    • G06F11/08Error detection or correction by redundancy in data representation, e.g. by using checking codes
    • G06F11/10Adding special bits or symbols to the coded information, e.g. parity check, casting out 9's or 11's
    • G06F11/1008Adding special bits or symbols to the coded information, e.g. parity check, casting out 9's or 11's in individual solid state devices
    • G06F11/1044Adding special bits or symbols to the coded information, e.g. parity check, casting out 9's or 11's in individual solid state devices with specific ECC/EDC distribution
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/07Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
    • G06F11/16Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware
    • G06F11/20Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements
    • G06F11/2002Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements where interconnections or communication control functionality are redundant
    • G06F11/2007Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements where interconnections or communication control functionality are redundant using redundant communication media
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/07Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
    • G06F11/16Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware
    • G06F11/20Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements
    • G06F11/2015Redundant power supplies
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/07Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
    • G06F11/16Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware
    • G06F11/20Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements
    • G06F11/202Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements where processing functionality is redundant
    • G06F11/2023Failover techniques
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/07Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
    • G06F11/16Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware
    • G06F11/20Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements
    • G06F11/202Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements where processing functionality is redundant
    • G06F11/2035Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements where processing functionality is redundant without idle spare hardware
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/07Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
    • G06F11/16Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware
    • G06F11/20Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements
    • G06F11/202Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements where processing functionality is redundant
    • G06F11/2043Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements where processing functionality is redundant where the redundant components share a common memory address space
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F11/00Error detection; Error correction; Monitoring
    • G06F11/07Responding to the occurrence of a fault, e.g. fault tolerance
    • G06F11/16Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware
    • G06F11/20Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements
    • G06F11/2097Error detection or correction of the data by redundancy in hardware using active fault-masking, e.g. by switching out faulty elements or by switching in spare elements maintaining the standby controller/processing unit updated
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F12/00Accessing, addressing or allocating within memory systems or architectures
    • G06F12/02Addressing or allocation; Relocation
    • G06F12/08Addressing or allocation; Relocation in hierarchically structured memory systems, e.g. virtual memory systems
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F12/00Accessing, addressing or allocating within memory systems or architectures
    • G06F12/14Protection against unauthorised use of memory or access to memory
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F12/00Accessing, addressing or allocating within memory systems or architectures
    • G06F12/14Protection against unauthorised use of memory or access to memory
    • G06F12/1458Protection against unauthorised use of memory or access to memory by checking the subject access rights
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F13/00Interconnection of, or transfer of information or other signals between, memories, input/output devices or central processing units
    • G06F13/10Program control for peripheral devices
    • G06F13/12Program control for peripheral devices using hardware independent of the central processor, e.g. channel or peripheral processor
    • G06F13/122Program control for peripheral devices using hardware independent of the central processor, e.g. channel or peripheral processor where hardware performs an I/O function other than control of data transfer
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F13/00Interconnection of, or transfer of information or other signals between, memories, input/output devices or central processing units
    • G06F13/14Handling requests for interconnection or transfer
    • G06F13/20Handling requests for interconnection or transfer for access to input/output bus
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F13/00Interconnection of, or transfer of information or other signals between, memories, input/output devices or central processing units
    • G06F13/14Handling requests for interconnection or transfer
    • G06F13/20Handling requests for interconnection or transfer for access to input/output bus
    • G06F13/28Handling requests for interconnection or transfer for access to input/output bus using burst mode transfer, e.g. direct memory access DMA, cycle steal
    • G06F13/287Multiplexed DMA
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F13/00Interconnection of, or transfer of information or other signals between, memories, input/output devices or central processing units
    • G06F13/14Handling requests for interconnection or transfer
    • G06F13/36Handling requests for interconnection or transfer for access to common bus or bus system
    • G06F13/362Handling requests for interconnection or transfer for access to common bus or bus system with centralised access control
    • G06F13/366Handling requests for interconnection or transfer for access to common bus or bus system with centralised access control using a centralised polling arbiter
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F13/00Interconnection of, or transfer of information or other signals between, memories, input/output devices or central processing units
    • G06F13/38Information transfer, e.g. on bus
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F15/00Digital computers in general; Data processing equipment in general
    • G06F15/16Combinations of two or more digital computers each having at least an arithmetic unit, a program unit and a register, e.g. for a simultaneous processing of several programs
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F15/00Digital computers in general; Data processing equipment in general
    • G06F15/16Combinations of two or more digital computers each having at least an arithmetic unit, a program unit and a register, e.g. for a simultaneous processing of several programs
    • G06F15/163Interprocessor communication
    • G06F15/167Interprocessor communication using a common memory, e.g. mailbox
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F15/00Digital computers in general; Data processing equipment in general
    • G06F15/16Combinations of two or more digital computers each having at least an arithmetic unit, a program unit and a register, e.g. for a simultaneous processing of several programs
    • G06F15/163Interprocessor communication
    • G06F15/173Interprocessor communication using an interconnection network, e.g. matrix, shuffle, pyramid, star, snowflake
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F5/00Methods or arrangements for data conversion without changing the order or content of the data handled
    • G06F5/06Methods or arrangements for data conversion without changing the order or content of the data handled for changing the speed of data flow, i.e. speed regularising or timing, e.g. delay lines, FIFO buffers; over- or underrun control therefor

Definitions

  • This invention relates to a multiprocessor computer system in which interconnected processor modules provide multiprocessing (parallel processing in separate processor modules) and multiprogramming (interleaved processing in one processor module).
  • This invention relates particularly to a system which can support high transaction rates to large on-line data bases and in which no single component failure can stop or contaminate the operation of the system.
  • an on-line system of this kind must provide not only sufficient computing power to permit multiple computations to be done simultaneously, but it must also provide a mode of operation which permits data processing to be continued without interruption in the event some component of the system fails.
  • the system should operate either in a fail-safe mode (in which no loss of throughput occurs as a result of failure) or in a fail-soft mode (in which some slowdown occurs but full processing capabilities are maintained) in the event of a failure.
  • the system should also operate in a way such that a failure of a single component cannot contaminate the operation of the system.
  • the system should provide fault-tolerant computing. For fault-tolerant computing all errors and failures in the system should either be corrected automatically, or if the failure or error cannot be corrected automatically, it should be detected, or if it cannot be detected, it should be contained and should not be permitted to contaminate the rest of the system.
  • interprocessor connections required special adapter cards that added substantially to the cost of the overall system and that introduced the possibility of single component failures which could stop the system.
  • Adding dual interprocessor links and adapter cards to avoid problems of critical single components failures increased the overall system cost even more substantially.
  • peripheral devices If a number of peripheral devices are connected to a single input/output bus of one processor in a multiprocessor system and that processor fails, then the peripheral devices will be unavailable to the system even though the failed processor is linked through an interprocessor connection to another processor or processors in the system.
  • the prior art has provided an input/output bus switch for interconnecting input/output busses for continued access to peripheral devices when a processor associated with the peripheral devices on a particular input/output bus fails.
  • the bus switches have been expensive and also have presented the possibility of single component failure which could down a substantial part of the overall system.
  • a primary object of the present invention is to construct a multiprocessor system for on-line, transaction-oriented applications which overcomes the problems of the prior art.
  • a basic objective of the present invention is to insure that no single failure can stop the system or significantly affect system operation.
  • the system of the present invention is constructed so that there is no single component that attaches to everything in the system, either mechanically or electrically.
  • Every major component is modularized so that any major component can be removed or replaced without stopping the system.
  • the system can be expanded in place (either horizontally by the addition of standard processor modules or in most cases vertically by the addition of peripheral devices) without system interruption or modification to hardware or software.
  • the multiprocessor system of the present invention comprises multiple, independent processor modules and data paths.
  • processor modules are interconnected by an interprocessor bus for multiprocessing and multiprogramming.
  • each processor module supports up to 32 device controllers, and each device controller can control up to eight peripheral devices.
  • These multiple communication paths include multiple interprocessor busses interconnecting each of the processor modules, multiports in each device controller, and input/output busses connecting each device controller for access by at least two different processor modules.
  • Each processor module is a standard module and includes as part of the module a central processing unit, a main memory, an interprocessor control and an input/output channel.
  • Each processor module has a pipelined microprocessor operated by microinstructions included as a basic instruction set in each processor module.
  • each processor module recognizes the fact that there is an interprocessor communications link; and when an additional processor module is added to the system, the operating system (a copy of which resides in each processor module) is informed that a new resource is available for operation within the existing operating system without the need to modify either the system hardward or software.
  • each processor module includes a second microprocessor which is dedicated to input/output operations.
  • the input/output subsystem of the multiprocessor system of the present invention is constructed to insure that no single processor module failure can impair system operation.
  • the input/output subsystem is constructed to handle very high transaction rates, to maximize throughput, and to minimize interference with programs running in the processor modules.
  • each processor module includes a microprocessor which is dedicated to input/output operations.
  • the input/output system is an interrupt driven system and provides a program interrupt only upon completion of the data transfer. This relieves the central processing unit from being dedicated to the device while it is transferring data.
  • Each input/output channel is block multiplexed to handle several block transfers of data from several device controllers on an apparent simultaneous basis. This is accomplished by interleaving variable length bursts of data in transfers between the input/output channel and stress responsive buffers in the device controllers.
  • each device controller has multiports, and a separate input/output bus is connected to each port so that each device controller is connected for access by at least two different processor modules.
  • each device controller is constructed so that each port is logically and physically independent of each other port. No component part of one port is also a component of another port so that no single component failure in one port can affect the operation of another port.
  • Each device controller includes logic which insures that only one port is selected for access at a time so that transmitting erroneous data to one port can never contaminate another port.
  • Each device controller includes logic which insures that only one port is selected for access at a time.
  • An enable latch in each port dynamically disables that port from placing any signals on the related input/output bus in response to a failure of any portion of the device controller, and the enable latch is not responsive to the processor module for re-enabling the port.
  • the device controller controls the transfer of information between a processor module and a peripheral device, and information is gated into a register in a port in a device controller in response to a gating signal generated by a processor module.
  • Parity generation and check means continuously monitor parity for the duration of the gating signal.
  • the error checks include check summing and parity checks on the data paths and error detection and correction in the main memory system.
  • the error checks also include time out limitations in the input/output channel.
  • Multiprocessor system apparatus and methods which incorporate the structure and techniques described above and which are effective to function as described above constitute further, specific objects of this invention.
  • FIG. 1 is an isometric, block diagram view of a multiprocessor system constructed in accordance with one embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 1 shows several processor modules 33 connected by two interprocessor buses 35 (an X bus and a Y bus) with each bus controlled by a bus controller 37.
  • FIG. 1 also shows several dual-port device controllers 41 with each device controller connected to the input/output (I/O) buses 39 of two processor modules.
  • I/O input/output
  • FIG. 2 is a block diagram view showing details of the connections of the X bus controller and the Y bus controller to the individual processor modules.
  • FIG. 2 shows, in diagrammatic form, the connections between each bus controller and the interprocessor control 55 of an individual processor module.
  • FIG. 3 is a detailed diagrammatic view of the logic of one of the bus controllers 37 shown in FIG. 2.
  • FIG. 4 is a detailed diagrammatic view of the logic for the shared output buffer and control 67 in the interprocessor control 55 of a processor module as illustrated in FIG. 2.
  • FIG. 5 is a view like FIG. 4 but showing the logic for an inqueue buffer and control 65 of the interprocessor control 55 for a processor module.
  • FIG. 6 is a state diagram of the logic 81 for a bus controller 37 and illustrates how the logic responds to the protocol lines going into the bus controller and generates the protocol lines going out of the bus controller to the processor modules.
  • FIG. 7 is a state diagram like FIG. 6 but showing the logic 73 and 75 for the shared outqueue buffer and control 67 of FIG. 4.
  • FIG. 8 is a state diagram like FIGS. 6 and 7 but showing the logic 93 and 101 for the inqueue buffer and control 65 of FIG. 5.
  • FIG. 9 is a diagrammatic view showing the time sequence for the transmission of a given packet between a sender processor module and a receiver processor module.
  • FIG. 10 is a logic diagram of the bus empty state logic section 75 and the processor fill state logic section 73 of the outqueue buffer and the control 67 shown in FIG. 4.
  • FIG. 11 is a listing of logic equations for the logic diagram shown in FIG. 10.
  • FIG. 12 is a block diagram of the input/output (I/O) system of the multiprocessor system shown in FIG. 1.
  • FIG. 13 is a block diagram of the input/output (I/O) channel 109 of a processor module.
  • FIG. 13 shows the major components of the I/O channel and the data path relating those component parts.
  • FIG. 14 is a detailed view showing the individual lines in the I/O bus 39 of FIG. 1.
  • FIG. 15 is an I/O channel protocol diagram showing the state changes of the T bus 153 for an execute input/output (EIO) caused by the microprogram 115 in the CPU 105.
  • the sequence illustrated is initiated by the CPU 105 and is transmitted through the I/O channel 109 of the processor module 33 and on the T bus 153 to a device controller 41 as shown in FIG. 1.
  • FIG. 16 is an I/O channel protocol diagram showing the state changes of the T bus 153 for a reconnect and data transfer sequence initiated by the I/O channel microprogram 121 in response to a request signal from a device controller 41.
  • FIG. 17 is an I/O channel protocol diagram showing the state changes of the T bus 153 for an interrogate I/O (IIO) instruction or an interrogate high priority I/O (HIIO) instruction initiated by the CPU microprogram 115.
  • the sequence illustrated is transmitted over the T bus 153 to a device controller 41.
  • FIG. 18 is a table identifying the functions referred to by the mnemonics in FIGS. 15 through 17.
  • FIG. 19 is a block diagram showing the general structure of the ports 43 and a device controller 41 as illustrated in FIG. 1.
  • FIG. 20 is a block diagram of a port 43 shown in FIG. 19. This FIG. 20 shows primarily the data paths within a port 43.
  • FIG. 21 is a block diagram showing the data path details of the interface common logic 181 of the device controller 41 shown in FIG. 19.
  • FIG. 22 is a block diagram showing the component parts of a data buffer 189 in the control part of a device controller 41 as illustrated in FIG. 19.
  • FIG. 23 is a graph illustrating the operation of the data buffer 189 illustrated in FIGS. 22 and 19.
  • FIG. 24 is a timing diagram illustrating the relationship of SERVICE OUT (SVO) from the channel 109 to the loading of data into the port data register 213 (FIG. 21) and illustrates how the parity check is started before data is loaded into the register and is continued until after the data has been fully loaded into the register.
  • SVO SERVICE OUT
  • FIG. 25 is a schematic view showing details of the power on circuit (PON) shown in FIGS. 19 and 21.
  • FIG. 26 is a logic diagram of the buffer control logic 243 of the data buffer 189 (shown in FIG. 22) of a device controller 41.
  • FIG. 26 shows how the buffer control logic 243 controls the handshakes on the data bus and controls the input and output pointers.
  • FIG. 27 is a listing of the logic equations for the select register 173 shown in FIG. 20. These logic equations are implemented by the port control logic 191 shown in FIG. 20.
  • FIG. 28 is a timing diagram showing the operation of the two line handshake between the I/O channel 109 and the ports 43.
  • FIG. 29 is a logic diagram showing the logic for the general case of the handshake shown in FIG. 28.
  • the logic shown in FIG. 29 is part of the T bus machine 143 of the input/output channel 109 shown in FIG. 13.
  • FIG. 30 is a block diagram of a power distribution system.
  • FIG. 30 shows how a plurality of independent and separate power supplies 303 are distributed and associated with the dual port device controllers 41 for insuring that each device controller has both a primary and an alternate power supply.
  • FIG. 31 is an enlarged, detailed view of the switching arrangement for switching between a primary power supply and an alternate supply for a device controller.
  • the switching structure shown in FIG. 31 permits both automatic switching in the event of a failure of the primary power supply and manual switching in three different modes--off, auto and alternate.
  • FIG. 32 is a block diagram showing details of one of the separate and independent power supplies 303 illustrated in FIG. 30.
  • FIG. 33 is a blook diagram view showing details of the vertical buses and the horizontal buses for supplying power from the separate power supplies 303 shown in FIG. 30 to the individual device controllers 41.
  • the particular bus arrangement shown in FIG. 33 permits easy selection of any two of the individual power supplies as the primary and the alternate power supply for a particular device controller.
  • FIG. 34 is a block diagram of the memory system and shows details of the memory 107 of a processor module 33 shown in FIG. 1.
  • FIG. 35 is a block diagram showing details of the map section 407 of the memory 107 shown in FIG. 34.
  • FIG. 36 is a block diagram showing the organization of logical memory into four logical address areas and four separate map sections corresponding to the four logical address areas.
  • FIG. 36 also shows details of the bits and fields in a single map entry of a map section.
  • FIG. 37 is a block diagram showing details of one of the memory modules 403 illustrated in FIG. 34.
  • the memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37 is a semiconductor memory module.
  • FIG. 38 is a diagram of a check bit generator used in the semiconductor memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37.
  • FIG. 38 also lists logic equations for two of the eight bit parity trees used in the check bit register.
  • FIG. 39 is a diagram of a check bit comparator used in the semiconductor memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37.
  • FIG. 39 includes the logic equation for nine bit parity tree for syndrome bit zero.
  • FIG. 40 is a diagram of a syndrome decoder used in the semiconductor memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37.
  • FIG. 37 also lists the logic equations for the operation of the logic section 511 of the syndrome decoder.
  • FIG. 41 is a logic diagram of a bit complementer used in the semiconductor memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37.
  • FIG. 42 shows the various states of a two processor system running an application program which is required to be running continuously.
  • the diagrams illustrate the two processors successively failing and being repaired and the application program changing its mode of operation accordingly.
  • FIG. 1 is an isometric diagrammatic view of a part of a multiprocessor system constructed in accordance with one embodiment of the present invention.
  • the multiprocessor system is indicated generally by the reference numeral 31.
  • the multiprocessor system 31 includes individual processor modules 33.
  • Each processor module 33 comprises a central processing unit 105, a memory 107, an input/output channel 109 and an interprocessor control 55.
  • the individual processor modules are interconnected by interprocessor buses 35 for interprocessor communications.
  • processor modules 33 are interconnected by two interprocessor buses 35 (indicated as the X bus and the Y bus in FIG. 1).
  • Each interprocessor bus has a bus controller 37 associated with that bus.
  • the bus controllers 37, interprocessor buses 35 and interprocessor controls 55 (FIG. 1), together with associated microprocessors 113, microprograms 115 and bus receive tables 150 (FIG. 2) provide an interprocessor bus system.
  • the construction and operation of this interprocessor bus system are illustrated in FIGS. 2-11 and 42 and are described in more detail below under the subtitle The Interprocessor Bus System.
  • the multiprocessor system 31 has an input/output (I/O) system for transferring data between the processor modules 33 and peripheral devices, such as the discs 45, terminals 47, magnetic tape drives 49, card readers 51, and line printers 53 shown in FIG. 1.
  • I/O input/output
  • the I/O system includes one I/O bus 39 associated with each I/O channel 109 of a processor module and one or more multi-port device controllers 41 may be connected to each I/O bus 39.
  • each device controller 41 has two ports 43 for connection to two different processor modules 33 so that each device controller is connected for access by two processor modules.
  • the I/O system includes a microprocessor 119 and a microprogram 121 in the I/O channel 109 (See FIG. 12.) which are dedicated to input/output transfers.
  • the microprocessor 113 and microprogram 115 of the central processing unit 105 and an input/output control table 140 in the main memory 107 of each processor module 33 are operatively associated with the I/O channel 109.
  • FIGS. 12-29 The construction and operation of these and other components of the I/O system are illustrated in FIGS. 12-29 and are described in detail below under the subtitle The Input/Output System and Dual Port Device Controller.
  • the multiprocessor system includes a power distribution system 301 which distributes power from separate power supplies to the processor modules 33 and to the device controllers 41 in a way that permits on-line maintenance and also provides redundancy of power on each device controller.
  • the power distribution system includes separate and independent power supplies 303.
  • a separate power supply 303 is provided for each processor module 33, and a bus 305 supplies the power from the power supply 303 to the central processing unit 105 and memory 105 of a related processor module 33.
  • each device controller 41 is connected for supply of power from two separate power supplies 303 through an automatic switch 311. If one power supply 303 for a particular device controller 41 fails, that device controller is supplied with power from the other power supply 303; and the changeover is accomplished smoothly and without any interruption or pulsation in the power supplied to the device controller.
  • the power distribution system coacts with the dual port system of the device controller to provide continuous operation and access to the peripheral devices in the event of a failure of either a single port 43 or a single power supply 303.
  • the multiprocessor system includes a power on (PON) circuit 182 (the details of which are shown in Fig. 25) in several components of the system to establish that the power to that particular component is within certain acceptable limits.
  • PON power on
  • the PON circuit 182 is located in each CPU 105, in each device controller 41, and in each bus controller 37.
  • the purpose of the PON circuit is to present a signal establishing the level of power applied to that particular component; and if the power is not within certain predetermined acceptable limits, then the signal output is used to directly disable the appropriate bus signal of the component in which the PON is located.
  • the power-on circuit functions in four states--power off; power going from off to on; power on; and power going from on to off.
  • the power-on circuit initializes all of the logic states of the system as the power is brought up; and in the present invention, the power-on circuit provides an additional and very important function of providing for a fail-safe system with on line maintenance. To do this, the power-on circuit in the present invention is used in a unique way to control the interface circuits which drive all of the intercommunication buses in the system.
  • FIGS. 30-33 The construction and operation of the power distribution system are illustrated in FIGS. 30-33 and are described in detail below under the subtitle Power Distribution System.
  • the multiprocessor system includes a memory system in which the physical memory is divided into four logical address areas--user data, system data, user code and system code (See FIG. 36.).
  • the memory system includes a map 407 and control logic 401 (See FIG. 34.) for translating all logical addresses to physical addresses and for indicating pages absent from primary storage bit present in secondary storage as required to implement a virtual memory system in which the physical page addresses are invisible to users.
  • the memory system incorporates a dual port access to the memory by the central processing unit 105 and the I/O channel 109.
  • the I/O channel 109 can therefore access the memory 107 directly (without having to go through the central processing unit 105) for data transfers to and from a device controller 41.
  • FIGS. 34-41 The construction and operation of the memory system are illustrated in FIGS. 34-41 and are described in detail below under the subtitle Memory System.
  • An error detection system is incorporated in the memory system for correcting all single bit and detecting all double bit errors when semiconductor memory is used in the memory system.
  • This error detection system utilizes a 16 bit data field and a 6 bit check field as shown in FIG. 37 and includes a data bit complementer 487 as also shown in FIG. 37 for correcting single bit errors.
  • FIGS. 37 through 41 and the related disclosure illustrate and describe details of the error detection system.
  • the term "software” will refer to an operating system or a user program instructions; the term “firmware” will refer to a microprogram in read only memory; and the term “hardware” will refer to actual electronic logic and data storage.
  • the operating system is a master control program executing in each processor module which has primary control of the allocation of all system resources accessible to that processor module.
  • the operating system provides a scheduling function and determines what process has use of that processor module.
  • the operating system also allocates the use of primary memory (memory management), and it operates the file system for secondary memory management.
  • the operating system also manages the message system. This provides a facility for information transfer over the interprocessor bus.
  • the operating system arrangement parallels the modular arrangement of the multiprocessor system components described above, in that there are no "global" components.
  • a process is the fundamental entity of control within a system.
  • Each process consists of a private data space and register values, and a possibly shared code set.
  • a process may also access a common data space.
  • a number of processes coexist in a processor module 33.
  • the processes may be user written programs, or the processes may have dedicated functions, such as, for example, control of an I/O device or the creation and deletion of other processes.
  • a process may request services from another process, and this other process may be located in the same processor module 33 as a process making the request, or the other process may be located in some other processor module 33.
  • the processes work in an asynchronous manner, and the processes therefore need a method of communication that will allow a request for services to be queued without "races” (a condition in which the outcome depends upon the sequence of which process started first)--thus the need for "messages” (an orderly system of interprocessor module communication described in more detail below).
  • a user process can make a request (using the message system) to the process associated with that device controller 41; and then the device process returns status back similar to the way the device controller 41 returns information back to the I/O channel 109 over the I/O bus 39.
  • the other fundamental entity of the software system consists of a request for service as well as any required data.
  • any required values will be returned to the requesting process.
  • This software organization provides a number of benefits.
  • This method of structuring the software also provides for significantly more reliable software. By being able to compartmentalize the software structure, smaller module sizes can be obtained, and the interfaces between modules are well defined.
  • the system is also more maintainable because of the compartmentalization of function.
  • the well defined modules and the well defined interfaces in the software system also provide advantages in being able to make it easily expandible--as in the case of adding additional processor modules 33 or device controllers 41 to the multiprocessor system.
  • messages going between processes in different processor modules 33 may use either interprocessor bus 35.
  • device controllers 41 may be operated by processes in either of the processor modules 33 connected to the device controller 41.
  • the multiprocessor hardware system and software system described above enable the user to develop a fault tolerant application system by virtue of its replicated modules with redundant interconnects.
  • the individual processor modules 33 are interconnected by two interprocessor buses 35 (an X bus and a Y bus) with each bus controlled by a related bus controller 37.
  • Each interprocessor bus 35 in combination with its bus controller 37 and a related interprocessor control 55 in each processor module 33, provides a multi-module communication path from any one processor module to any other processor module in the system.
  • the use of two buses assures that two independent paths exist between all processor modules in the system. Therefore, a failure in one path (one bus) does not prevent communication between the processor modules.
  • the bus controller 37 for each interprocessor bus 35 is a controller which is, in a preferred form of the invention, separate and distinct from the processor modules 33.
  • Each interprocessor bus 35 is a synchronous bus with the time synchronization provided by a bus clock generator in the bus controllers 37.
  • the interprocessor control portions 55 of all of the modules associated with the bus make state changes in synchronism with that bus clock during transfers over the bus.
  • the CPU 105 operates on a different clock from the interprocessor bus clock. During the filling of an outqueue or the emptying of an inqueue in the interprocessor control 55 by the CPU, the operation takes place at the CPU clock rate. However, transmission of packets over the interprocessor bus always takes place at the bus clock rate.
  • the information transmitted over the interprocessor bus is transferred at high transmission rates without any required correspondence to the clock rates of the various CPUs 105.
  • the information transfer rate over the interprocessor bus is also substantially faster than would be permitted by direct memory accesses into and out of the memory sections 107 at memory speed. This ensures that there is adequate bus bandwidth even when a large number of processor modules is connected in a multiprocessor system.
  • a benefit of using separate clocks for each CPU 105 is that a master system clock is not required, and this eliminates a potential source of single component failure which could stop the entire system.
  • the interprocessor control 55 incorporates logic interlocks which make it possible to operate the interprocessor buses 35 at one clock rate and each CPU 105 at its own independent clock rate without loss of data.
  • each packet is a sixteen word packet in which fifteen of the words are data words and one word is a check word.
  • the control logic within the bus controller 37 and the interprocessor controls 55 of the individual modules 33 follows a detailed protocol.
  • the protocol provides for establishing a sender-receiver pair and a time frame for the data packet transfer. At the end of the time frame for the transmission of the data packet, the bus controller 37 is released for another such sequence. The specific manner in which these functions are carried out will become more apparent after a description of the structural features of FIGS. 3-9 below.
  • X bus 35 is identical in structure to the Y bus 35, so the structure of only one bus will be described in detail.
  • each bus 35 comprises sixteen individual bus data lines 57, five individual bus protocol lines 59, and one clock line 61, and one select line 63 for each processor module 33.
  • each processor module 33 includes two inqueue sections 65 (shown as an X inqueue section and a Y inqueue section in FIG. 2) and a shared outqueue section 67.
  • the shared outqueue section 67 includes an outqueue buffer 69 which performs a storage function.
  • the buffer 69 has sixteen words of sixteen bits each. The buffer 69 is loaded by the CPU and holds the data until the packet transmission time, at which time the data is gated out to the bus, as will be described in more detail below.
  • the outqueue section 67 also includes a receive register 71, which in a preferred form of the invention is a four bit register. This register is loaded by the CPU with the number of the processor module to which the data will be sent.
  • the control part of the outqueue section 67 includes a processor fill state logic section 73 which operates in synchronism with the CPU clock, a bus empty state logic section 75 which operates in synchronism with the X or Y bus clock, and an outqueue counter 77.
  • the outqueue counter 77 scans the buffer 69 to direct the data input into each of the sixteen words of the buffer; and, as the sixteenth word is stored into the outqueue buffer 69, the outqueue counter 77 terminates the fill state.
  • the outqueue section 67 also includes an outqueue pointer 79 which connects the entire outqueue section to either the X bus or the Y bus 35.
  • the outqueue pointer 79 allows the logic sections 73 and 75 and the buffer 69 to be shared by the X and Y interprocessor buses 35.
  • the bus controller 37 comprises a bus control state logic section 81, a sender counter 83, a processor select logic section 85, a receive register 87, a packet counter 89 and a bus clock generator 91.
  • each inqueue section 65 comprises a bus fill state logic section 93 which operates in synchronism with the bus clock, a sender register 95, an inqueue buffer 97, an inqueue counter 99, and a processor empty state logic section 101 which operates in synchronism with the CPU clock.
  • FIG. 6 is a state diagram of the bus control logic 81 of the bus controller 37.
  • FIG. 7 is a state diagram of the logic sections 73 and 75 of the outqueue section 67.
  • FIG. 8 is a state diagram of the logic sections 93 and 101 of the inqueue sections 65.
  • the processor fill state logic section 73 has basically four states--EMPTY, FILL, FULL and WAIT--as indicated by the respective legends.
  • the bus empty state logic section 75 has basically four states--IDLE, SYNC, SEND and DONE--as illustrated by the legends.
  • the store outqueue condition will not cause an exit from the FILL state until the outqueue counter 77 has advanced to count 15 (on a count which starts with zero) at which time the FILL state will advance to the FULL state.
  • the asterisk in the notation of FIG. 7 indicates an increment of the outqueue counter 77.
  • FIG. 6 shows the state diagram for logic 81 of the bus controller and illustrates that the logic has basically four states--IDLE, POLL, RECEIVE and SEND.
  • FIG. 6 The notation in FIG. 6 is the same as that described above for FIG. 7.
  • a solid arrow line indicates a state transition from one state to another and a dotted arrow line to that solid arrow line indicates a condition which must occur to allow the indicated (solid line arrow) transition to occur.
  • An asterisk on a state transition in this case indicates that simultaneously with the indicated transition the sender counter 83 is incremented by one.
  • the dashed arrow output lines in FIG. 6 indicate protocol commands issued from the bus controller to the interprocessor bus.
  • a dashed arrow leaving a state indicates a logic output from that state such as a logic output signal to a protocol line (in the case of the bus empty state logic 75) or to a status line of the processor module (in the case of the processor fill state logic 73).
  • FIG. 8 shows the state diagrams for the bus fill state logic section 93 and the processor empty state logic section 101.
  • the state diagram for the logic section 93 includes four states--SYNC, ACKNOWLEDGE, RECEIVE and FULL.
  • the state diagram for the logic section 101 includes four states--RESET, READY, INTERRUPT and DUMP.
  • the asterisk in FIG. 8 indicates an increment in the inqueue counter 99.
  • FIG. 9 is a timing diagram showing the time sequence in which the state changes given in FIGS. 6, 7 and 8 occur.
  • the sequence shown in FIG. 9 accomplishes the transmission of a packet from one processor module to another processor module at the bus clock rate (assuming that the intended receiver module is ready to receive the packet).
  • FIG. 9 shows the time sequences for a successful packet transfer with individual signal representations listed from top-to-bottom in FIG. 9 and with time periods of one bus clock each shown from left-to-right in the order of increasing time in FIG. 9.
  • the top line in FIG. 9 indicates the state of the bus controller, and each division mark represents a clock period or cycle of the bus clock generator 91 shown in FIG. 3. Each time division of the top line carries down vertically through the various signal representations listed by the legends at the left side of the figure.
  • the first signal (below the bus controller state line) is the SEND REQUEST signal (one of the protocol group indicated by the reference numeral 59 in FIG. 3) and specifically is the signal which may be asserted by the outqueue control logic section 67 of any processor module 33.
  • the signal is transmitted to the bus control state logic section 81 of the bus controller 37 (see FIG. 3).
  • the next signal shown in FIG. 9 represents a signal which originates from the processor select logic section 85 of the bus controller 37 and which is transmitted on only one at a time of the select lines 63 to a related processor module 33.
  • the next signal represented in FIG. 9, the SEND ACKNOWLEDGE signal may be asserted only by a particular processor 33 when that processor is selected and when its bus empty state logic section 75 is in the SEND state (as illustrated in the third state of FIG. 7).
  • This SEND ACKNOWLEDGE signal is used by the bus controller 37 to establish the identity of a processor module 33 wishing to send a packet.
  • the next signal represents a signal from the bus controller 37 transmitted on one of the protocol lines 59. This signal does two things.
  • this signal in combination with receiver SELECT interrogates the receiver processor module 33 to find out whether this receiver module is ready to receive (as indicated by the ACKNOWLEDGE state in FIG. 8).
  • this signal has a secondary function of disabling the bus empty state logic section 75 of the receiving module so that the receiving module cannot gate an intended receiver number to the data bus should the outqueue section of the intended receiver module 33 also have a data packet of its own ready to send.
  • the sender processor is asserting the SEND ACKNOWLEDGE signal it is also gating the receiver number to the bus for use by the bus controller 37.
  • the bus 35 itself is, of course, a non-directional bus so that the information can be gated to the data bus 57 by any module for use by either the bus controller 37 for a control function or for use by another processor for an information transfer function. It should be noted that a module 33 may gate data to the bus only when its SELECT line is asserted and the RECEIVE COMMAND signal is not asserted.
  • the bus controller 37 is gating the sender number to the data bus 57 for capture by the selected receiver processor module.
  • the next signal line (the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE line in FIG. 9) represents a signal which is transmitted from the selected receiving module's bus fill state logic section 93 to the bus control state logic section 81 of the bus controller 37 (over one of the protocol lines 59) to indicate that the selected receiver module is in the ACKNOWLEDGE state (as indicated by the legend in FIG. 8) and thus ready to receive the packet which the sender module has ready to transmit.
  • the SEND COMMAND line represents a signal which originates from the bus control state logic section 81 of the bus controller 37 and which is transmitted to the bus empty state logic section 75 of the sender processor module 33 over one of the protocol lines 59.
  • the SEND COMMAND signal In combination with a SELECT of the sender processor module the SEND COMMAND signal enables the sender processor module to send a packet to the receiver module during the sixteen clock cycles bracketed by the SEND COMMAND signal.
  • the final line (the data/16 line) represents the information present on the data lines 57 during the above-described sequence.
  • the data is gated to the bus by the selected sender processor module and is transmitted to the receiver processor module into the inqueue buffer 97 (see FIG. 5) during this sixteen clock cycle time frame. This assumes that the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal was received by the bus controller in response to the RECEIVE COMMAND signal.
  • the processor fill state logic section 73 includes two flip-flops A and B, and the bus empty state logic section 75 includes two flip-flops C and D.
  • C and D state variables are defined to be the IDLE, SYNC, SEND and DONE states respectively.
  • the initial state reached through power on initialization or manual reset is the EMPTY state shown in the top left part of FIG. 7.
  • the EMPTY state of the processor fill state logic 73 provides a ready signal to the central processor unit (CPU) 105 to indicate the presence of that state, as indicated by the dashed arrow RDY shown as leaving the empty state in FIG. 7.
  • the CPU firmware in response to that ready signal, when a transmission over the interprocessor bus is required, will provide a store receive signa1 (shown by the dashed arrow incoming to the diagram in FIG. 7). This store receive signal qualifies (synchronizes) the transition which advances the EMPTY state to the FILL state.
  • the CPU firmware to transfer data into the outqueue buffer 69, will provide a store outqueue signal (the dashed arrow entering the diagram in FIG. 7) for each word to be stored in the buffer 69.
  • Each occurrence of this store outqueue signal will advance the outqueue counter 77, commencing with a count of zero, until a count of 15 is reached.
  • the FULL state of the processor FILL state logic provides a synchronization condition to the bus empty state logic denoted by the dashed arrow leaving the FULL state of logic 73 and going down to the logic 75 in FIG. 7.
  • the processor fill state logic 73 will remain in the FULL state until the bus empty state logic 75 has subsequently reached the DONE state.
  • the initial state, IDLE for the logic section 75 in FIG. 7 is again provided by power on initialization or manual reset.
  • the bus empty state logic 75 will remain in the IDLE state until the transistion to the SYNC state is allowed as shown by the dashed arrow from the FULL state of the processor fill 73.
  • the empty state logic 75 will proceed with no qualification required from the SYNC state to the SEND state.
  • the bus controller logic 81 (FIG. 6) will poll processor modules successively until the sender is identified (as discussed earlier with reference to FIG. 9).
  • the bus controller will issue a RECEIVE COMMAND and SELECT to the intended receiver processor module; and upon receipt of the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal will proceed to the packet time frame (also identified in FIG. 9).
  • the bus controller asserts SELECT of the sender processor module and also asserts the SEND COMMAND signal to the sender processor module.
  • This SELECT signal and SEND COMMAND signal is shown as entering the diagram and qualifying (synchronizing) transitions leaving and entering the SEND state as noted in FIG. 7.
  • the WAIT state of the processor fill state logic 73 qualifies a transition of the bus empty state logic 75 from the DONE state to the IDLE state (as denoted by a dashed arrow leaving the WAIT state and qualifying the indicated transition).
  • bus empty state logic 75 qualifying the transition of the processor fill state logic 73 from the WAIT state to the EMPTY state (as denoted by the dashed arrow leaving the IDLE state).
  • the flip-flops A and B are JK flip-flops and are edge triggered flip-flops in that state changes occur only on clock transitions (as indicated by the small triangular symbols and legends on the lefthand sides of the flip-flops A and B in FIG. 10).
  • the primary significance of the logic diagram in FIG. 10 is to illustrate the transition from one state to another in the state machines shown in FIG. 7. Thus, to illustrate the transition from IDLE to SYNC in the empty state logic 75, the operation proceeds as follows.
  • the state variable C To implement a change from the IDLE state to the SYNC state, the state variable C must be set.
  • the logic equation for the J input of state variable C is as shown in FIG. 11 and is indicated by the reference numeral 103.
  • the interlock (shown by the dashed arrow from the full state of the fill state logic 73 in FIG. 7 to the transition) corresponds to the quantity (A ⁇ B) or (FULL) in the equation indicated by the reference number 103.
  • the D or (IDLE) in the equation indicated by reference numeral 103 in FIG. 11 corresponds to the IDLE state shown by the legend in FIG. 7.
  • the J in the equation corresponds to the J input of the C flip-flop in FIG. 10.
  • the (C) corresponds to the true output of the C flip-flop in FIG. 10.
  • FIGS. 10 and 11 show the logic diagram and logic equations for the state diagram of the outqueue buffer and control 67. Corresponding logic diagrams and logic equations have not been illustrated for the inqueue buffer and control 65 or the bus controller 37 because such logic diagrams and equations are similar to those shown in FIG. 10 and FIG. 11 and are easily obtainable from the state diagrams shown in FIGS. 6 and 8.
  • Each processor module 33 (FIG. 1) in the multiprocessor system is connected to both interprocessor buses 35 (FIG. 1) and is capable of communicating with any processor module including itself over either bus. For each block data transfer, one processor module is the source or sender and another is the destination or receiver.
  • Transmission of data by a processor module over one of the interprocessor buses is initiated and accomplished under software control by means of the SEND instruction.
  • the microprogram 115 (FIG. 2) and the CPU microprocessor 113 (FIG. 2) interacts with the shared outqueue section 67 of the interprocessor control 55 to read a data block from memory 101 to break it up into packets, to calculate packet check sum words, and to transmit the block one packet at a time over a bus to the receiving processor module.
  • Parameters supplied to the SEND instruction specify the number of words in the block, the starting address of the block, which bus to use, the destination processor, and a maximum initial timeout value to wait for the outqueue 67 (FIG. 2) to become available.
  • the SEND instruction terminates only after the entire block has been transmitted; thus sending a block is a single event from the software viewpoint.
  • the SEND instruction is interruptable and resumable, so that response of the operating system to other events is not impaired by the length of the time required to complete a SEND instruction.
  • Receiving of data by a processor module over the interprocessor buses is not done by means of a software instruction, since the arrival times and sources of data packets cannot be predicted.
  • the receiving of data is enabled but cannot be initiated by the receiver.
  • the CPU microprocessor 113 takes time out from software instruction processing as required to execute the BUS RECEIVE microprogram 115.
  • This microprogram takes the received data packet from one of the inqueue sections 65 (FIG. 2) of the interprbcessor control 55, stores the data into a memory buffer, and verifies correct packet check sum.
  • BRT Bus Receive Table 150
  • the BRT contains 32 two-word entries, corresponding to the two buses from each of the sixteen processor modules possible in one specific implementation of the multiprocessor system.
  • Each BRT entry corresponding to a bus and a sender contains an address word and a count word.
  • the address word specifies into which buffer in the System Data area incoming data from that sender is to be stored.
  • the count word specifies how many data words remain to complete the block transfer from that sender.
  • the CPU microprocessor 113 suspends processing of software instructions, and the bus receive microprogram 115 is activated.
  • This microprogram reads the address and count words from the sender's BRT entry, stores the data packet into the specified area, verifies correct packet check sum, and restores adjusted values of the address and count words into the BRT entry. If the packet caused the count to reach zero or if the packet contained incorrect check sum, the bus receive microprogram sets a completion interrupt flag to signal termination of the data block to the software. The CPU microprogram then resumes software instruction processing at the point where it left off with no disturbance except delay to the currently executing program.
  • each interprocessor bus and associated bus controller allow packets to be transmitted between any sender and receiver as required.
  • the circular polling by a bus controller to identify a requesting sender ensures that all processor modules have an equal opportunity to send over that bus.
  • Each bus provides a communication path which is shared in time in an unbiased way by all processor modules.
  • each inqueue section 65 of the interprocessor control 55 of a processor module is shared in time by incoming packets from several senders. That is, the inqueue logic and storage of a processor is not dedicated to a single sender for the duration of a block transfer. Instead, each packet received is correctly directed into memory by the BRT entry corresponding to its sender and bus. Data blocks from several senders are assembled correctly in the receiver's memory independently of the order in which the senders make use of the bus.
  • a processor module has two ways of controlling its ability to receive packets over the X bus or the Y bus.
  • a second means of controlling its ability to receive packets over the bus is the action taken by a processor module after an X bus or Y bus receive completion interrupt (activation of an operating system interrupt handler).
  • the BUS RECEIVE microprogram sets the X bus or Y bus completion interrupt flag. Otherwise, the microprogram issues the RINT signal (see FIG. 8) to the inqueue Processor Empty state logic 101 to allow another packet to be received. When the completion flag is set, however, the RINT signal is not issued.
  • the completion interrupt signal can therefore designate either a block data transfer that has been sent and received without error, or it can designate a partial transfer in which a check sum error is detected, and in which partial transfer of the completion interrupt is generated as a result of the check sum error detected.
  • the sender continues to send the data block but the receiver discards the data block after the check sum error has been detected.
  • This error shows up in the bus receive table (BRT) count word as a negative value.
  • the SEND instruction is an instruction that requires four parameter words in the CPU register stack.
  • the first of the four parameter words is a count of the number of words to be transferred. This value must match the number expected by the BRT in the receiver processor module if the transfer is to complete successfully.
  • the second parameter word is the address, minus one, in the System Data area in the sender processor's memory where the data to be transferred is located.
  • the third parameter word is a timeout value allotted to completing a sin91e packet (fifteen data word) transfer.
  • the timeout period is restarted for each packet transferred by the SEND instruction.
  • the fourth parameter word specifies the bus (whether the X bus or the Y bus) to be used and specifies the receiver processor module.
  • the high order bit of the parameter specifies the bus and the low order four bits, in one specific implementation of the invention, specify the number of the receiver processor module.
  • the first condition is that a packet timeout occurred and the remaining packets were not transmitted and the instruction was terminated at that point. In this event the remaining packets of the block are not transmitted.
  • the second condition is an indication that a successful data block transfer has been completed.
  • the SEND instruction fills the outqueue buffer 69 (FIG. 4) with fifteen data words, appends an odd-parity check sum, and signals the bus controller 37 that it has a packet ready for transmission. After each sixteen word packet is transmitted, execution of the SEND instruction resumes at the point where it left off. If the last packet of the block has less than fifteen words, the remaining words are filled in with zeros. The instruction terminates when the last packet is transmitted.
  • FIG. 5 shows the logic diagram and FIG. 7 shows the state diagram for the send hardware.
  • the first action of the SEND instruction sequence is to issue the S/RECEIVE signal to the processor fill state logic 73 (FIG. 4) and to supply on the M Bus (FIG. 4) the receiver processor number to the receive register 71.
  • the pointer of the outqueue pointer 79 is set in accordance with the high order bit of the M Bus to connect the outqueue 67 to either the X bus or the Y bus.
  • the store receive (S/RECEIVE) signal causes the processor fill state logic 73 (which is initially in the empty state as shown in FIG. 7) to advance to the FILL state as shown in FIG. 7. This state transition causes the receive register 71 (FIG. 4) to be loaded with the receiver processor number.
  • the outqueue section 67 is ready for the data packet to be loaded into the outqueue buffer 69.
  • up to fifteen words are read from memory and are stored, by means of the M bus (FIG. 4), into the outqueue buffer 69.
  • the store outqueue signal causes each word on the M bus to be written into the outqueue buffer 69 in a location specified by the outqueue counter 77.
  • Each store outqueue signal also causes the outqueue counter 77 to be advanced by one.
  • the address word is being incremented by one, and the count of the words to be sent is being decremented by one. If the count reaches zero before fifteen words are read from memory, the remainder of the outqueue buffer is filled with zeros to pad out the data packet.
  • the microprogram 115 (FIG. 2) is calculating a modulo-two sum of the data words. After the fifteenth data word has been loaded, this odd check-sum word is loaded into the sixteenth location of the outqueue buffer 69.
  • the outqueue counter 77 has a value of count 15 and this value, in combination with the store outqueue signal, causes the processor fill state logic 73 to advance from the FILL state to the FULL state as shown in FIG. 7.
  • microprogram 115 has completed loading of the data into the outqueue 69.
  • the microprogram now waits for the packet to be transmitted by testing for occurrence of the ready (RDY) signal shown in FIG. 7.
  • the microprogram 115 While waiting for the packet to be transmitted, the microprogram 115 increments a timer; and if the timer runs out or expires before the ready (RDY) signal is asserted, the microprogram issues the clear outqueue (CLOQ) signal to the processor fill state logic 73 (see FIG. 4). This causes the processor fill state logic 73 to return to the empty state as shown in FIG. 7, and the microprogram then terminates the SEND instruction with the time out indication.
  • CLOQ clear outqueue
  • the FULL state of the processor fill state logic 73 qualifies the bus empty state logic 75 to advance from the IDLE state to the SYNC state shown in FIG. 7.
  • the SYNC state automatically advances to the SEND state, and this state causes the SEND REQUEST signal to be issued to the bus controller 37.
  • the SEND REQUEST signal initiates a packet transfer sequence described earlier.
  • the sender processor module has been identified by the bus controller 37 by polling, and when the receiver processor module has accepted the packet transfer by means of the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal, the data packet is gated from the outqueue buffer 69 through the outqueue pointer 79 to one of the data buses 57 for loading into the inqueue of the receiver processor module.
  • the value of the outqueue counter count 15, in combination with the SEND COMMAND signal and the SENDER SELECT signal causes the SEND state of the bus empty state logic 75 to advance to the DONE state.
  • the DONE state qualifies the FULL state of the processor fill state logic 73 (as shown by the dashed line arrow going from the DONE state to the indicated transition from the FULL state in FIG. 7) to advance to the WAIT state.
  • the WAIT state qualifies the DONE state to advance to the IDLE state as illustrated by the state diagram in FIG. 7.
  • IDLE state qualifies the WAIT state to advance to the EMPTY state as also indicated in the state diagram of FIG. 7.
  • the EMPTY state of the processor fill state logic 73, provides the READY indication to the microprogram 115.
  • the SEND instruction is terminated and the successful block transfer indication is given.
  • the packet transmitted is not the last packet in a data block, then the sequence described above is repeated until all words in the block have been transmitted, or until a timeout error has occurred.
  • the SEND instruction is interruptable and resumable; however, the SEND instruction is only interruptable between packets; and the interruption of the SEND instruction has no effect on the data transmitted.
  • a data block of up to 32,767 words is transmittable from a sender processor module to a receiver processor module, and accuracy of the transmission is checked by the packet check-sum. Also, the transmission occurs at a high data transfer rate, because the buffering provided by the outqueue buffer 69 of the sender processor module enables the transfer to be made at interprocessor bus speed independent of the memory speed of the sender processor module. This allows efficient use of this communication path between a number of processor modules on a time slicing basis.
  • Each BRT entry contains the address where the incoming data is stored and the number of words expected.
  • the sender processor module While the sender processor module is executing the send instruction and sending data over the bus, the bus receive hardware and the microprogram 115 in the receiver processor module are storing the data away according to the appropriate BRT entry (this occurs interleaved with software program execution).
  • the receiver processor module When the receiver processor module receives the expected number of words from a given sender, the currently executing program is interrupted, and that particular bus transfer is completed.
  • FIG. 5 shows the logic diagram and FIG. 8 shows the state diagram for the bus receive hardware.
  • the RESET state of the processor empty state logic 101 advances to the READY state.
  • the READY state qualifies the SYNC state of the bus fill state logic 93 to advance the logic to the ACKNOWLEDGE state.
  • the inqueue section 65 In this ACKNOWLEDGE state the inqueue section 65 returns RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE to the bus controller 37 in response to a SELECT 63 (see FIG. 2) of that processor module 33. This indicates the readiness of the X inqueue section 65 to receive the data packet.
  • the combination of the SELECT of that processor module and the RECEIVE COMMAND signal qualify the ACKNOWLEDGE state of the bus fill state logic 93 and to advance to the RECEIVE state.
  • the data packet is loaded from the data bus to the inqueue buffer 97 under control of the inqueue counter 99.
  • the sixteenth word of the packet As the sixteenth word of the packet is loaded, it causes the RECEIVE state to advance to the FULL state (see FIG. 8).
  • the FULL state qualifies the READY state of the processor empty state logic 101 to advance to the MICROINTERRUPT state as shown in FIG. 8.
  • the MICROINTERRUPT state presents an INQUEUE FULL state to the CPU interrupt logic. This INQUEUE FULL signal causes a microinterrupt to occur at the end of the next software instruction if the MASK bit corresponding to that bus is on.
  • the bus receive microprogram 115 activated by the interrupt first of all issues a LOCK signal (see FIG. 5) to the processor empty state logic 101. This causes the MICROINTERRUPT state of the processor empty state logic 101 to advance to the DUMP state.
  • the LOCK signal also selects either the X inqueue or the Y inqueue; subject, however, to the condition if both inqueues are full and enabled, the X queue is selected.
  • the microprogram 115 issues the K/SEND signal which causes the sender register 95 contents to be gated to the K bus (as shown in FIG. 5) to obtain the packet sender's processor number.
  • the microprogram 115 reads the sender processor's BRT entry to obtain the address and count words.
  • the microprogram 115 issues a RINT signal which causes the processor empty state logic 101 to advance from the DUMP state to the RESET state as shown in FIG. 8. In this event there is no further action.
  • the microinterrupt is terminated, and software ihstruction processing is resumed.
  • the microprogram 115 reads words from the inqueue buffer 97 to the K bus by means of the K/INQUEUE signal as shown in FIG. 5.
  • the inqueue counter 99 is incremented to scan through the inqueue buffer 97.
  • the count word is decremented, the memory address word is incremented, and the data word is stored into memory.
  • the count word will contain a value between minus 14 and zero.
  • the bus fill state logic 93 stays in the FULL state until cleared by an RIR instruction.
  • the bus receive microprogram 115 issues the RINT signal to the processor empty state logic as shown in FIG. 5 which causes the DUMP state of the processor empty state logic 101 to advanoe to the RESET state as shown in FIG. 8.
  • the RESET state of the logic 101 qualifies the bus fill state logic 93 to advance from the FULL state to the SYNC state as also shown in FIG. 8.
  • These packets may be from the same sender, completing that data block, or the packets may be from some other sender.
  • the software interrupt handler When a bus receive completion interrupt has occurred, the software interrupt handler obtains the sender processor number from the memory location where that number was saved, and the software interrupt handler can then detect if a check sum error occurred by examining that sender processor's bus receive table count word.
  • the count word In the case of a transmission error, the count word has been set to minus 256. Otherwise, the count word will contain a value between minus fourteen and zero.
  • the receiving of data by a receiver processor does not cause a software interrupt of the receiver processor module until the entire data block has been received or until an error has has occurred.
  • the inqueues 65 serve as buffers to allow the transmission of data to occur at bus transmission rates while allowing the storing of data into memory and the checking of the data to occur at memory speed. This ability to use the high transmission rate on the bus insures adequate bus bandwidth to service a number of processor modules on a time slicing basis.
  • the provision of a check sum word in each data packet provides a means in the receiver processor module for checking the accuracy of the data received over the multiprocessor communication path.
  • Information sent over the interprocessor bus is sent under the control of the operating system and is sent from one process in one processor module 33 to another process in another processor module 33.
  • a process (as described in detail above in the description of the Multiprocessor System) is a fundamental entity of control in the software system; and a number of processes coexist in a processor module 33.
  • the information sent over the interprocessor bus between processes in different processor modules consists of two types of elements, control packets and data.
  • the control packets are used to inform the receiving processor module 33 about message initiations, cancellations, and data transfers.
  • interprocessor buses 35 interconnect the processor modules 33
  • a process within a particular processor module 33 communicates with another process or with other processes within another processor module 33 through a method of multiplexing the interprocessor bus 35.
  • the bus traffic between two processor modules 33 will therefore contain pieces of interprocess communications that are in various states of completion. Many interprocess communications are therefore being interleaved on an apparently simultaneous basis.
  • the hardware is time slicing the use of the interprocessor bus 35 on a packet level, and multiple processes are intercommunicating both within the processor modules 33 and to the extent necessary over the interprocessor buses 35 in message transactions which occur interleaved with each other. Under no circumstances is an interprocessor bus 35 allocated to any specific process-to-process communication.
  • Data information is sent over the interprocessor bus in one or more packets and is always preceded by a control packet and is always followed by a trailer packet.
  • control packet preceding the data packets is needed because a bus is never dedicated to a specific message, and the control packet is therefore needed to correctly identify the message and to indicate how much data is to be received in the message.
  • This information transfer (control packet, data information, trailer packet) is made as an indivisible unit once it is started.
  • the sender processor module sends the data block as an individual transmission (consisting of some number of data packets) and sends the trailer packet as an individual transmission; and only then is the sender processor module able to send information relating to another message.
  • the trailer packet serves two purposes.
  • the trailer packet indicates the end of the block.
  • the trailer packet provides a means for recognizing data has been transmitted and the data transmission has completed.
  • the information transmitted is either duplicated over different paths (so that it is insured that the information will get to the receiver) or a receiver acknowledgment is required (so that the information is repeated if necessary). Any single bus error therefore cannot cause information to be lost, and any single bus error will not be seen by the two processes involved.
  • the bus receive software interlocks with the bus receive hardware (the inqueue section 65 shown in FIG. 2) by controlling the transfer of information from the inqueue into the memory 107.
  • the interlock is removed by clearing the previous completion interrupt and by reenabling the bus receive microinterrupts by setting on the bus mask bit in the mask register.
  • the hardware/software system is so constructed that no information is lost on a system power failure (such as a complete failure of AC power from the mains) or on a line transient that causes a momentary power failure for part of the system.
  • a system power failure such as a complete failure of AC power from the mains
  • a line transient that causes a momentary power failure for part of the system.
  • This hardware/software system coaction includes a power warn signal (see line 337 of FIG. 3) supplied to the inqueue section 65 (see FIG. 2) so that, at most, one further packet of information can be loaded into the inqueue after the receipt of the power warn signal.
  • a power warn signal (see line 337 of FIG. 3) supplied to the inqueue section 65 (see FIG. 2) so that, at most, one further packet of information can be loaded into the inqueue after the receipt of the power warn signal.
  • the software action in this event includes a SEND instruction to force the inqueues to be full.
  • the net effect is to insure that no transmissions are completed after the processor module 33 has received its power warn signal, so that the state of every transfer is known when logic power is removed.
  • the interprocessor buses 35 are used by the operating system to ascertain that other processor modules in the system are operating. Every N seconds, each of the processor modules 33 sends a control packet to each processor module 33 in the system on each interprocessor bus 35. Every two N seconds, each processor module 33 must have received such a packet from each processor module 33 in the system. A processor module that does not respond is considered down. If a processor module does not get its own message, then that processor module 33 knows that something is wrong with it, and it will no longer take over I/O device controllers 41.
  • FIG. 42 diagrammatically illustrates how a particular application program can run continuously even though various parts of the multiprocessor system can become inoperative.
  • FIG. 42 illustrates a multiprocessor system configuration which consists of two processor modules 33 connected by dual interprocessor buses 35 (indicated as an X bus and a Y bus), a device controller 41 which controls a number of keyboard terminals, and another device controller 41 which controls a disc.
  • FIG. 42 The individual views of FIG. 42 indicate various parts of the multiprocessor system rendered unserviceable and then reintroduced into the multiprocessor system in a serviceable state.
  • the sequence starts with the upper left hand view and then proceeds in the order indicated by the broad line arrows between the views.
  • the sequence thus goes from the condition indicated as (1) Initial State to (2) CPU 0 Down to (3) CPU 0 Restored to (4) CPU 1 Down to (5) CPU 1 Restored (as indicated by the legends above each individual view).
  • the processor module 0 In the next view (the view entitled "CPU 0 Down") the processor module 0 is rendered unserviceable.
  • the multiprocessor system informs the application program PA that this has happened, and the application program PA no longer tries to communicate with the program PB. All of the I/O is switched by the multiprocessor system to take place by way of the processor module 1, and the application program continues to service the terminals without interruption over the I/O bus 39 connecting the processor module 1 with the device controllers 41 (as indicated by the solid line arrow on the right hand I/O bus 39).
  • the processor module 0 In the next state of operation of the multiprocessor system, as illustrated in the center top view of FIG. 42 and entitled "CPU 0 Restored", the processor module 0 is now brought back into service by way of a console command. The processor module 0 is reloaded with the multiprocessor system from the disc by way of the processor module 1. The application program PA is informed that processor module 0 is now serviceable and the application program PA tells the multiprocessor system to create another copy of the application program in the processor module 0. This other copy is designated as PC. The terminals continue without interruption.
  • the processor module 1 is rendered inoperative, as illustrated in the view entitled "CPU 1 Down".
  • the application program PC is informed of this fact by the multiprocessor system and the application program PC takes over the application.
  • the multiprocessor system automatically performs all of the I/O by way of the processor module 0.
  • the terminals continue in operation without interruption.
  • the processor module 1 is rendered operable by way of a console command and is reloaded with the multiprocessor system from the disc by way of the processor module 0.
  • the application program PC is informed that the processor module is now available, and it tells the multiprocessor system to create another copy of itself (application program PD) in the processor module 1. All elements of the multiprocessor system are now operable.
  • the multiprocessor system 31 thus is a true fault tolerant system.
  • the multiprocessor system 31 shown in FIG. 1 includes an input/output (I/O) system and dual port device controllers 41 as noted generally above.
  • I/O input/output
  • dual port device controllers 41 as noted generally above.
  • the general purpose of the I/O system is to allow transfer of data between a processor module 33 and peripheral devices.
  • the data transfer can be accomplished over redundant paths to insure fail soft operations so that a failure of a processor module 33 or a failure of a part of a device controller 41 will not inhibit transfer of data to and from a particular peripheral device.
  • Each device controller 41 has dual ports 43 and related structure which, in association with two related I/O buses 39, permit the redundant access to a peripheral device as will be described in more detail below.
  • the I/O system of the present invention also has some particularly significant features in terms of performance.
  • one of the performance features of the I/O system of the present invention is the speed (bandwidth) at which the input/output bus structure operates.
  • the device controllers 41 collect data from peripheral devices which transmit data at relatively slow rates and transmit the collected data to the processor modules in a burst multiplex mode at or near memory speed of the processor modules 33.
  • each processor module 33 is attached to and handles a plurality of individual device controllers 41; and this fact makes it possible for each device controller 41 to be connected (through dual ports 43) to more than one processor module 33 in a single multiprocessor system.
  • each processor module 33 includes, in addition to the interprocessor control 55 noted above, a central processor unit (CPU) part 105, a memory part 107 and an input/output (I/O) channel part 109.
  • CPU central processor unit
  • I/O input/output
  • each device controller 41 controls one or more devices through connecting lines 111 connected in a star pattern, i.e. each device independently connected to the device controller.
  • a disc drive 45 is connected to one device controller 41 and a tape drive 49 is connected to another device controller 41.
  • each CPU part 105 includes a microprocessor 113.
  • a microprogram 115 is associated with each microprocessor 113.
  • a part of the microprogram 115 is executed by the microprocessor 113 in performing I/O instructions for the I/O system.
  • the I/O instructions are indicated in FIG. 12 as EIO (execute I/O), IIO (interrogate I/O), HIIO (interrogate high priority I/O); and these instructions are illustrated and described in greater detail below with reference to FIGS. 15, 16 and 17.
  • the microprocessor 113 has access to the I/O bus 39 by way of the I/O channel 109 by a collection of paths 117 as illustrated in FIG. 12.
  • the I/O channel 109 includes a microprocessor 119, and a microprogram 121 is associated with the microprocessor 119.
  • the microprogram 121 has a single function in the multiprocessor system, and that function is to perform the reconnect and data transfer sequence illustrated in FIG. 16 (and described in more detail below).
  • the I/O channel 109 of a processor module 33 also includes (as shown in FIG. 12) data path logic 123.
  • the data path logic 123 includes a channel memory data register 125, an input/output data register 127, a channel memory address register 129, a character count register 131, an active device address register 133, a priority resolving register 135 and parity generation and check logic 137.
  • the path 117 shown in FIG. 12 includes two buses indicated as the M bus and the K bus in FIG. 13.
  • the M bus is an outbus from the microprocessor 113 and transmits data into the input/output data register 127.
  • the K bus is an inbus which transmits data from the data path logic 123 into the microprocessor 113.
  • a path 139 connects the data path logic 123 and the memory subsystem 107.
  • This path 139 is illustrated in FIG. 12 as including both a hardware path 139A and two logical paths 139B and 139C in the memory subsystem 107 of a processor module 33.
  • the hardware path 139A includes three branches as illustrated in FIG. 13.
  • a first branch 139A-1 transmits from memory into the channel memory data register 125.
  • a second path 139A-2 transmits from the channel memory address register 129 to memory.
  • a third path 139A-3 transmits from the input/output data register 127 to memory.
  • the input/output channel of a processor module 33 includes a control logic section 141.
  • This control logic section 141 in turn includes a T bus machine 143 (see FIG. 13) and request lines RECONNECT IN (RCI) 145, LOW PRIORITY INTERRUPT REQUEST (LIRQ) 147, HIGH PRIORITY INTERRUPT REQUEST (HIRQ) 149 and RANK 151 (see FIG. 14).
  • the I/O bus 39 shown in FIG. 14 and FIG. 12 also includes a group of channel function lines 153, 157 and 159. See also FIG. 13.
  • the TAG bus (T bus) 153 consists of four lines which serve as function lines, and there are three lines SERVICE OUT (SVO) 155, SERVICE IN (SVI) 157, and STOP IN (STI) 159 which serve as handshake lines as indicated by the legends in FIG. 14.
  • the I/O bus 39 also includes a group of data lines 161, 163, 165, 167 and 169.
  • the DATA BUS lines 161 and PARITY 163 are bidirectional and serve as data lines and as indicated in FIG. 14, there are sixteen DATA BUS lines 161 and one PARITY line 163 in this group.
  • the lines END OF TRANSFER (EOT) 165, PAD OUT (PADO) 167 and PAD IN (PADI) 169 serve as data status lines, and indicate special conditions that may occur on the data lines 161 and 163 from time-to-time.
  • I/O bus 39 includes a reset line (IORST) 171 as also shown in FIG. 14 and in FIG. 12.
  • IORST reset line
  • Each T bus command illustrated in FIG. 18 requires some specific format on the data bus 161 while a T bus command is valid. This specific data bus format is illustrated for the T bus functions Load Address and Command (LAC) and Read Device Status (RDST) shown in FIG. 18, for the preferred embodiment.
  • LAC Load Address and Command
  • RDST Read Device Status
  • the data or field transmitted on lines .0. to 5 of the data bus 161 specify the operation to be performed; the field transmitted on lines 8 to 12 of the data bus specify the device controller 41 (or more precisely the port 43 of that device controller which is attached to the data bus 161) to which the command is addressed; and the field transmitted on data bus lines 13 to 15 specify which device attached to the device controller is to be operated on by that device controller 41 in response to this command.
  • data bus bits .0., 1, 2 and 3 indicate ownership error, interrupt pending, device busy, and parity error respectively.
  • Bits 4 to 15 return device dependent status.
  • T bus The functions on the T bus are transmitted in three sequences, shown in FIGS. 15, 16 and 17 and described in detail below.
  • Each T bus function is asserted by the channel and a handshake sequence is performed between the channel 109 and the device controller 41 using the handshake lines 155, 157 and 159 to acknowledge receipt of the T bus function.
  • Control of the T bus and handshake is the function of the T bus machine 143 in FIG. 13.
  • FIG. 28 is a timing diagram showing the operation of the handshake between the I/O channel 109 and the ports 43.
  • line 155 transmits the service out signal (SVO) and line 157 transmits the service in signal (SVI).
  • the channel clock cycle as shown in vertical orientation with the SVO and SVI signals.
  • the service in (SVI) signal is not synchronized with the channel clock and may be asserted at any time by the device controller in response to a service out signal from the I/O channel 109.
  • the channel 109 Before asserting service out (SVO), the channel 109 asserts the T bus function and, if required, the data bus.
  • the channel then asserts a service out signal as indicated by the vertical rise 279 in FIG. 28; and, SVO remains true until the device controller responds with service in (SVI) (281), acknowledging the channel command; SVI remains true until the channel drops SVO.
  • SVI service in
  • the channel 109 removes the service out (SVO) signal (as shown by the vertical drop 283 in FIG. 28) in a time period typically between one and two clock cycles; and in response, the device controller drops service in (SVI) as shown by the vertical drop 285 in FIG. 28.
  • SVO service out
  • the channel 109 When the device controller drops the service in (SVI) signal, the channel 109 is free to reassert a service out signal (SVO) for the next transfer; however, the channel will not reassert SVO until SVI has been dropped.
  • SVI service in
  • SVO service out signal
  • the arrows 281A, 283A and 285A in FIG. 28 indicate the responses to the actions 279, 281, 283 respectively.
  • the handshake is completed at the trailing edge of the vertical drop 285 as shown in FIG. 28.
  • the interface data register 213 of the controller accepts the data at the leading edge of service out (vertical rise 279) and transfers the data to the control part of the device controller 187 at the trailing edge of the service out (the vertical drop 283).
  • the channel 109 accepts data from the device controller at the trailing edge of service out (the vertical drop 283).
  • a two line handshake is used to interlock transfer of information between the channel 109 and its device controller 41, since they act asynchronously.
  • handshake 2L This is the general handshake condition, indicated as handshake 2L in FIGS. 15, 16 and 17.
  • channel commands used to select a device controller are not handshaken by SVI, since no single device controller is selected during this time. These commands include (as shown in FIG. 18):
  • commands used to terminate a sequence are not handshaken by SVI since they cause a selected device controller to deselect itself.
  • the channel asserts SVO (155) for a given period of time (e.g., two clock cycles) and then the channel removes SVO.
  • This type of handshake is referred to as Handshake 1L in FIGS. 15, 16 and 17.
  • the channel when the channel prepares to assert SVO, it initiates a timer (part of T bus machine 143 in FIG. 13) which times out and posts an error if the next handshake cycle is not initiated and completed within the period of time set by the timer. If the timer times out, an error is posted at the appropriate point in the sequence, and either ABTI (EIO, IIO or HIIO sequence) or ABTD (reconnect sequence) is sent to the device controller 41 (see discussions of FIGS. 15, 16 and 17).
  • ABTI EIO, IIO or HIIO sequence
  • ABTD reconnect sequence
  • FIG. 29 shows the logic for the handshake shown in FIG. 28.
  • the logic shown in FIG. 29 is part of the T bus machine 143 shown in FIG. 13.
  • the logic shown in FIG. 29 is the logic which is effective for the general handshake condition noted above.
  • the logic shown in FIG. 29 includes a service out flip-flop 287 and a service in synchronization flip-flop 289. As illustrated by the dividing lines and legends in FIG. 29, the flip-flops 287 and 289 are physically located within the channel 109.
  • the device controller 41 includes combinational logic 291 and a transmitter 293 which transmits a service in signal (SVI) back to the D input of the flip-flop 289.
  • SVI service in signal
  • the channel 109 asserts service out by turning on the J input of the flip-flop 287; and when the next clock cycle starts, the service out signal is transmitted by a transmitter 295 to the device controller.
  • each of the dual ports 43 in a device controller 41 is connected by a physical connection 179 to interface common logic 181 (shown in more detail in FIG. 21) and each of the ports 43 is also associated through a logical connection 183 to the interface common logic 181 as determined by an ownership latch 185.
  • the interface common logic 181 is associated with the control part 187 of the device controller 41.
  • the control part 187 of the device controller includes a buffer 189.
  • the dual ports 43 shown in block diagram form in FIG. 19 (and in more detail in FIG. 23) are important parts of the multiprocessor system of the present invention because the dual ports provide the failsoft capability for the I/O system.
  • the ports 43 and related system components are structured in such a way that the two ports 43 of one device controller 41 are logically and physically independent of each other. As a result, no component part of one port 43 is also a component of the other port 43 of a particular device controller 41; and no single component failure (such as an integrated circuit failure) in one port can affect the operation of the other port.
  • Each port 43 functions to interface (as indicated by the legend in FIG. 19) a processor module 33 with a device controller, and ultimately with a particular device, through the device controller 41.
  • the port 43 is the entity that communicates with the processor module and communicates with the control part of the device controller 187 (conditional on the state of the ownership latch 185).
  • the port itself makes the connection to a processor module (dependent upon instructions received from the I/O channel 109 as discussed in more detail below) by setting its select bit 173.
  • Each of the individual ports 43 in a particular device controller 41 can be connected independently to a processor module 33 and at the same time as the other port in that device controller is connected to a different module.
  • the ownership latch 185 establishes the logical connection between the control part of the device controller and one of the dual ports 43 so that only one port has control of the device controller at any one point in time.
  • the decode logic determines what function is being transmitted on the T bus 153 at any particular time.
  • the control logic combines T bus functions to perform specific port functions, for example, set select bit, clear select bit, read interrupt status.
  • control logic The functioning of the control logic is illustrated in the logic equations set out in FIG. 27.
  • connection sequence (to be described later in reference to FIGS. 15, 16 and 17) is transmitted over the I/O bus 39
  • one of the ports 43 (and only the one port 43 in a device controller 41 attached to that I/O bus 39) connects (in a logical sense) to the bus 39 by setting its select bit 173.
  • This logical connection is determined by part of the data transmitted in that connection sequence.
  • that particular port 43 When connected, that particular port 43 subsequently responds to channel protocols in passing information between the channel and the control part of the device controller.
  • the device address comparator 193 is the component part of the port 43 that determines the port's unique address.
  • the device address comparator 193 determines the unique address for a particular port 43 by comparing the device address field on the data bus 161 during a LAC T bus function, with device address jumpers associated with a particular port 43.
  • the term ADDCOMP (see FIG. 27) is generated and the select bit 173 for that port is set (assuming that the other conditions set out in FIG. 27 allow the select bit to be set).
  • the port 43 then responds to all T bus operations until the sequence terminates by clearing the select bit.
  • the parity check register 177 is related to the parity generator and check logic 137 of FIG. 13 in that on output the parity generator logic 137 generates the parity to be checked by the parity checker 177 of the port 43, and this parity must check or the operation will be aborted by the I/O channel 109 of the processor module 33. On input, the interface common logic 181 generates parity to be checked by the channel parity check logic 137 in a similar fashion.
  • the parity check is started before data is loaded into the register, and the parity check is continued until after the data has been fully loaded into the register. That is, the parity on the D bus is checked by the port parity register whenever the channel asserts SVO with an output T bus function, and the parity is monitored for the duration of SVO to insure that the data on the D bus is stable for the duration of SVO while the port transfers the data into the data register 213.
  • This parity check occurs on each transaction in a T bus sequence; and if a parity error occurred during any transaction in the sequence, the error is returned as a status bit in response to a T bus function during a sequence.
  • the P bit return for RDST indicates that the port determined a parity error during the EIO sequence.
  • the parity error bit is a bit number 3 on the D bus in response to a RDST function on the T bus.
  • the parity error is reported during the read interrupt status (RIST) T bus function similar to the manner described above for the RDST T bus function.
  • the parity error is cleared at the beginning of an EIO, IIO, HIIO or reconnect sequence as shown in FIG. 24.
  • parity check register If a parity error is detected during any sequence it is recorded by the parity check register to be returned on the D bus in response to a RDST or RIST T bus function.
  • the function of the enable latch 175 in the port 43 is to allow the I/O system to recover from a certain class of errors that would otherwise render inoperative both of the I/O buses 39 attached to a particular device controller 41.
  • the enable latch 175 accomplishes this by not allowing the port 43 to place any signals on the I/O bus 39.
  • the enable latch 175 is cleared by a specific disable command.
  • This is a load address and command (LAC) T bus function with a specific operation code transmitted on the D bus 161.
  • LAC load address and command
  • the port 43 includes a status multiplexer 195.
  • the status multiplexer 195 returns the ownership error mentioned above if the device controller 41 is logically connected to the other port 43 of that device controller, to indicate that the device controller is owned by the other port and commands to this port will be ignored.
  • the port 43 includes an interface transceiver 197 for each input line (i.e., SVI, STI, Data Bus, Parity, PADI, RCI, LIRQ, HIRQ) of the I/O bus 39 shown in FIG. 14.
  • the transceivers 197 transmit data from the port 43 to the I/O channel 109 when the port select bit 173 is set and the T bus function on the T bus 153 requires that the device controller 41 return information to the channel.
  • the transceivers 197 pass information from the data bus 161 into the port 43 at all times.
  • the power on circuit 182 acts in association with the transceivers 197 to control the behavior of the transceivers as the device controller 41 is powered up or powered down, in a way which prevents erroneous signals from being placed on the I/O bus while power is going up or down. This feature is particularly significant from the standpoint of on line maintenance.
  • each transceiver 197 comprises a receiver 198 and a transmitter 200.
  • the transmitter is enabled by an enable line 202.
  • the signal from the PON circuit in a particular embodiment of the present invention, is connected in a "wire or" connection to the output of the gate which combines the other terms so that the output of the PON circuit overrides the other terms by pulling down the enable line 202.
  • the PON circuit output stage is designed to take advantage of a property of the specific transceiver integrated circuit used. On this particular type IC if the driver enable line 202 is held below two diode drops above ground potential, the transmitter output transistors are forced into the off state regardless of the level of power applied to the integrated circuit. This ensures that the driver cannot drive the bus.
  • This particular combination of features provides a mode of operation wherein the output of the integrated circuit is controlled as power comes up or goes down, whereas normally the output of an integrated circuit is undefined when power drops below a certain level.
  • each central processor unit (CPU) 105 has a PON circuit 182 whioh is similar to the PON circuit 182 in the device controller. The PON circuits therefore control the transmitters for all of the device controllers 41 and all of the interprocessor controls 55.
  • FIG. 25 Details of the power-on (PON) circuit are shown in FIG. 25 where the circuit is indicated generally by the reference numeral 182.
  • the purpose of the PON circuit is to sense two different voltage levels of the five volt supply.
  • the circuit senses the point at which power drops below a certain level which renders the logic in the device controller or CPU an indeterminate state or condition. At this point the circuit supplies signals to protect the system against the logic which subsequently goes into an undefinable state.
  • the second voltage level which the PON circuit will sense is a value that is perceived when power is coming up. This second level at which power is sensed will be greater than the first level by roughly 100 millivolts to provide hysteresis for the system to eliminate any conditions of oscillation.
  • the PON circuit stays in a stable condition after it senses one of the voltage conditions until it senses the other voltage condition, at which point it changes state.
  • the state at which the PON circuit is in at any particular time determines the voltage level at which the transition to the other state will be made.
  • the power on circuit 182 thus presents a signal establishing an indication that the power is within predetermined, acceptable operating limits for the device controller 41. If the power is not within those predetermined, acceptable operating limits, the signal output of the power-on circuit 182 is used to directly disable the appropriate bus signals of the device controller 41.
  • the output of the PON circuit 182 is a binary output. If the output is a one, the power is within satisfactory limits. If the output of the PON circuit is a zero, this is an indication that the power is below the acceptable limit.
  • the power-on circuit 182 shown in FIG. 25 and to be described in detail below is used with the device controller 41 and has seven output driver stages which are used in the application of the power-on circuit 182 to the device controller 41. However, the same power-on circuit 182 is also used with the CPU 105 and the bus controller 37, but in those applications the power-on circuit will have a lesser number of output driver stages.
  • the PON circuit 182 comprises a current source 184 and a differential amplifier 186.
  • the differential amplifier 186 has, as one input, a temperature compensated reference voltage input on a line 188 and has a second input on a line 190 which is an indication of the voltage that is to be sensed by the power-on circuit.
  • the reference voltage on line 188 is established by a zener diode 192.
  • the differential amplifier 186 comprises a matched pair of transistors 194 and 196.
  • the voltage applied on the line 190 is determined by resistors 198, 200 and 202.
  • the resistors 198, 200 and 202 are metal film resistors which provide a high degree of temperature stability in the PON circuit.
  • the outputs on lines 204 and 206 of the differential amplifier 186 are applied to a three transistor array (the transistors 208, 210 and 212), and this three transistor array in turn controls the main output control transistor 214.
  • the main output control transistor 214 drives all output drivers that are attached.
  • the main output transistor 214 drives output stages 216 through 228.
  • the output stage 216 is used to clear the logic
  • the output stages 218, 220 and 222 are used in combination with the interface devices of one port 43 of the device controller 41
  • the output stages 224, 226 and 228 are used in combination with the interface device of the other port 43 of the device controller 41.
  • the PON circuit 182 includes a hysteresis control 230.
  • the hysteresis control 230 includes resistors 232, 234 and a transistor 236.
  • the power is applied through the current source 182 to the differential amplifier 186 and to the main output control transistor 214.
  • the voltage on the line 190 is less than the voltage on the line 188 so the differential amplifier 186 holds the output of the main output control transistor 214 in the off state. This, in turn, will force the output stages 216 through 228 on.
  • the differential amplifier 186 drives the main output control transistor 214, turning it on. This removes the base drive from the output stages 216 through 228, forcing these output stages off.
  • the output of the PON circuit 182 is then a one, indicating that the power is within acceptable limits.
  • the hysteresis control circuit 230 comes into play. While power was coming on, the transistor 236 of the hysteresis control circuit 230 was on. When the transistor 236 is on, the resistance value of the resistor 202 appears to be less than the resistance value of this resistor 202 is when the transistor 236 is off.
  • the point at which the main output control transistor 214 turns on is the point at which the hysteresis transistor 236 turns off. Turning off the hysteresis transistor 236 causes a slight voltage jump in the line 190 which further latches the differential amplifier 186 into the condition where the differential amplifier 186 sustains the main output transistor 214 in the on state.
  • the state of the PON circuit will remain stable in this condition with the main output control transistor 214 on and the output drivers 216 through 228 off until the plus five volts drops below a lower threshold point, as determined by the voltage applied on the line 190.
  • the differential amplifier 186 turns off the main output control transistor 214. This, in turn, turns on the output driver stages 216 through 228.
  • the voltage applied to the input of the PON circuit 182 must drop somewhat farther than the point at which the PON circuit 182 sensed that power was within the acceptable limits during the power-up phase of operation.
  • This differential or hysteresis is used to inhibit any noise on the five volt power supply from causing any oscillation in the circuit that would erroneously indicate that power is failing.
  • the PON circuit 182 shown in FIG. 25 provides very accurate sensing of the two voltages used by the PON circuit to determine its state (whether a one or a zero output of the PON circuit).
  • the PON circuit In order to sense these two voltages very accurately the PON circuit must have the capability of compensating for initial tolerances of the different components and also the capability to compensate for changes in temperature during operation.
  • the zener diode 192 In the PON circuit 182, the zener diode 192 is the only critical part that must be compensated for because of its initial tolerance, and this compensation is provided by selecting the resistor 198.
  • Temperature compensation is achieved because the zener diode 192 is an active zener diode and is not a passive zener diode. Effective temperature compensation is also achieved because the two transistors in the differential amplifier 186 are a matched pair of transistors and the resistors 198, 200 and 202 are metal film resistors.
  • Each port 43 includes a number of lines which are indicated by the general reference numeral 179 in FIG. 20 and FIG. 19.
  • This group of lines 179 includes the individual lines 201 (sixteen (16) of which make up the Input Bus - I Bus), device address lines 203, Output Bus lines 205 (of which there are sixteen), a take ownership line 207 and general lines 209 which transmit such signals as parity, the T bus, and other similar lines which are required because of the particular hardware implementation.
  • FIG. 21 is the block diagram of the interface common logic.
  • the interface common logic 181 is associated with each of the dual ports 43 in a device controller 41.
  • the interface common logic 181 includes the ownership latch 185 (see also FIG. 19). This ownership latch determines the logical connection between the interface common logic 181 and a port 43 from which TAKE OWNERSHIP signal has been received over the line 207.
  • the TAKE OWNERSHIP signal is derived by the port hardware from a load address and command (LAC) T bus command (see FIG. 18) with a particular operation code in the command field on the D bus.
  • LAC load address and command
  • the port logic examines the command field (the top six bits) on the D bus. Then, if the command field contains a code specifying a take ownership command, the port hardware issues a signal to set the ownership latch to connect the port to the interface common logic and thence to the control part of the device controller. If the command field specifies a kill command, the port hardware issues a signal to clear the port's enable latch.
  • This operation happens only if the device address field on the D bus matches the port's device address jumpers, and no parity error is detected during the command. That is, no commands (including the take ownership, kill, etc.) are executed if a parity error is detected on the LAC.
  • the I/O channel 109 issuing the Take Ownership command gains control of the device controller 41, and the other port 43 is logically disconnected. Take Ownership may also cause a hard clear of the controller's internal state.
  • the state of the ownership latch 185 determines which port may pass information through the multiplexer 211. Once the ownership latch 185 is set in a given direction, it stays in that state until a Take Ownership command is received by the other port. Assertion of the I/O reset line (IORST) will also cause ownership to be given to the other port after the internal state of the device controller has been cleared.
  • IORST I/O reset line
  • Control signals are chosen by the state of the ownership register 185 and from the appropriate one of the ports 43 and are transmitted by the multiplexer 211 to the control part 187 of a device controller on a set of control lines 215.
  • Data are selected from an appropriate one of the ports 43 on lines 205 and are loaded into the data register 213 and presented to the controller on an Output Bus (O bus) 217.
  • O bus Output Bus
  • control lines 215 are used to control the multiplexer 220 in selecting information from the controller as transmitted on lines 219, to be returned by the input bus (I bus) 201 to the ports 43 (FIG. 20) and then to the channel 109 of a processor module 33.
  • a line 221 returns the device address from the appropriate port 43 to the I bus 201 and thence to the I/O channel 109.
  • the data buffer 189 shown in FIG. 19 is illustrated in more detail in FIG. 22.
  • many of the device controllers 41 incorporate a multiword buffer for receiving information at a relatively slow rate from a peripheral device and then transmitting that information at or near memory speed to the processor module to maximize channel bandwidth utilization.
  • the device controllers 41 In the buffer design itself it is important that the device controllers 41 be able to cooperate with each other in gaining access to the channel 109 to avoid error conditions. In order for the device controllers 41 to cooperate properly, the multiword buffers 189 are constructed to follow certain guidelines.
  • Buffer Threshold abbreviated T in FIG. 23.
  • the buffer depth (D in FIG. 23) is the sum of the holdoff depth plus the threshold depth.
  • the holdoff and threshold depths are a function of a number of variables. These include the device rate, the channel rate, the memory speed, the reconnect time, the number of controllers of higher priority on that I/O bus, the number of controllers of lower priority on that I/O bus, and the maximum burst length permissible.
  • a controller at high priority on an I/O bus has more controllers of lower priority associated with it on the same I/O bus than another controller at lower priority on the same I/O bus, and therefore the higher priority controller requires more holdoff depth than the lower priority controller.
  • a controller at low priority on an I/O bus requires more threshold depth than a controller at higher priority.
  • the buffer 189 in a controller is constructed to take advantage of the fact that as holdoff requirement increases the threshold requirement decreases, and as the threshold requirement increases the holdoff requirement decreases. This is accomplished by making the stress at which a reconnect request is made be variable, the actual setting depending on the characteristics of the controllers at higher and lower priority in a particular I/O channel configuration.
  • the buffer depth is therefore the maximum of the worst-case threshold depth or worst-case holdoff depth requirement, rather than the sum of the worst-case threshold depth and worst-case holdoff depth. This allows the buffer depth to be minimized, and shortens the time required to fill or empty the buffer.
  • time has been plotted on the horizontal axis versus words in the buffer on the vertical axis for an output operation.
  • the transfer of data continues from the buffer at the rate indicated by the line of slope -R D and the request is held off by higher priority device controllers 41 until point 225 at which point the request is honored by the channel 109, and the I/O channel begins its reconnect sequence for this device controller.
  • the channel 109 transfers data words at a rate indicated by the line of slope R C into the buffer 189.
  • the device controller 41 continues to transfer data words out of the buffer at the rate -R D so that the overall rate of input to the buffer 189 is indicated by the line of slope R C -R D until the buffer is again filled at the point 229.
  • the buffer is full, and the device controller disconnects from the channel 109, and the data transfer continues at the rate indicated by the slope line -R C .
  • the notation t r in FIG. 23 indicates the time required for the polling and selection of this device controller and the transfer of the first word. This will be discussed again below in relation to FIG. 16.
  • the letter B in FIG. 23 indicates the burst time.
  • the burst time is a dynamic parameter. The length of any particular burst is dependent upon the device transfer rate, the channel transfer rate, the number of devices with transfers in progress and the channel reconnect time. The maximum time permitted for a burst is chosen to minimize the amount of buffer depth required while accomodating high device transfer rates and also the number of devices that can transfer concurrently.
  • FIG. 22 is a block diagram of a particular embodimcnt of a buffer 189 constructed in accordance with the present invention to accomplish the holdoff and threshold requirements illustrated in FIG. 23.
  • the buffer 189 shown in FIG. 22 comprises an input buffer 231, a buffer memory 233, an output buffer 235, an input pointer 237, an output pointer 239, a multiplexer 241, buffer control logic 243 (described in more detail in FIG. 26), a multiplexer 245 connected to the buffer control logic 243 and a stress counter 247.
  • two groups of data input lines are fed into the input buffer 231.
  • One group of data input lines include sixteen device data input lines 249.
  • the other group of input lines include sixteen Output Bus lines (O bus lines) 217.
  • One or the other of these two groups of input signals is then fed from the input buffer 231 to the buffer memory 233 by a group of lines 251. There are sixteen of the lines 251.
  • Data is taken from the buffer memory 233 and put into the output buffer 235 by a group of lines 253. There are sixteen of the lines 253.
  • the output buffer 335 transmits the data back to the interface common logic 181 (see FIG. 19 and FIG. 21) on a group of sixteen lines 219 and to the devices 45, 47 (such as 49, 51, 53 shown in FIG. 1) on a group of sixteen lines 255 as indicated by the legends in FIG. 22.
  • the input and output pointers 237 and 239 function with the multiplexer 241 as follows.
  • the input pointer 237 is connected to the buffer memory 233 through the multiplexer 241 to determine the location into which the word is written.
  • the output pointer 239 is connected to the buffer memory 233 through the multiplexer 241 to determine the location from which the word is taken.
  • the purpose of the buffer control logic 243 illustrated in FIG. 22 and FIG. 26 is to keep track of the stress placed on the buffer 189.
  • the degree of the full or empty condition of the buffer in combination with the direction of the transfer with respect to the processor module (whether input or output) determines the degree of stress. Stress increases as the device accesses the buffer and decreases as the channel accesses the buffer.
  • the stress counter measures increasing stress from 0-15 on an input, and decreasing stress from 0-15 on an output.
  • Another implementation would add the direction of transfer in the buffer oontrol logic such that two new lines would access the pointers 237 and 239 and the stress counter would always measure increasing stress.
  • a channel request line 215 (see also FIG. 21) and a device request line 257 (coming from the control part 187 of the device controller) are asserted to indicate access to the buffer 189.
  • the multiplexer 245 chooses one of these lines as a request to increase the buffer fullness and chooses the other line as a request to decrease the buffer fullness based on the direction of the transfer (whether input or output) with respect to the processor module.
  • the line chosen to increase buffer fullness is also used to load data from the appropriate data lines 249 or 217 (see FIG. 22) into the input buffer 231 by means of the line 259.
  • the channel and the device may access the buffer 189 at the same time, and the buffer control logic 243 services one request at a time.
  • the buffer control logic 243 chooses one of the lines for service and holds the other line off until the buffer control logic 243 has serviced the first request, then it services the other request.
  • the servicing of a request by the buffer control logic 243 includes the following.
  • the buffer control logic 243 asserts line 263 which does three things.
  • (A) It writes the word from the input buffer 231 into the buffer memory 233 at the location determined by the input pointer 237 and the multiplexer 241.
  • the buffer control logic 243 asserts line 265 which accomplishes the following three operations.
  • the buffer control logic 243 writes the word being read from the buffer memory 233 as determined by the output pointer 239 and multiplexer 241 into the output buffer 235.
  • the stress counter 247 determines when the buffer 189 is full (D), or at threshold depth (T) as shown by the output line legends in FIG. 22.
  • the output of the stress counter is decoded, and any one of the decoded values may be used to specify that the buffer is at threshold depth.
  • wire jumpers are used to select one of sixteen possible stress values, and a reconnect request is made to the channel 109 when the stress on the buffer 189 reaches that value.
  • the control part 187 of the device controller uses these three signals (which correspond to the legends in FIG. 23) to make reconnect requests and disconnect requests on respective lines 145 (see FIG. 14 and FIG. 12) and 159 (see FIG. 14 and FIG. 12).
  • the STI (stop in) signal transmitted on line 159 shown in FIG. 14 and FIG. 12 is related to the buffer depth (D), the full or empty conditions of the buffer and the direction of transfer; and the RCI (reconnect in) signal on line 145 of FIG. 14 and FIG. 12 is related to the threshold depth (T) indication from the stress counter 247 in FIG. 22.
  • the STI signal is asserted when the buffer 189 reaches a condition of minimum stress (full on output and empty on input).
  • the STI signal signals the channel 109 that the controller 41 wishes to terminate the burst data transfer.
  • the buffer passes through its threshold it asserts the RCI signal on line 145 to indicate to the channel 109 that the buffer wishes to transfer a burst of data.
  • FIG. 26 shows details of the multiplexer 245, the buffer control logic 243 and the stress counter 247 of the buffer 189 shown in FIG. 22.
  • the multiplexer 245 is shown as two sets of gates 245A and 245B, request flip-flops 267A and 267B, a clock flip-flop 269, request synchronization flip-flops 271A and 271B, a priority resolving gate 273 and request execution gates 275A and 275B.
  • the stress counter 247 comprises a counter section 247A and a decoder section 247B as indicated by the legends in FIG. 26.
  • the two sets of gates 245A and 245B have used the channel request signal (line 215) and the device request signal (line 257) and the read and write signals to determine which of the channel or the device is putting data onto the buffer 189 and which is taking data out of the buffer 189.
  • the request flip-flops 267A and 267B store the requests until the control logic has serviced the request.
  • the clock flip-flop 269 generates a two phase clock used by the request synchronization flip-flops 271A and 271B and the request execution gates 275A and 275B.
  • the request synchronization flip-flops 271A and 271B synchronize the request to the clock generation flip-flop 269 and stabilize the request for execution.
  • the priority resolving gate 273 picks one of the requests for execution and causes the other request to be held off.
  • the request execution gates 275A and 275B execute the requests in dependence on the synchronized request.
  • Each output signal on the lines 263 and 265 performs the functions described above (incrementing and decrementing the stress counter, updating the buffer memory or output buffer, and updating the input pointer or output pointer).
  • each signal clears the appropriate request flip-flop through the lines 277A and 277B illustrated in FIG. 26.
  • FIGS. 15, 16 and 17 show the three sequences of operation of the I/O system.
  • the normal data transfer between a processor module 33 and a particular device, such as a disc 45 includes an EIO sequence to initiate the transfer.
  • the EIO instruction selects the particular device controller and device and specifies the operation to be performed.
  • the device controller 41 initiates the I/O between the device controller 41 and the particular device.
  • the device controller 41 periodically reconnects to the channel 109 and transfers data between the device controller 41 and the channel 109.
  • the periodic reconnection may be for the purpose of either transferring data from the channel to the device or for the purpose of transferring data from the device to the channel.
  • the device controller 41 interrupts the CPU 105, which responds by issuing an IIO or an HIIO sequence.
  • the IIO sequence determines the identity of the interrupting device and conditions under which the transfer completed.
  • the HIIO sequence is similar to the IIO sequence but is issued in response to a high priority I/O interrupt.
  • EIO Executecute I/O
  • the first state shown in FIG. 15 is the no-operation (NOP) or idle state.
  • the other states are the same as those listed in FIG. 18 by the corresponding mnemonics--load address and command (LAC), load parameter (LPRM), read device status (RDST), deselect (DSEL) and abort instruction (ABTI).
  • LAC mnemonics--load address and command
  • LPRM load parameter
  • RDST read device status
  • DSEL deselect
  • ABTI abort instruction
  • the solid line arrows indicate a state change
  • a dashed line arrow indicates a condition which must occur before a state change can occur.
  • the EIO instruction and execution shown in FIG. 15 is directly under control of the microprocessor 113 (see FIG. 12) of the CPU 105.
  • This CPU initiation is shown as transmitted to the state machine in FIG. 15 by the line 117; the initiation signal is accepted only when the T bus is in the idle state.
  • the T bus goes from the NOP (idle) state to the LAC state.
  • this word is used to select a particular device controller 41 and a partioular peripheral device 45, 47, 49, 51 or 53 (see FIG. 1), and the word is also used to specify the operation to be performed.
  • the word just below the top of the register stack in the CPU 105 is put on the T bus 161 (see FIG. 14) by the I/O channel 109 and is passed to the device controller 41 selected during the previous LAC state.
  • LPRM load parameter state
  • the T bus goes to the RDST state.
  • the device controller 41 returns the device status (the status of a particular device selected and comprising the set of signals describing the state of that device) from the device controller 41 and places it on the top of the register stack 112 in the CPU 105.
  • T bus machine 143 goes from the RDST state to the abort instruction (ABTI) state.
  • the ABTI state instructs the device controller 41 to ignore the previous LAC and LPRM information passed to it by the I/O channel 109 and then the T bus (channel) returns to the NOP (idle) state.
  • the T bus goes to the deselect state (DSEL).
  • the device controller 41 clears its select latch 173 and responds to the instruction issued to it (passed to it during the LAC state) and the T bus returns to the NOP (idle) state.
  • a reconnect signal may be generated after an EIO sequence to request that the channel transfer data to the controller.
  • the device controller 41 may assert an interrupt request line under a number of different conditions, e.g. to signal the completion of an EIO sequence or to report an unusual condition in a peripheral device.
  • the device request lines are common to all device controller ports 43 attached to a particular I/O bus 39.
  • the channel 109 responds to reconnect requests made on the line RCI (145 of FIG. 14), and the CPU 105 responds to requests made on the LIRQ line 147 (see also FIG. 14) with an IIO sequence, and to a request made on the HIRQ line 149 with an HIIO sequence.
  • the first thing that the channel 109 or CPU 105 does in response to a Device Request signal is to determine the identity of the highest priority device controller 41 asserting a request. That is, there may be several device controllers 41 asserting a request to the channel 109 at one time, and the channel will select a particular device controller in accordance with a predetermined priority scheme.
  • up to thirty-two device controllers 41 can be connected to a single channel 109.
  • the thirty-two device controllers are connected in a star poll using the sixteen bit data bus 161.
  • One additional line 151 is used to divide the thirty-two device controllers into two groups of sixteen each.
  • One group of sixteen device controllers is assigned priority over the other group; and priority is also assigned among the sixteen within each group.
  • the device responding on bit zero of the D bus during a polling sequence has the highest priority within a rank, and the one responding on bit 15 has the lowest priority.
  • polling involves the state descriptions shown in FIG. 16 and 17 up to and including that handshake which occurs during the select (SEL) state in each figure.
  • the channel 109 sets the rank line to zero and then presents the T bus function RPOL (FIG. 16) if the response is to a reconnect request, while the CPU 105 presents an LPOL (FIG. 17) T bus function if the CPU is responding with an IIO sequence, or an HPOL T bus function if the CPU is responding with an HIIO sequence.
  • RPOL RPOL
  • LPOL LPOL
  • T bus function if the CPU is responding with an IIO sequence
  • HPOL T bus function if the CPU is responding with an HIIO sequence.
  • the channel 109 transfers the D bus response into the priority resolve register 135 (see FIG. 13).
  • This priority resolve register 135 output determines which device controller has the highest priority (in accordance with the scheme described above) and asserts the appropriate bit back onto the D bus 161, if there is a bit asserted in rank zero by the attached device controllers.
  • the output of the priority resolve register is presented to all device controllers attached, along with the select function (SEL) on the T bus, and the device controller whose priority on rank zero matches the output of the priority resolve register sets its select bit 173 (see FIG. 19), and then that port will respond to subsequent states in the sequence.
  • This is the mode of operation indicated by the solid line arrow going from the state indicated by RPOL with a rank equals zero to select (SEL).
  • the channel 109 sets the rank line to one and reissues the RPOL T bus command. Then, if the priority resolving register determines that a response occurred on rank 1, the channel asserts the T bus select function as before.
  • the channel returns to the idle state indicated by state NOP in FIG. 16.
  • This latter event is an example of a failure which might occur in one port 43 and which would result in the system 31 accessing that particular device controller 41 through the other port 43.
  • the action of the priority resolving register 135 in response to an IIO or an HIIO sequence initiated by the CPU 105 is the same as the response of the priority resolving register 135 to a reconnect sequence initiated by the channel in response to a reconnect in on the line 145 from a device controller 41.
  • reconnect sequence begins with the poll sequence described above for reconnecting the highest priority device controller 41 making a request.
  • the next step in the reconnect sequence is to determine the actual device controller number contained in the device address comparator 193.
  • the device address comparator 193 includes jumpers to determine a physical device controller number. These are the same jumpers that are used on a LAC T bus function during an EIO sequence to determine a particular port. In the reconnect sequence the address determined by these jumpers is returned to the I/O channel via the D bus during the T bus RAC state to access a table defining the buffer area for this device.
  • the channel asserts the RAC T bus function and the device controller 41 returns the device controller address and the transfer direction.
  • the channel uses the device address returned by the device controller 41 to access a two word entry (142) in an I/O control table (IOC) 140 (FIG. 12) which defines a buffer area 138 in the memory 107 for this particular device controller and device.
  • IOC I/O control table
  • the format of a two word entry 142 is shown enlarged in FIG. 12 to show details of the fields of the two words.
  • IOC table 140 There is a two word entry 142 in the IOC table 140 for each of the eight possible devices of each of the thirty-two possible device controllers 41 attached to an I/O bus 39 associated with a particular processor module 33, and each processor module 33 has its own IOC table.
  • Each two word entry describes the buffer location in main memory and remaining length to be transferred at any particular time for a particular data transfer to a particular device.
  • the upper word specifies the transfer address to or from which the transfer will be made by a burst; and the lower word specifies the byte count specifying the remaining length of the buffer area and the status of the transfer.
  • the fields representing the status of the transfer include a protect bit P and a channel error field CH ERR.
  • the channel error field comprises three bits which can be set to indicate any one of up to seven numbered errors.
  • the transfer address and byte count are updated in the IOC table 140 at the conclusion of each reconnect and data transfer sequence (burst).
  • the transfer address is counted up and the byte count is counted down at the conclusion of each burst.
  • the amount reflects the number of bytes transferred during the burst.
  • the second word also contains (1) a field in which any error encountered during a reconnect and data transfer sequence may be posted for later analysis, and (2) a protect bit to specify that the buffer area in memory 107 may be read from but not written into.
  • the protect bit serves to protect the processor memory 107 from a failure in the device controller 41. That is, when the device controller 41 returned the transfer direction to the channel 109 during a read address and command (RAC) T bus function, a failure in the device controller 41 could cause the device controller to erroneously specify an input transfer. Then the channel would go to the IN state and transfer data from the device controller into memory, thus causing data in the buffer 138 to be lost.
  • the protect bit allows the program to specify that the channel may not write into this buffer area; that is, the device may only specify an output transfer.
  • the transfer address specifies the logical path 139B (see FIG. 12).
  • the channel places the transfer address in the channel memory address register 129 (see FIG. 13) and places the byte count in the character count register 131 (see FIG. 13).
  • the channel puts the T bus in either the IN state or OUT state and transfers data between the device controller 41 and memory 107 using the channel memory address register 129 to specify the logical path 139C (see FIG. 12).
  • the channel memory address register 129 and character count register 131 are updated with each word transferred during the burst to reflect the next address in the buffer and the number of characters yet to be transferred.
  • the contents of the channel memory address register 129 and of the character count register 131 are written into the IOC table 140.
  • the channel 109 accepts the word by the handshake mechanism described above and places the word in the I/O data register 127 (see FIG. 13) and then transfers the word to the buffer area in memory defined by the logical path 139C (see FIG. 12).
  • the channel 109 takes a word from the buffer area over logical path 139C and transfers the word to the channel memory data register 125.
  • the channel then transfers the word into the I/O data register 127 (FIG. 13) and handshakes with the device controller which accepts the word into its interface data register 213.
  • the high speed of the I/O channel is accomplished by pipelining where the word in the I/O data register 127 is handshaken to the device while the channel concurrently requests and accepts the next word in the transfer from memory 107 and places it in the channel memory data register 125. Since it takes just as long to put a word out to the device as it does to accept a word from memory for the device, the two operations can be overlapped.
  • the channel decremented the character count register by two for every word transferred, since there are two bytes in every word.
  • the burst transfer can terminate in two ways.
  • the burst transfer can terminate normally or the burst transfer can terminate with an error condition.
  • the character count register 131 can reach a count of either one or two bytes remaining to be transferred. In this situation the channel puts up EOT (line 165 as shown in FIG. 14) signifying that the end of transfer has been reached. If the count reaches one, then the channel asserts EOT and PAD OUT (line 167 of FIG. 14) signifying the end of transfer with an odd byte.
  • the device controller 41 responds by asserting STOP IN (STI) on line 159 (see FIG. 14), and the device controller 41 also asserts PAD IN (PADI) on line 169 (FIG. 14) if the channel asserted PAD OUT (PADO).
  • STOP IN STI
  • PAD IN PADI
  • the STOP IN (STI) can occur on an output transfer or on an input transfer.
  • the device controller 41 can assert STOP IN (STI); and, to signify an odd byte on the last word, the device controller 41 can also assert PAD IN (PADI).
  • STOP IN STOP IN
  • PADI PAD IN
  • the channel 109 updates the IOC table entries as noted above, and returns to the idle (NOP) state shown in FIG. 16.
  • the transfer can also be terminated by an error condition.
  • the device controller 41 may request an input transfer into a buffer whose protect bit P is set in the IOC table as mentioned above.
  • the device controller 41 may not return a PAD IN (PADI) signal in response to a PAD OUT (PADO) signal from the channel 109.
  • PADI PAD IN
  • PADO PAD OUT
  • the channel 109 may detect a parity error on the D bus 161.
  • the device controller 41 may not respond to a SERVICE OUT (SVO) signal from the channel 109 within the allotted time as mentioned above in the discussion on handshakes.
  • SVO SERVICE OUT
  • the buffer area specified by the IOC table entries may cross into a page whose map marks it absent (see the discussion of the mapping scheme in the memory system).
  • a parity error may be detected in accessing the map while accessing the memory during the reconnect in and data transfer sequence. See the description in the memory system relating to the parity error check.
  • the memory system may detect an uncorrectable parity error when the channel 109 accesses the memory. See the description of the memory system for this parity error check.
  • the channel 109 goes to the abort data transfer state (ABTD) as shown in FIG. 16. This instructs the device controller 41 that an error has occurred and that the data transfer should be aborted. The channel 109 then goes back to the idle state which is (NOP) as shown in FIG. 16.
  • ABTD abort data transfer state
  • NOP idle state
  • the channel 109 updates the IOC table entries and puts an error number indicating one of the seven errors noted above in the error field of the second word of the IOC table entry as mentioned above.
  • the number of that error is entered in the error field of the IOC table entry.
  • the channel 109 selects the error from which recovery is least likely to occur and enters only the number of that error in the error field of the IOC table entry.
  • the device controller 41 may try to reconnect to the channel when the count word in the IOC table is zero. In this event, the channel will not let the device controller reconnect and the channel goes through the sequence as described above with reference to FIG. 16, but when the channel determines that the count word in the IOC table is zero, the channel 109 goes directly to the abort (ABTD) state. This is an important feature of the present invention because it protects the processor memory from being overwritten by a failing device.
  • the channel issues an abort (ABTD) to the device controller 41 as noted above and leaves the channel error field of the two word entry 142 at zero.
  • ABTD abort
  • the device controller 41 In response to an abort data (ABTD) T bus function, the device controller 41 makes an interrupt request on the line HIRQ or LIRQ (lines 149 or 147 as shown in FIG. 14) to the channel 109.
  • ABTD abort data
  • the device controllers 41 may at any time request an interrupt on these two lines.
  • An interrupt generally indicates that a data transfer has been completed or terminated by an abort from the channel (an ABTD from the channel) or by an error condition within the device controller 41 or attached device, or that a special condition has occurred within the device controller or an attached device. For example, when the power is applied and the PON circuit indicates that power is at an acceptable level, the device controller interrupts the processor module to indicate that its internal state is Reset because power was off or had failed and has been reset by the PON circuit.
  • the program running within the processor module 33 issues an interrogate I/O instruction (IIO) or an interrogate high priority I/O instruction (HIIO) over the I/O bus 39.
  • IIO interrogate I/O instruction
  • HIIO interrogate high priority I/O instruction
  • the IIO instruction is issued in response to a low priority I/O interrupt, that is, one issued on the low priority interrupt request (LIRQ) line 147 (see FIG. 14).
  • LIRQ low priority interrupt request
  • the HIIO instruction is issued in response to a high priority I/O interrupt, that is, one requested on a high priority interrupt request (HIRQ) line 149 (see FIG. 14).
  • HIRQ high priority interrupt request
  • the microprocessor 113 executes the EIO, IIO or HIIO instruction by taking control of the channel control logic 141 and data path logic 123.
  • LPOL T bus function low priority interrupt poll
  • HPOL T bus function high priority interrupt poll
  • the polling sequence which is also described above completes by selecting the appropriate device controller 41 by using the T bus function select (SEL) as shown in FIG. 17.
  • the appropriate device controller 41 selected is that device controller which has the highest priority and is making an interrupt request.
  • the sequence continues with a read interrupt cause (RIC) T bus function as shown in FIG. 17.
  • the device controller 41 responds by returning device dependent status on the D bus 161 (see FIG. 14).
  • the microprocessor 113 (FIG. 12) reads the status from the D bus 161 and places the status on the top of the register stack 112 (FIG. 12).
  • the sequence then continues with a read interrupt status (RIST) T bus function as shown in FIG. 17.
  • the device controller 41 responds to this RIST T bus function by returning the device controller number, the unit number and four dedicated status bits on the D bus.
  • ABTD abort
  • parity error parity error
  • the mioroprocessor 113 oopies the content of the D bus--the controller number, the device number and the interrupt status--and places that content on the top of the register stack 112.
  • the channel goes from the RIST state to the abort instruction (ABTI) state as shown in FIG. 17. This deselects the device controller 41, and then the channel 109 goes back into the idle (NOP) state as shown by the bottom line in FIG. 17.
  • ABTI abort instruction
  • NOP idle
  • an I/O operation between a processor module and an I/O device typically consists of a group of sequences, e.g. an EIO followed by some number of reconnect and data transfer sequences, terminating with an IIO sequence. Sequences from several different I/O operations may be interleaved, resulting in apparent simultaneous I/O operation by several devices. Thus, a large number of devices may be accessed concurrently; the exact number depends on the channel bandwidth and the actual bandwidth used by each device.
  • the I/O system and dual port device controller architecture and operation described above provide a number of important benefits.
  • the present invention provides a structure and operation which can accommodate a wide variety of device operations.
  • the present invention provides for a maximum usage of resources, primarily by making a maximum usage of memory bandwidth.
  • Each device uses a minimum of the memory bandwidth. This allows a relatively large number of devices to be associated with the particular I/O bus. Because of the inherent speed of the I/O bus, and the buffering technique of the present invention, each particular transfer is made at a relatively high speed limited only by memory speed. Because the transfers are in a burst mode, the overhead associated with each transfer is minimized. This maximizes the use of the channel bandwidth and also permits the use of high speed devices.
  • the present invention provides for failsoft access to peripheral devices. There are redundant paths to each peripheral device, and containment of failure on any particular path. Failure of a particular module in one path does not affect the operation of a module in another path to that device.
  • Protection features prevent a peripheral device from contaminating its own buffer or the memory of the system. These protection features include a separate count word in each IOC table and a protect bit in the IOC table. The IOC table is accessible by the channel, but not by the device. This is a second level of protection to prevent the device from accessing any memory not assigned to that device.
  • the present invention requires only a small number of lines in the I/0 bus to provide a flexible and powerful I/0 system.
  • the operation of the device controller is well defined as power is turned on or off to protect the I/0 bus from erroneous signals during this time and also to permit on line maintenance and system upgrade.
  • the present invention uses stress to allow the buffers to cooperate without communicating with each other.
  • An on line transaction system is obtained through overlapped transfers and processing.
  • Multichannel direct memory access provides interleaved bursts to give overlapped transfers and minimum waits for accesses to a device. Each burst requires a minimum memory overhead and allows the processor to make maximum use of the memory. This combination allows maximum use of the I/0 bandwidth and minimal tie up of the processor.
  • the multiprocessor system of the present invention incorporates a power distribution system that over comes a number of problems associated with prior art systems.
  • the power distribution system of the present invention incorporates a plurality of separate and independent power supplies and distributes the power from the power supplies to the processor modules and to the device controllers in a way that permits on-line maintenance and also provides redundancy of power on each device controller.
  • on-line is used in the sense that when a part of the system is on-line, that part of the system is not only powered on, but it is also functioning with the system to perform useful work.
  • on-line maintenance therefore means maintaining a part of the system (including periodic preventative maintenance or repair work) while the remainder of the system is on-line as defined above.
  • any processor module or device controller can be powered down so that on-line maintenance can be performed in a power off condition on that processor module or a device controller while the rest of the multiprocessor system is on-line and functional.
  • the on-line maintenance can be performed while fully meeting Underwriters Laboratory safety requirements.
  • each device controller is connected for supply of power from two separate power supplies and by a diode switching arrangement that permits the device controller to be supplied with power from both power supplies when both power supplies are operative and to be supplied with power from either one of the power supplies in the event the other power supply fails; and the changeover in the event of failure of one of the power supplies is accomplished smoothly and without any interruption or pulsation in the power supply so that an interrupt to a device controller is never required in the event of a failure of one of its associated power supplies.
  • FIG. 30 A power distribution system for insuring both a primary supply and an alternate power supply for each individual dual port device controller 41 is illustrated in FIG. 30.
  • the power distribution system is indicated generally by the reference numeral 301 in FIG. 30.
  • the power distribution system 301 insures that each dual port device controller 41 has both a primary power supply and an alternate power supply. Because each device controller does have two separate and independent sources of power supply, a failure of the primary power supply for a particular device controller does not render that device controller (and all of the devices associated with that controller) inoperative. Instead, in the present invention, a switching arrangement provides for an automatic switchover to the alternate power supply so that the device controller can continue in operation.
  • the power distribution system thus coacts with the dual port system of the device controller to provide continuous operation and access to the devices in the event of a failure of either a single port or a single power supply.
  • the power distribution system 301 shown in FIG. 30 provides the further advantage that each processor module 33 and associated CPU 105 and memory 107 has a separate and independent power supply which is dedicated to that processor module. With this arrangement, a failure of any one power supply or a manual disconnection of any one power supply for repair or servicing of the power supply or associated processor module is therefore limited in effect to only one particular processor module and cannot affect the operation of any of the other processor modules in the multiprocessor system.
  • the power distribution system 301 shown in FIG. 30 thus works in combination with the individual processor modules and the dual port device controllers to insure that a failure or disconnection of any one power supply does not shut down the overall system or make any of the devices ineffective.
  • the power distribution system 301 includes a plurality of separate and independent power supplies 303, and each power supply 303 has a line 305 (actually a multiline bus 305 as shown in FIG. 33) which is dedicated to supplying power to the CPU and memory of a particular, related processor module.
  • line 305 actually a multiline bus 305 as shown in FIG. 33
  • Each device controller 41 is associated with two of the power supplies 303 through a primary line 307 and an alternate line 309 and an automatic switch 311.
  • a manually operated switch 313 is also associated with each device controller 41 between the device controller and the primary line 307 and the alternate line 309.
  • the switches 311 and 313 are shown in more detail in FIG. 31.
  • FIG. 32 shows details of the component construction of a power supply 303.
  • each power supply 303 has an input connector 315 for taking power from the mains.
  • the input 315 is connected to an AC to DC converter 317, and the output of the AC to DC converter provides, on a line 319, a five volt interruptable power supply (IPS).
  • IPS interruptable power supply
  • This five volt interruptable power supply is supplied to the CPU 105, the memory 107 and the device controller 41. See also FIG. 33.
  • the AC to DC converter 317 also provides on a second output line 321 a sixty volt DC output which is supplied to a DC to DC converter 323. See FIG. 32.
  • the DC to DC converter in turn provides a five volt output on a line 325 and a twelve volt output on a line 327.
  • the outputs from the lines 325 and 327 are, in the system of the present invention, uninterruptable power supply (UPS) outputs in that these power supply outputs are connected to the CPU and memory when semiconductor memory is used.
  • UPS uninterruptable power supply
  • the power supply to a semiconductor memory must not be interrupted because a loss of power to a semiconductor memory will cause loss of all data stored in the memory.
  • the five volt interruptable power supply on line 319 is considered an interruptable power supply because this power is supplied to parts of the multiprocessing system in which an interruption of power can be accepted.
  • the five volts interruptable power is supplied to parts of the CPU other than semiconductor memory and to only those parts of the memory which are core memory (and for which a loss of power does not cause a loss of memory) and to the device controller which (as will be described in more detail below) is supplied with an alternate source of power in the event of a failure of the primary power supply.
  • the present invention provides a battery back-up for the input to the DC to DC converter 323.
  • This battery back-up includes a battery and charger module 329.
  • the module 329 is connected to the DC to DC converter 323 by a line 331 and a diode 333.
  • the battery 323 supplies power at 48 volts to the converter 323, which is within the input range of the converter 323.
  • the diode 333 insures that power from the battery is supplied to the converter 323 if the voltage on the line 321 drops below 48 volts.
  • the diode 333 also stops the flow of current from the battery and the line 333 when the output of the AC to DC converter on line 321 exceeds 48 volts.
  • Each power supply 303 also includes a power warning circuitry 335 for detecting a condition in the AC power input on line 315 that would result in insufficient power out on the output lines 319, 325 and 327.
  • the power warning circuit 335 transmits a power failure warning signal on a line 337 to the related CPU 105.
  • the uninterruptable power supply on lines 325 and 327 must not be interrupted, even for an instant of time; and the battery back-up provided by the arrangement shown in FIG. 32 insures that there is no interruption in the power supply on lines 325 and 327 in the event of a power failure in the input line 315.
  • One particular power supply 303 itself can fail for some reason with the other power supplies 303 still operating.
  • the power distribution system 301 of the present invention limits the effect of the failure of the power supply 303 to the loss of one particular, associated CPU and memory; and the automatic switch 311 provides for an automatic switchover from the failed power supply to the alternate power supply to keep the associated device controller 41 in operation.
  • the device controller 41 which had been connected to the failed power supply therefore continues in operative association with the other processor modules and components of the multiprocessor system, because the required power is automatically switched in from the alternate power supply.
  • each automatic switch 311 includes two diodes--a diode 341 associated with the primary power line 307 and a diode 343 associated with the alternate power line 309.
  • the function of the diodes 341 and 343 is to permit power to be supplied to a device controller 41 from either the primary power line 307 and a related power supply 303 or the alternate power line and its related power supply 303 while keeping the supplies isolated. This prevents a failed power supply from causing its associated alternate or primary from failing.
  • each diode In normal operation each diode permits a certain amount of current to flow through the diode so that the power to each device controller 41 is actually being supplied by both the primary and alternate power supplies for that device controller.
  • the voltage on the lines 307 and 309 must be enough higher than five volts to accomodate the voltage drop across the diodes 341 and 343 and still supply exactly five volts to the device controller 41.
  • the lines 305 are in parallel with the lines 307 and 309, and the power actually received at the CPU in memory must also be five volts; so balancing diodes 339 are located in the lines 305 to insure that the voltage after the diodes 339 as supplied to each CPU is exactly five volts.
  • the manual switch 313 permits a device controller 41 to be disconnected from both the primary and the alternate power sources when the device controller needs to be disconnected for removal and service.
  • the switch 313 includes a manual switch 345, a transistor 347, a capacitor 348 and a resistor 350 and a resistor 352.
  • the manual switch 345 is closed to turn on the transistor 347 which then supplies power to the device controller 41.
  • the feedback capacitor 348 acts in conjunction with the resistor 352 to cause the required smooth ramp build-up of power when the switch 345 is closed to turn the transistor 347 on.
  • the feedback capacitor 348 acts in conjunction with resistor 350 to provide a smooth fall off of power.
  • all of diodes 341, 343 and 339 are Schottky diodes which have a very low forward voltage drop, and this reduces power dissipation.
  • each device controller 41 does have a power on circuit (PON) 182 for detecting when the five volt power is below specifications.
  • PON power on circuit
  • the PON circuit 182 is shown in more detail in FIG. 25 and resets the device controller 41 to lock everything off of the device controller and holds the device controller itself in a state that is known when the power is turned off by the switch 313.
  • the PON circuit 182 also releases the device controller and returns it to operation after the power is turned on by switch 313 and five volt power supply at the proper specification is supplied to the device controller 41.
  • each power supply 303 is transmitted to a related CPU by the vertical bus 305, and each vertical bus 305 is a laminated bus bar which has five layers of electrical conductors.
  • each vertical bus 305 has two different conductors connected to ground.
  • One conductor provides the ground for both the five volt interruptable power supply (IPS) and the five volt uninterruptable power supply (UPS).
  • IPS interruptable power supply
  • UPS uninterruptable power supply
  • a separate conductor provides a ground for the memory voltage. This separate ground for the memory voltage insures that the relatively large fluctuations in current to the memory will not have any effect on either the five volt IPS or the five volt UPS supplied to the CPU.
  • the horizontal bus 307, 309 includes the primary and alternate power supply lines 307 and 309 (as indicated by the reference numerals in Fi9. 30).
  • the bus 307, 309 is actually a nine layer laminated bus which has a single ground and eight voltage layers (V1 through V8 as indicated by the legends and notations in FIG. 33).
  • Each voltage layer is connected to the five volt interruptable output of a different power supply 303.
  • the layer V1 is connected at 351 to the five volt IPS power for the power supply 303 and related processor module farthest to the left as viewed in FIG. 33
  • the layer V2 is connected at 353 to the five Volt IPS power supply 303 for the processor module at the center as viewed in FIG. 33, and so on.
  • each device controller 41 Since there are eight layers (V1 through V8) and a common ground available to each device controller in the horizontal bus, upstanding vertical taps 355 to these eight layers at spaced intervals along the horizontal bus permit each device controller 41 to be associated with any two of the power supplies 303 merely by connecting the primary line 307 and the alternate line 309 to a particular set of taps.
  • the device controller 41 on the lefthand side of FIG. 33 is shown connected to the taps V111 and V2 and the device controller 41 on the righthand side of FIG. 33 is shown connected to the taps V2 and V3.
  • any device controller 41 can be connected to any two of the power supplies 303 with any one of the power supplies serving as the primary power supply and any one of the other power supplies serving as the alternate power supply.
  • the power distribution system of the present invention thus provides a number of important benefits.
  • the power distribution system permits on line maintenance to be performed because one processor module or device controller can be powered down while the rest of the multiprocessor system is on line and functional.
  • the power distribution system fully meets all Underwriter Laboratory safety requirements for doing on line maintenance of a powered down component while the rest of the multiprocessor system is on line and in operation.
  • Each device controller is associated with two separate power supplies so that a failure in one of the power supplies does not cause the device controller to stop operation. Instead, the electronic switch arrangement of the present invention provides such a smooth transition of power from the two power supplies to only one of the power supplies that the device controller is maintained in continuous operation without an interrupt.
  • Each processor module 33 (see FIG. 1) in the multiprocessor system 31 contains a memory.
  • This memory is indicated by the general reference numeral 107 in FIG. 1 and is shown in greater detail in FIG. 34.
  • each processor module 33 is associated with both the CPU 105 and the I/0 channel 109 of that module.
  • This dual access to the memory is illustrated in FIG. 34 and will be described in greater detail below in the description of the FIG. 34 structure and operation.
  • CPU and channel accesses to the memory can be interleaved in time. There is no need for either the CPU or the channel to wait for access to the memory, except in the case where both the CPU and the channel are trying to access the memory at exactly the same time. As a result, both the CPU and the channel can be performing their separate functions simultaneously, subject to an occasional wait by the CPU or channel if one of these units is accessing the memory at the exact time the other unit needs to access the memory.
  • the dual port access also allows background I/0 operation.
  • the CPU 105 needs to be involved with the channel 109 only in the initiation and termination of I/0 data transfers.
  • the CPU can be performing other functions during the actual I/0 data transfer itself.
  • the memory 107 shown in FIG. 34 comprises a physical memory which consists of up to 262,144 words of sixteen data bits each.
  • each word in memory has an additional parity bit if the memory is a core memory or six additional error correction bits if the memory is a semiconductor memory.
  • the parity bit permits detection of single bit errors.
  • the six error correction bits permit detection and correction of single bit errors and also permit detection of all double bit errors.
  • the physical memory is conceptually subdivided into contiguous blocks of 1024 words each (which are called pages).
  • the pages in physical memory are numbered consecutively from page zero, starting at physical location zero.
  • the address range of physical memory in one specific embodiment of the present invention, which address range is zero through 262,143, requires eighteen bits of physical address information.
  • the basic architecture of the present invention is, however, constructed to accommodate and utilize twenty bits of physical address information, as will become more apparent from the description to follow.
  • the physical memory is physically divided into physical modules of 32,768 words. Thus, eight of these modules provide the 262,143 words noted above.
  • All accesses to memory are made to one of four logical address areas--user data, system data, user code and system code areas. All CPU instructions deal with these logical (as distinct from physical) addresses exclusively. Thus, a programmer need not be concerned with an actual physical address but can instead write a program based entirely on logical addresses and the logical addresses are translated by the map section of memory system into physical addresses.
  • the range of addressing in any given logical address area is that of a sixteen bit logical address, zero through 65,535.
  • each logical address area comprises sixty-four logical pages of 1024 words each.
  • the various logical pages comprising an operating system program or a user program need not reside in contiguous physical pages.
  • the logical pages need be in physical main memory but may be in secondary memory, such as on a disc.
  • Virtual memory has two benefits.
  • virtual memory allows the use of a physical main memory space which is smaller than the logical address areas would require, because the physical memory can be supplemented by a secondary physical memory.
  • virtual memory permits address spaces of a plurality of users (multiprogramming) to share the physical memory, and each user does not have to be concerned with the allocation of physical memory among the operating system, himself, or other users.
  • the memory system of the present invention provides protection between users in the multiprogramming environment by guaranteeing that one user program cannot read from or write into the memory space of another user program. This is accomplished by the paging and mapping system.
  • the map for that user program points only to the memory pages (up to sixty-four pages of code and sixty-four pages of data) for that particular user program. That particular user program cannot address outside its own logical address space and therefore cannot write into or read from the memory space of another user program.
  • code pages are non-modifiable also prevents a user program from destroying itself.
  • mapping scheme The required translation of a sixteen bit logical address to an eighteen bit physical address is accomplished by a mapping scheme.
  • a physical page number is obtained by a look-up operation within a map. This physical page number is then combined with the address within a page to form the complete physical memory address.
  • Each map section corresponds to one of the four logical addressing areas (user data, system data, user code and system code).
  • the separation provides isolation of programs from data so that programs are never modified.
  • the separation also provides isolation of system programs and data from user programs and data, and this protects the operating system from user errors.
  • Map 0--user data map All addresses to variable user data areas are translated through this user data map.
  • Map 1- system data map.
  • the system data map is similar to the user data map and in addition, all memory references by either the I/0 channel, the interprocessor bus handling microprogram, or the interrupt handling microprogram specifies this map.
  • the system data map provides channel access to all of physical memory via only a sixteen bit address word.
  • Map 2--user code map This map defines the active user program. All user instructions and constant data are obtained via this user code map.
  • Map 3--system code map This map defines the operating system program. All operating system instructions and constant data are obtained via this system code map.
  • Each map section has sixty-four entries corresponding to the sixty-four pages possible in each logical address area. Each entry contains the following information.
  • the physical page number field (which can have a value of zero through 255).
  • the reference history field comprises reference bits, and the high order bit of the reference bits is set to a "one" by any use of the page corresponding to that map entry.
  • the dirty bit is set to a "one" when a write access is made to the corresponding memory page.
  • the reference bits and the dirty bit are used by the memory manager function of the operating system to help select a page for overlay.
  • the dirty bit also provides a way to avoid unnecessary swaps of data pages to secondary memory.
  • the absent bit is initially set to a "one” by the operating system to flag a page as being absent from main memory. An access to a page with this bit set to "one" causes an interrupt to the operating system page fault interrupt handler to activate the operating system virtual memory manager function.
  • the absent bit is also used as a protection mechanism to prevent erroneous access by a program outside its intended logical address area for either code or data.
  • Three instructions are used by the operating system in connection with the map. These three instructions are: SMAP, RMAP, AMAP.
  • the SMAP (set map entry) instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to insert data into a map entry. This instruction requires two parameters--the map entry address and the data to be inserted.
  • the RMAP (read map entry) instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to read a map entry. This instruction requires one parameter, the map entry address, and the result returned by the instruction is the map entry content.
  • the AMAP (age map entry) instruction causes the reference history field of a map entry to be shifted one position to the right. This is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to maintain reference history information as an aid in selecting a page for overlay.
  • a page fault interrupt provided by the absent bit occurs when a reference is made to a page that does not currently reside in main memory or which is not part of the logical address space of the program or its data.
  • an interrupt through to the operating system page fault interrupt handler occurs.
  • the page fault interrupt sequence includes the following events:
  • the page fault interrupt occurs.
  • the 8 interrupt handler microcode places an interrupt parameter indicating the map number and the logical page number in a memory location known to the operating system. Then the current environment is saved in an interrupt stack marker in memory.
  • the page fault interrupt handler executes. If the page fault occurred because of a reference outside the logical address space of the program, then the program is terminated with an error condition. On the other hand, if a page fault occurred because the logical page was absent from physical main memory (but present in secondary memory), an operating system process executes to read the absent page from the secondary memory (usually disc) to an available page in primary memory . That physical page information and a zero absent bit are inserted into the map entry. When this memory management function completes, the environment that caused the page fault is restored.
  • the I/0 channel has access to the memory through its own port.
  • Data transfers to and from memory by the I/0 channel are via the system data map. That is, the sixteen bit logical addresses provided by the I/0 channel are translated to an eighteen bit physical address by means of the system data map.
  • mapping scheme allows I/0 access to more words of physical memory than its address counter would normally allow.
  • 262 144 words of physical memory (for an eighteen bit address) can be accessed with only a sixteen bit logical address by going through the map.
  • the extra address information (the physical page information) is contained in the map and is supplied by the operating system before each I/0 transfer is initiated.
  • the present invention is also readily extendible to a twenty bit physical address.
  • FIG. 34 is a block diagram showing details of the memory 107 of a processor module 33 and showing also connections from the memory 107 to the CPU 105 and the I/0 channel 109 of that processor module.
  • the memory system 107 provides access ports for both the CPU 105 and the I/0 channel 109 to the memory 107, and the I/0 channel 109 therefore is not required to access the memory through the CPU 105.
  • the memory 107 includes map memory control logic 401 which controls initiation and completion of access to physical memory modules 403.
  • the memory 107 also includes a data path section 405 containing registers (as indicated by the legends in FIG. 34 and described in detail below) which supply data to be written to memory and which hold data read from memory.
  • the memory 107 also includes a map section 407.
  • the map section 407 includes logical address registers from both the CPU and the channel and a map storage 409 from which physical page numbers are obtained.
  • the map section 407 thus contains a processor memory address (PMA) register 411 and a channel memory address (CMA) register 129.
  • PMA processor memory address
  • CMA channel memory address
  • the address selector 415 is connected to the map 409 by a logical page address bus 417, and the address selector 415 is also connected directly to the memory modules by a page offset bus 419.
  • the logical page address bus 417 transmits the eight high order bits to the map 409 for translation to a physical page number
  • the page offset bus 419 transmits the ten low order bits (of an eighteen page address from the address selector 415) to the memory modules 403.
  • An output bus 421 supplies the physical page address to the modules 403.
  • This output bus 421 contains the translated eight high order bits for the address of the physical page.
  • the data path section 405 contains the following registers: A processor memory data (PMD) register 423; a channel memory data (CMD) register 425; a next instruction (NI) register 431; a memory data (MD) register 433; and a channel data (CD) register 125.
  • PMD processor memory data
  • CMD channel memory data
  • NI next instruction
  • MD memory data
  • CD channel data
  • This data selector 427 has an output bus 429 which supplies data to be written to memory in the modules 403.
  • Data read out from one of the memory modules 403 is read into one of the three data registers NI, MD and CD over a bus 437.
  • the map memory control logic 401 is also connected with each of the memory modules 403 by a bus 439.
  • the bus 439 comprises command lines which initiate read or write operations, completion signals from the memory modules, and error indicators or flags.
  • the map section 407 includes, in addition to the map 409, a map page register 441, a map output latch 443, a map memory data (MMD) register 445, a map data selector 447, a map parity generator 449, a map parity checker 451, reference bit logic 453, and dirty bit logic 455.
  • a map page register 441 a map page register 441, a map output latch 443, a map memory data (MMD) register 445, a map data selector 447, a map parity generator 449, a map parity checker 451, reference bit logic 453, and dirty bit logic 455.
  • MMD map memory data
  • the map memory control logic 401 is shown in FIG. 35 as associated with the map section 407 by control signal lines 457.
  • the map memory control logic 401 controls the loading of registers and selection of registers by the selectors, controls (in conjunction with map absence and parity error outputs) the initiation of memory modules 403 operations, and provides interrupts to the CPU 105 (as indicated by the page fault and map parity error interrupt signals indicated by the legends in FIG. 35)--all as will be described in more detail below.
  • the memory system shown in FIGS. 34 and 35 utilizes a physical page address field of eight bits and a page offset of ten bits which combine to give a total eighteen bits.
  • the numbers 8, 10, 12, 13, 14 and 18 which are not in parenthesis on certain bus lines in FIG. 34 and FIG. 35 relate to this specific eighteen bit implemented embodiment of the present invention.
  • the memory system is easily expandable to a twenty bit implemented embodiment (with a physical page address of ten bits) and this is indicated by the numbers (10), (12), (14), (15), (16) and (20) which are within parenthesis on the same bus lines of FIG. 35.
  • FIG. 36 illustrates the organization of logical memory in four separate and distinct logical address areas 459, 461, 463 and 465. These four logical address areas are: user data area 459; system data area 461; user code area 463; and system code area 465.
  • FIG. 36 also illustrates the four map sections corresponding to the logical address areas.
  • the user data map section 467 corresponds to the logical user data address area 459
  • the system data map section 469 corresponds to the logical system data address area 461
  • the user code map section 471 corresponds to the logical user code address area 463
  • the system code map section 473 corresponds to the logical system code address area 465.
  • each map section has sixty-four logical page entries (page zero through page sixty-three), and each map entry comprises sixteen bits (as illustrated by the enlarged single map entry in FIG. 36).
  • each map entry comprises a ten bit physical page number field, a single parity bit P, a reference history field comprising three reference bits R, S and T, a single dirty bit D, and a single absent bit A.
  • the physical page number field provided by the ten high order bits provides the physical page number corresponding to the logical page called for by the program.
  • the parity bit P is always generated as odd parity to provide a data integrity check on the map entry contents.
  • the reference history field bits R, S and T are used by the memory manager function of the operating system to maintain reference history information for selecting the least recently used page for overlaying.
  • the R bit is set to a one by any read or write operation to that logical page.
  • the S and T bits are storage bits which are manipulated by the AMAP (age a map entry) instruction.
  • the dirty bit D is set to a one by a write access to that logical page.
  • the operating system uses the dirty bit to determine whether a data page has been modified since it was last brought in from secondary memory.
  • the absent bit A is set to a one by the operating system to flag a logical page which is absent from main memory but present in secondary memory or to flag a page which is outside the logical address area of that user.
  • the two high order bits for the map entry shown in FIG. 36 are not used in the specific embodiment of the invention illustrated in the drawings, but these two bits are used when the full twenty bit physical addressing is used.
  • the SMAP instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to insert data into a map entry like that illustrated in FIG. 36.
  • the SMAP instruction is implemented by the microprogram 115 (FIG. 12) in the CPU 105.
  • the microprogram interacts with the map memory control logic 401 (see FIG. 34), first of all, to select (with the first instruction parameter)a location in the map 409 and then, second, to insert in that location the second instruction parameter--the new map entry data.
  • the microprogram 115 loads the new map entry data into the processor memory data (PMD) register 423.
  • PMD processor memory data
  • the map address including two high order bits for map selection, are loaded into the processor memory address (PMA) register 411.
  • PMA processor memory address
  • the microprogram 115 in the CPU 105 initiates a map write operation sequence of the map memory control logic 401. This map write operation sequence is initiated after any previous memory operations have been completed.
  • the remaining actions of the SMAP instruction are performed under the control of the map memory control logic. Thus, the remaining actions are all performed automatically by hardware.
  • the map address is transmitted from the PMA register through the address selector 415 over the bus 417 to the map 409. Only the eight high order bits (the map select and map address) are used in this operation. The two high order bits specify the map selection--whether user data, system data, user code or system code.
  • the ten low order bits of the logical address bus from the address selector (ASEL) 415 (which bits are the offset within a page for a memory read or write access) are not used in this operation.
  • the new map data is transmitted from the PMD register 423 through the map data selector 447 to the map parity generator 449 and to the map 409.
  • the map parity generator computes odd parity on the new map data and supplies this parity bit to the map.
  • the map memory control logic 401 generates a map write strobe signal (on one of the lines indicated by 457 in FIG. 35) to the map 409 which causes the new data and parity to be written into the selected map section at the specific map entry selected by the logical page address on the bus 417.
  • SMAP SMAP
  • SMAP SMAP
  • One use of the set map instruction is therefor to insert a physical page address for a logical page to provide for translation of logical page numbers to physical page numbers after a page has been swapped in from secondary memory.
  • Another use of the set map instruction is to set on an absent bit for a logical page swapped out to secondary memory.
  • the read map (RMAP) instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to examine the content of a map entry.
  • the microprogram 115 in the CPU 105 interacts with the map memory control logic 401 to select (with the instruction parameter) a location in the map 409 and to return to the register stack 112 (see FIG. 12) as a result of the content of that map entry.
  • the microprogram 115 In the operation of the read map (RMAP) instruction, referring to FIG. 35, the microprogram 115 loads the map address, including the two high order bits for the map selection, into the PMA register 411. The microprogram 115 then initiates a map read operation sequcnce of the map memory control logic 401.
  • RMAP read map
  • the content of the selected map entry is transmitted from the map 409 to the map parity checker 451 (see FIG. 35) and to the map output latch 443.
  • the map parity checker 451 compares the parity bit from the map entry with the odd parity computed on the data.
  • map address is loaded into the map page register 441; and the map parity error signal sets an error flag which causes a map parity error interrupt to the CPU 105.
  • map entry data is loaded from the map output latch 443 into the map memory data register (MMD) 445.
  • the RMAP instruction microprogram returns the data in the map memory data (MMD) register 445 to the register stack 112 (see FIG. 12) as the result of the instruction.
  • the uses of the RMAP instruction include the following.
  • RMAP read map
  • the read map (RMAP) instruction is also used in diagnostics to determine whether the map storage is functioning properly.
  • the age map (AMAP) instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to maintain useful reference history information in the map.
  • This reference history information is maintained in the map by map entries (the R,S and T bits of the map entry format shown in FIG. 36) within a map section which are typically "aged” after each page fault interrupt occurrence in that map section.
  • This AMAP instruction has just a single para-meter which is the map address specifying the map location to be aged.
  • the microprogram 115 in the CPU 105 selects a map location with the instruction map address parameter.
  • the microprogram 115 loads the map address parameter into the PMA register just as in the RMAP instruction.
  • map read operation sequence of the map memory control logic 401 is initiated, and this sequence proceeds identically as in the RMAP instruction described above.
  • the microprogram 115 reads the content of the map entry from the MMD register 445 (Fig. 35) extracts the reference history field (the R, S and T bits 10, 11 and 12 shown in FIG. 36), shifts the field right one position, and reinserts the field to form the new map entry data.
  • the reference history field the R, S and T bits 10, 11 and 12 shown in FIG. 36
  • microprogram 115 takes the modified map entry and loads this new data into the PMD register 423 (FIG. 34) and writes the new map entry data back into the selected map entry (similar to the SMAP sequence).
  • AMAP age map
  • the R bit is set to one by any memory reference to the corresponding logical page, so that when this bit is a one, it is an indication that this page has been used since the last set map (SMAP) or age map (AMAP) operation instruction.
  • SMAP last set map
  • AMAP age map
  • This setting of the R bit in conjunction with the age map (AMAP) instruction provides a means for maintaining frequency of use information in the reference history field of the map.
  • the reference history field of all of the map entries in a given map are typically aged after a page fault interrupt.
  • the value of the three bit reference field in a map entry is an indication of the frequency of access since the previous three page fault interrupts.
  • a binary value of seven indicates accesses in each of the intervals between the proceeding page fault interrupts.
  • a binary value of four in the reference history field indicates an access in the interval since the last page fault interrupt and indicates that there were no accesses in the intervals previous to the most recent page fault interrupt.
  • a binary value of zero for the three bit reference field indicates that that logical page has not been accessed in any of the three intervals since the last three page fault interrupts.
  • This reference history information is maintained so that when it is necessary to select a page for overlay, a page which has been infrequently used in the recent past can be identified. A page infrequently accessed in the recent past is likely to continue that behavior, and that page will therefore probably not have to be swapped back into memory after being overlayed.
  • This frequency of use history is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to select infrequently used pages for overlay so as to minimize swapping from secondary memory to implement an efficient virtual memory system.
  • memory may be accessed by the CPU or by the I/O system.
  • the action of the memory system and map during a CPU memory access sequence will now be described.
  • the access sequence is similar for the various CPU memory accesses such as writing data, reading data, or reading instructions from memory.
  • the CPU memory access sequence is started either by the CPU microprogram 115 or by the CPU instruction-fetch logic. In either event, the CPU 105 loads an eighteen bit logical address into the PMA register 411 and initiates a data read, data write, or instruction read operation sequence of the map memory control logic 401.
  • the eighteen bit logical address is composed of two high order logical address space select bits and sixteen low order bits specifying a location within that logical address space.
  • the two select bits may be specified by the CPU microprogram 115 or may be automatically generated in the CPU, based on the contents of the instruction (I) and environment (E) registers.
  • the eighteen bit logical address also includes, in addition to the two high order logical address select bits, six bits which specify the logical page within the selected map and ten low order bits which specify the offset within the page in the selected map.
  • the eighteen bit address in the PMA register 411 (FIG. 35) is transmitted through the address selector 415 to the buses 417 and 419 (see FIGS. 34 and 35).
  • the bus 419 transmits the page offset portion of the address. This page offset portion of the address is transmitted directly to the physical memory modules 403 (FIG. 403) by the bus 419.
  • the bus 417 transmits the logical page address portion (which must be translated to a physical page address) to the map 409.
  • the map entry selected by the logical page address is read out from the map 409 to the map memory control logic 401 (FIG. 34), the map parity checker 451 (FIG. 35), and the map output latch 443.
  • the map memory control logic 401 terminates the memory access sequence.
  • the parity checker 451 detects incorrect parity in the map entry, the logical page address is loaded into the map page register 441, a map parity error signal is transmitted to the CPU, and the memory access sequence is terminated.
  • the physical page address is transmitted from the map output latch 443 over the bus 421 to the physical memory modules 403; and the map memory control logic 401 issues a command over the bus 439 to cause the selected memory module 403 to perform a read or write operation.
  • the data to be written is transmitted from the PMD register 423 through the data selector 427 to the memory module over the bus 429.
  • map memory control logic 401 causes the map entry data to be modified and rewritten.
  • the map entry data is transmitted from the map output latch 443 to the dirty bit logic 455 (see FIG. 35) and to the map data selector 447.
  • the dirty bit D supplied to the map data selector is set to a one by the dirty bit logic 455. Otherwise, the dirty bit is not modified.
  • the reference bit R supplied to the map data selector by the reference bit logic 453 is set to a one in either a read or a write operation.
  • the map data selector 447 supplies this new map data to the parity generator 449 and to the map 409.
  • An odd parity bit P is generated from the new data by the parity generator 449 (see FIG. 35).
  • a map write strobe from the map memory control logic 401 then causes the new data and parity to be written into the map entry selected by the logical page address bus 417.
  • the logical page has been translated through the map entry, and the map entry has been rewritten with updated parity, reference, and dirty bits.
  • the physical memory module 403 When the physical memory module 403 completes its read or write operation, it sends a completion signal to the map memory control logic 401 over the bus 439 (see FIG. 34).
  • the memory module 403 In a read operation the memory module 403 gates the memory data to the bus 437 (FIG. 34).
  • the data is loaded into the MD register 433 (FIG. 34) for use by the CPU 105.
  • the data is loaded into the NI register 431 (FIG. 34) for subsequent execution by the CPU 105.
  • An I/O channel access to read or to write data to memory proceeds similar to a CPU memory access as described above except for the following.
  • the channel memory address (CMA) register 129 (FIG. 34) is used to provide the logical address, and this register always specifies the system data map 469 (see FIG. 35).
  • the channel memory data (CMD) register 425 (FIG. 34) is used to supply data to memory in a write operation.
  • the channel data (CD) register 125 (FIG. 34) is used to receive data from memory in a read operation.
  • the access is always a read or write data to memory access, and there is no instruction read access as in the case of a CPU access.
  • map parity and absent conditions are transmitted to the I/O channel 109 if they occur in an I/O channel access to memory.
  • either semiconductor memory core memory is used for the memory modules 403.
  • parity error detection system When the memory is core memory, errors are detected by a parity error detection system.
  • the parity error detection system for core memory modules is effective to detect all single bit errors. Conventional parity error generation and checking techniques are used, and details of the core memory will therefore not be illustrated.
  • FIGS. 37-41 and related Table 1 illustrate details of an error detection and correction system used when the mexory modules 403 are constructed with semiconductor memory.
  • the six bit check field error detection and correction system of the present invention is, as will be described in detail below, capable of detecting and correcting all single bit errors and is also capable of detecting all double bit errors. In addition, most errors of three or more bits are detected.
  • the multiprocessor system incorporating the error detection and correction system of the present invention is therefore tolerant of single failures and can be operated with single bit failures in semiconductor memory until such time as it is convenient to repair the memory.
  • the error detection and correction system utilizes a systematic linear binary code of Hamming distance four.
  • each check bit is a linear combination of eight data bits (as shown in FIG. 38).
  • each data bit is a component of exactly three check bits (as also shown in FIG. 38).
  • the error correction and detection system embodies a syndrome decoder which provides the combination of fast logic speed and low parts count.
  • the error detection and correction system of the present invention operates to add six check bits to each data word written into storage.
  • the check field portion of the storage word is used to identify or to detect the loss of information in that word since the time it was stored.
  • error In semiconductor memory there are two possible mechanisms for loss of information (error). One is hard failure of a memory device which makes that device permanently unable to retain information, and the other is soft failure in which electrical noise can cause a transient loss of information.
  • the detection of errors is accomplished by a check bit comparator which produces a six bit syndrome.
  • the syndrome is the difference between the check field obtained from the stored word and the check field which would normally correspond to the data field obtained from the stored word.
  • This syndrome is then analyzed (decoded) to determine whether an error has occurred and, if an error has occurred, to determine what type of correction is required.
  • the syndrome decoder output causes a data bit complementer to invert the bit that was in error; and this corrected data is supplied as the output of that memory module.
  • the syndrome decoder indicates a multiple error
  • the fact of the multiple error is communicated to the map memory control section by means of one of the control and error lines to cause an interrupt to the CPU.
  • the memory module 403 includes a timing and control logic section 475 and a semiconductor storage array 477.
  • the storage array 477 provides storage for 32,768 words of twenty-two bits each. Each word has (as illustrated in FIG. 37) a sixteen bit data field and a six bit check field.
  • Each semiconductor memory module 403 also has, as illustrated in FIG. 37, an output latch 479, a check bit generator 481, a check bit comparator 483, a syndrome decoder 485 and a data bit complementer 487.
  • the memory module 403 interfaces to the rest of the system through the signal and data paths illustrated in FIG. 37. These paths include: 429 (data to memory bus), 439 (control and error lines to the map memory control section 401), 419 and 421 (physical address bus), and 437 (data from memory bus). These signal and data paths are also shown in FIG. 34.
  • the content of the output latch 479 is transmitted on a bus 489 to both the check bit comparator 483 and the data bit comparator 487.
  • the output of the check bit comparator 483 is transmitted on a syndrome bus 491 to both the syndrome decoder 485 and the timing and control logic section 475.
  • the output of the syndrome decoder 485 is transmitted on a bus 493 to the data bit complementer 487.
  • the line 495 transmits a SINGLE ERROR (correctable error) signal, and the line transmits a MULTIPLE ERROR (uncorrectable error) signal.
  • the timing and control logic 475 provides control signals on a control bus 499 to the semiconductor storage array 477 and also to the output latch 479.
  • the output of the check bit generator 481 is transmitted to the storage array 477 by a bus 501.
  • the check bit generator 481 includes six separate eight-bit parity trees 503.
  • the check bit comparator 483 includes six separate nine-bit parity trees 505.
  • the syndrome decoder 485 includes a decoder section 507 and a six-bit parity tree 509.
  • the outputs of the decoder section 507 and six-bit parity tree 509 are combined in error identification logic indicated generally by the reference numeral 511.
  • the bit complementer 437 comprises sixteen exclusive-or gates 513.
  • the sixteen bit data word is supplied by the bus 429 to the storage array 477 and also to the check bit generator 481 (see FIG. 37).
  • the check bit generator 48 as best illustrated in FIG. 38, generates six check bits C0 through C5 by means of the six eight-bit parity trees 503.
  • check bit zero (C0) is therefore the complement of the modulo-two sum of data bits 8 through 15.
  • check bit C3 is generated by an eight bit parity tree 503 as specified by the logic equation for C3 set out at the lower part of FIG. 38.
  • Check bit three (C3) is the modulo-two sum of data bits 0, 1, 2, 4, 7, 9, 10 and 12 as shown by the logic equation and as also illustrated by the connections between the eight bit parity tree and the corresponding data bit lines in the logic diagram in the upper part of FIG. 38.
  • each of the other check bits is generated by a modulo-two addition of eight data bits as illustrated in the logic diagram in the top part of FIG. 38.
  • these six check bits, as thus generated by the check bit generator 481, and the sixteen data bits, as transmitted on the data bus 429, are entered in a particular location in the storage array 477. As illustrated in FIG. 37, the six check bits and the sixteen data bits are entered in the storage array 477 under the control of the timing and control logic 475 and the physical address information on the physical address bus 419, 421.
  • Every word stored in the storage array 477 has a six bit check field generated for that word in a similar manner. This check field is retained with the stored word in the storage array 477 until the time when that location in the storage array is subsequently accessed for a read operation.
  • the timing and control logic 475 and the address on the physical address bus 419, 421 causes the content of the selected storage location to be loaded into the output latch 479.
  • the output latch is twenty-two bits wide to accommodate the sixteen data bits and the six bit check field.
  • the check bit comparatpor 483 forms six syndrome bits S0 through S5.
  • Each syndrome bit is the output of a nine-bit parity tree 505 whose inputs are eight data bits and one check bit. Each syndrome bit is related to a correspondingly numbered check bit. Thus, check bit zero is used only for computing syndrome bit zero, check bit one is used only for computing syndrome bit one, and so forth.
  • syndrome bit zero is the complement of the modulo-two sum of check bit zero and data bits 8 through 15 (as shown in the logic equation at the bottom of FIG. 39).
  • each of syndrome bits S 1 through S 5 is generated from the modulo two sum of a corresponding check bit and eight of the data bits, as shown by the connections to the particular data bit lines for each syndrome bit in the logic diagram part of FIG. 39.
  • the presence or absence of errors and the types of errors, if any, are identified by interpreting the value of the six syndrome bits on the bus 491.
  • Table 1 enumerates the sixty-four possible values of the six bit syndrome code and gives the interpretation for each possible value.
  • check bit errors are single bit errors which do not require correction of the data word.
  • the two errors could be (a) one error in a data bit and one error in a check bit or (b) two errors in the data bits or (c) two errors in the check bits.
  • That condition can correspond to either a single data bit error or a multiple error.
  • the syndrome decoder 485 provides two functions.
  • the syndrome decoder 485 provides an input to the data bit complementer 487 (see FIG. 37) by way of the bus 493 in the case of single data bit errors , which input causes the erroneous bit to be inverted within the data bit complementer 487.
  • the syndrome decoder 485 provides one of two error signals in the event of an error.
  • a single data or check bit error is transmitted on the SINGLE ERROR line 495 to the timing and control logic 475.
  • a multiple error indication is transmitted on the MULTIPLE ERROR line 497 to the timing and control logic 475.
  • a MULTIPLE ERROR signal is generated in the case of all double bit errors and most three or more bit errors. This MULTIPLE ERROR signal, as noted above, causes an interrupt to the CPU 105 (see FIG. 34).
  • the construction of the syndrome decoder 485 is shown in detail in FIG. 40.
  • the syndrome decoder 485 comprises a decoder 507, a six bit parity tree 509 and error identification logic 511.
  • the decoder 507 decodes five of the six syndrome bits (bits S1 through S5) to provide sufficient information (thirty-two outputs) to generate both the error types (whether single errors or double or multiple errors) and the sixteen output lines required for inversion of data bit errors in the sixteen data bits. These sixteen output lines required for inversion of data bit errors are indicated generally by the bus 493 and are identified individually by T0 through T15 in FIG. 40.
  • the decoder 507 outputs which are not connected to the OR gate 512 correspond to errors in the six check bits. Errors in the six check bits do not need to be corrected (since the errors are not data bit errors), and these outputs of the decoder are therefore not used.
  • the remaining outputs represent double or multiple errors and are so indicated by the legends in FIG. 40. All of these cases are collected by the OR gate 512 and are one component of the multiple error signal on the line 497 at the output of the error identification logic 511.
  • the syndrome decoder 45 includes a parity tree 509 which forms the modulo-two sum of syndrome bits S0 through S5.
  • the resulting even or odd output of the parity tree 509 corresponds to the error classes shown at the bottom of Table 1.
  • the EVEN output 514 corresponds to syndromes containing no bits on, two bits on, four bits on, or six bits on.
  • the EVEN syndrome corresponding to no bits on (no error) is excluded from the MULTIPLE ERROR output signal 497 by an AND gate 515 which excludes the zero syndrome case (the other input from decoder 507 to the gate 515).
  • An output is desired on the SINGLE ERROR indicator line 495 only for single bit errors. Since the odd output on the line 510 of the parity tree 509 corresponds to one bit on (check bit error), three bits on (data bit error or multibit errors), or five bits on (multibit errors) in the six-bit syndrome (as indicated in the summary at the bottom of Table 1), the odd output on line 510 must be qualified so that only single bit errors are transmitted through the logic 511 to the line 495. Those three-bit syndrome codes corresponding to multibit errors and all of the five-bit syndrome codes must therefore be excluded so that only the single bit errors are transmitted on the line 495. This is accomplished by an inverter 517 and an AND gate 519.
  • a SINGLE ERROR output is generated on the line 495 for syndrome codes containing a single one bit (check bit errors) and also for those syndrome codes containing three one bits corresponding to data bit errors.
  • the odd output of the parity tree 509 indicates syndromes containing one, three or five bits on.
  • the inverter 517 and the AND gate 519 exclude multiple error three bit syndromes and all five bit syndromes.
  • the SINGLE ERROR output 495 includes only single check bit errors and single data bit errors. Single check bit errors do not need to be corrected, and single data bit errors are corrected by the bit complementer 487.
  • the normal pattern of error generation is such that the deterioration of storage is normally detected before three bit errors occur.
  • the normal pattern of deterioration of memory storage would first involve a single bit error from noise or component failure, then would later involve a double bit error from additional failure, etc.; and the double bit errors would be detected before the three or more bit errors could develop.
  • the function of the data bit complementer 487 (see FIG. 37) is to invert data bit errors as detected by the syndrome decoder 485.
  • FIG. 41 shows details of the construction of the bit complementer 487.
  • the bit complementer 487 is implemented by exclusive-or gates 513. Each of these gates 513 inverts a given data bit on a line 489 when a corresponding decoder output on a line 493 is asserted.
  • the corrected output is then transmitted on an output line 437 of the bit complementer 487 as the output of that physical memory module.
  • the memory system of the present invention provides a number of significant features.
  • the memory map provides four separate and distinct logical address spaces--system code, system data, user code and user data--and provides for a translation of logical addresses within these address spaces to physical addresses.
  • the division of logical memory into four address spaces isolates the system programs from the actions of the user programs and protects the system programs from any user errors.
  • the division into four logical address areas also provides for a separation of code and data for both user code and data and system code and data. This provides the benefits of non-modifiable programs.
  • One field permits translation of logical page addresses to physical page addresses.
  • Another field provides an absence indication. This field is an absence bit which allows implementation of a virtual memory scheme where logical pages may reside in a secondary memory.
  • This reference history field allows frequency of use information to be maintained for use by the memory manager function of the operating system to make the virtual memory scheme an efficient scheme. Frequently accessed pages are retained in primary memory, and infrequently used pages are selected for necessary overlaying.
  • a dirty bit field is maintained in each entry of the system data map and the user data map so that unmodified data pages can be identified.
  • the unmodified data pages so identified are not swapped out to secondary memory because a valid copy of that data page is already present in secondary memory.
  • the memory system includes map memory control logic which automatically maintains the reference and dirty bit information as CPU and I/O channel accesses are made to memory.
  • the memory system of the present invention provides for three CPU instructions--SMAP, RMAP and AMAP--which are used by the operating system's memory manager function to maintain and to utilize information in the map.
  • the memory system of the present invention includes a dual port access to the memory.
  • the memory can be accessed separately by the CPU and by the I/O channel. Accesses to memory by the I/O channel do not need to involve the CPU, and the CPU can be performing other functions during the time that an I/O data transfer is being made into or out of memory.
  • the operation of the dual port access to the memory also involves arbitration by the map memory control logic in the event that the CPU and the I/O channel attempt a simultaneous access to the memory. In the case of simultaneous access, the I/O channel is given priority and the CPU waits until that particular I/O channel access has completed.
  • Physical memory is expandible by the modular addition of physical memory modules.
  • the physical memory modules incorporate, in the case of semiconductor memory, error detection and correction under certain conditions. Single errors are detected and corrected so that operation of the CPU and I/O channel can be continued even in the event of a transient or permanent failure within the physical memory module.
  • the error detection and correction system comprises a twenty-two bit word within the storage medium. Sixteen bits represent the data and six bits provide an error detection and correction check field. The six bit check field allows the detection and correction of all single errors and the detection of all double errors.
  • the core memory includes parity for the detection of single errors.
  • each processor module incorporates its own primary memory system.
  • each processor module has its own memory system, problems of shared memory in a multiprocessing system are avoided.
  • the problems of shared memory in a multiprocessing system include reduced memory bandwidth available to a particular processor because of contention, and this reduction of available memory bandwidth becomes more severe as additional CPU's are combined with a single shared memory.
  • An additional problem of shared memory is that a failure in the shared memory can result in simultaneous failure of some or all of the CPU's in the system. That is, in a shared memory system, a single memory failure can stop all or part of the system; but a memory failure will not stop the multiprocessor system of the present invention.
  • the dual port access by the CPU and the I/O channel to the memory utilizes and is permitted because of separate address registers and separate data registers to and from memory.
  • the CPU has a specific register (the NI register) specifically for receiving instructions from memory.
  • This separate and specific register allows overlapped fetching of the next instruction during execution of the current instruction (which may involve the reading of data from memory). As a result, at the end of a current instruction, the next instruction can be initiated immediately without waiting for an instruction fetch.
  • the map is constructed to provide significantly faster access than the access to physical main memory. This provides a number of benefits in the translation of addresses through the map.
  • the map can be rewritten in the time that the physical memory access is being accomplished.
  • the high speed at which the map can be accessed reduces the overall time including page translation required for a memory access.
  • Parity is maintained and checked in the actual map storage itself. This provides immediate indication of any failure in the map storage before resulting incorrect operation in the processor module can occur.

Abstract

A multiprocessor system of the kind in which two or more separate processor modules are interconnected for parallel processing includes interprocessor buses dedicated exclusively to interprocessor communication. The multiprocessor system includes an input/output system having multi-port device controllers and input/output buses connecting each device controller for access by the input/output channels of at least two different processor modules. Each device controller includes logic which insures that only one port is selected for access at a time. An enable latch in each port dynamically disables that port from placing any signals on the related input/output bus in response to a failure of any portion of the device controller, and the enable latch is not responsive to the processor module for re-enabling the port. The device controller controls the transfer of information between a processor module and a peripheral device, and information is gated into a register in a port in a device controller in response to a gating signal generated by a processor module. Parity generation and check means continuously monitor parity for the duration of the gating signal.

Description

This application is a continuation of application Ser. No. 543,810, filed 10/24/83, now abandoned, which is a continuation of application Ser. No. 147,123, filed 5/6/80, now abandoned, which is a divisional of application Ser. No. 721,043, filed 09/07/76, now U.S. Pat. No. 4,228,496.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
This invention relates to a multiprocessor computer system in which interconnected processor modules provide multiprocessing (parallel processing in separate processor modules) and multiprogramming (interleaved processing in one processor module).
This invention relates particularly to a system which can support high transaction rates to large on-line data bases and in which no single component failure can stop or contaminate the operation of the system.
There are many applications which require on-line processing of large volumes of data at high transaction rates. For example, such processing is required in retail applications for automated point of sale, inventory and credit transactions and in financial institutions for automated funds transfer and credit transactions.
In computing applications of this kind it is important, and often critical, that the data processing not be interrupted. A failure of an on-line computer system can shut down a portion of the related business and can cause considerable loss of data and money.
Thus, an on-line system of this kind must provide not only sufficient computing power to permit multiple computations to be done simultaneously, but it must also provide a mode of operation which permits data processing to be continued without interruption in the event some component of the system fails.
The system should operate either in a fail-safe mode (in which no loss of throughput occurs as a result of failure) or in a fail-soft mode (in which some slowdown occurs but full processing capabilities are maintained) in the event of a failure.
Furthermore, the system should also operate in a way such that a failure of a single component cannot contaminate the operation of the system. The system should provide fault-tolerant computing. For fault-tolerant computing all errors and failures in the system should either be corrected automatically, or if the failure or error cannot be corrected automatically, it should be detected, or if it cannot be detected, it should be contained and should not be permitted to contaminate the rest of the system.
Since a single processor module can fail, it is obvious that a system which will operate without interruption in an on-line application must have more than one processor module.
Systems which have more than one processor module can therefore meet one of the necessary conditions for non-interruptible operation. However, the use of more than one processor module in a system does not by itself provide all the sufficient conditions for maintaining the required processing capabilities in the event of component failure, as will become more apparent from the description to follow.
Computing systems for on-line, high volume, transaction oriented, computing applications which must operate without interruption therefore require multiprocessors as a starting point. But the use of multiprocessors does not guarantee that all of the sufficient conditions will be met, and fulfilling the additional sufficient conditions for on-line systems of this kind has presented a number of problems in the prior art.
The prior art approach to uninterrupted data processing has proceeded generally along two lines--either adapting two or more large, monolithic, general purpose computers for joint operation or interconnecting a plurality of minicomputers to provide multiprocessing capabilities.
In the first case, adapting two large monolithic general purpose computers for joint operation, one conventional prior art approach has been to have the two computers share a common memory. Now in this type of multiprocessing system a failure in the shared memory can stop the entire system. Shared memory also presents a number of other problems including sequencing accesses to the common memory. This system, while meeting some of the necessary conditions for uninterruptible processing, does not meet all of the sufficient conditions.
Furthermore, multiprocessing systems using large general purpose computers are quite expensive because each computer is constructed as a monolithic unit in which all components (including the packaging, the cooling system, etc.) must be duplicated each time another processor is added to the system even though many of the duplicated components are not required.
The other prior art approach of using a plurality of minicomputers has (in common with the approach of using large general purpose computers) suffered from the drawback of having to adapt a communications link between computers that were never originally constructed to provide such a link. The required links were, as a result, usually made through the input/output channel. Connections through the input/output channel are necessarily slower than internal transfers within the processor itself, and such interprocessor links have therefore provided relatively slow interprocessor communication.
Furthermore, the interprocessor connections required special adapter cards that added substantially to the cost of the overall system and that introduced the possibility of single component failures which could stop the system. Adding dual interprocessor links and adapter cards to avoid problems of critical single components failures increased the overall system cost even more substantially.
Providing dual links and adapter cards between all processors generally became very cumbersome and quite complex from the standpoint of operation.
Another problem of the prior art arose out of the way in which connections were made to peripheral devices.
If a number of peripheral devices are connected to a single input/output bus of one processor in a multiprocessor system and that processor fails, then the peripheral devices will be unavailable to the system even though the failed processor is linked through an interprocessor connection to another processor or processors in the system.
To avoid this problem, the prior art has provided an input/output bus switch for interconnecting input/output busses for continued access to peripheral devices when a processor associated with the peripheral devices on a particular input/output bus fails. The bus switches have been expensive and also have presented the possibility of single component failure which could down a substantial part of the overall system.
Providing software for the prior art multiprocessor systems has also been a major problem.
Operating systems software for such multiprocessing systems has tended to be nonexistent. Where software had been developed for such multiprocessor systems, it quite often was restricted to a small number of processors and was not adapted for the inclusion of additional processors. In many cases it was necessary either to modify the operating system or to put some of the operating system functions into the user's own program--an expensive, time-consuming operation.
The prior art lacked a satisfactory standard operating system for linking processors. It also did not provide an operating system for automatically accommodating additional processors in a multiprocessing system constructed to accommodate the modular addition of processors as increased computering power was required.
A primary object of the present invention is to construct a multiprocessor system for on-line, transaction-oriented applications which overcomes the problems of the prior art.
A basic objective of the present invention is to insure that no single failure can stop the system or significantly affect system operation. In this regard, the system of the present invention is constructed so that there is no single component that attaches to everything in the system, either mechanically or electrically.
It is a closely related objective of the present invention to guarantee that every error that happens can be either corrected, detected or prevented from contaminating the system.
It is another important objective of the present invention to provide a system architecture and basic mode of operation which free the user from the need to get involved with the system hardware and the protocol of interprocessor communication. In the present invention every major component is modularized so that any major component can be removed or replaced without stopping the system. In addition, the system can be expanded in place (either horizontally by the addition of standard processor modules or in most cases vertically by the addition of peripheral devices) without system interruption or modification to hardware or software.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
The multiprocessor system of the present invention comprises multiple, independent processor modules and data paths.
In one specific embodiment of the present invention 16 separate processor modules are interconnected by an interprocessor bus for multiprocessing and multiprogramming. In this specific embodiment each processor module supports up to 32 device controllers, and each device controller can control up to eight peripheral devices.
Multiple, independent communication paths and ports are provided between all major components of the system to insure that it is always possible to communicate between processor modules and between processor modules and peripheral devices over at least two paths and also to insure that a single failure will not stop system operation.
These multiple communication paths include multiple interprocessor busses interconnecting each of the processor modules, multiports in each device controller, and input/output busses connecting each device controller for access by at least two different processor modules.
Each processor module is a standard module and includes as part of the module a central processing unit, a main memory, an interprocessor control and an input/output channel.
Each processor module has a pipelined microprocessor operated by microinstructions included as a basic instruction set in each processor module.
The basic instruction set in each processor module recognizes the fact that there is an interprocessor communications link; and when an additional processor module is added to the system, the operating system (a copy of which resides in each processor module) is informed that a new resource is available for operation within the existing operating system without the need to modify either the system hardward or software.
To increase performance and to maintain very high transaction rates each processor module includes a second microprocessor which is dedicated to input/output operations.
The input/output subsystem of the multiprocessor system of the present invention is constructed to insure that no single processor module failure can impair system operation.
In addition, the input/output subsystem is constructed to handle very high transaction rates, to maximize throughput, and to minimize interference with programs running in the processor modules.
As noted above, each processor module includes a microprocessor which is dedicated to input/output operations.
The input/output system is an interrupt driven system and provides a program interrupt only upon completion of the data transfer. This relieves the central processing unit from being dedicated to the device while it is transferring data.
Each input/output channel is block multiplexed to handle several block transfers of data from several device controllers on an apparent simultaneous basis. This is accomplished by interleaving variable length bursts of data in transfers between the input/output channel and stress responsive buffers in the device controllers.
As noted above, each device controller has multiports, and a separate input/output bus is connected to each port so that each device controller is connected for access by at least two different processor modules.
The ports of each device controller are constructed so that each port is logically and physically independent of each other port. No component part of one port is also a component of another port so that no single component failure in one port can affect the operation of another port.
Each device controller includes logic which insures that only one port is selected for access at a time so that transmitting erroneous data to one port can never contaminate another port.
Each device controller includes logic which insures that only one port is selected for access at a time. An enable latch in each port dynamically disables that port from placing any signals on the related input/output bus in response to a failure of any portion of the device controller, and the enable latch is not responsive to the processor module for re-enabling the port.
The device controller controls the transfer of information between a processor module and a peripheral device, and information is gated into a register in a port in a device controller in response to a gating signal generated by a processor module. Parity generation and check means continuously monitor parity for the duration of the gating signal.
Comprehensive error checks and provision for error containment are provided for all data transfers over the data paths of the multiprocessor system.
The error checks include check summing and parity checks on the data paths and error detection and correction in the main memory system.
The error checks also include time out limitations in the input/output channel.
Multiprocessor system apparatus and methods which incorporate the structure and techniques described above and which are effective to function as described above constitute further, specific objects of this invention.
Other and further objects of the present invention will be apparent from the following description and claims and are illustrated in the accompanying drawings which, by way of illustration, show preferred embodiments of the present invention and the principles thereof and what are now considered to be the best modes contemplated for applying these principles. Other embodiments of the invention embodying the same or equivalent principles may be used and structural changes may be made as desired by those skilled in the art without departing from the present invention and the purview of the appended claims.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
FIG. 1 is an isometric, block diagram view of a multiprocessor system constructed in accordance with one embodiment of the present invention. FIG. 1 shows several processor modules 33 connected by two interprocessor buses 35 (an X bus and a Y bus) with each bus controlled by a bus controller 37. FIG. 1 also shows several dual-port device controllers 41 with each device controller connected to the input/output (I/O) buses 39 of two processor modules.
FIG. 2 is a block diagram view showing details of the connections of the X bus controller and the Y bus controller to the individual processor modules. FIG. 2 shows, in diagrammatic form, the connections between each bus controller and the interprocessor control 55 of an individual processor module.
FIG. 3 is a detailed diagrammatic view of the logic of one of the bus controllers 37 shown in FIG. 2.
FIG. 4 is a detailed diagrammatic view of the logic for the shared output buffer and control 67 in the interprocessor control 55 of a processor module as illustrated in FIG. 2.
FIG. 5 is a view like FIG. 4 but showing the logic for an inqueue buffer and control 65 of the interprocessor control 55 for a processor module.
FIG. 6 is a state diagram of the logic 81 for a bus controller 37 and illustrates how the logic responds to the protocol lines going into the bus controller and generates the protocol lines going out of the bus controller to the processor modules.
FIG. 7 is a state diagram like FIG. 6 but showing the logic 73 and 75 for the shared outqueue buffer and control 67 of FIG. 4.
FIG. 8 is a state diagram like FIGS. 6 and 7 but showing the logic 93 and 101 for the inqueue buffer and control 65 of FIG. 5.
FIG. 9 is a diagrammatic view showing the time sequence for the transmission of a given packet between a sender processor module and a receiver processor module.
FIG. 10 is a logic diagram of the bus empty state logic section 75 and the processor fill state logic section 73 of the outqueue buffer and the control 67 shown in FIG. 4.
FIG. 11 is a listing of logic equations for the logic diagram shown in FIG. 10.
FIG. 12 is a block diagram of the input/output (I/O) system of the multiprocessor system shown in FIG. 1.
FIG. 13 is a block diagram of the input/output (I/O) channel 109 of a processor module. FIG. 13 shows the major components of the I/O channel and the data path relating those component parts.
FIG. 14 is a detailed view showing the individual lines in the I/O bus 39 of FIG. 1.
FIG. 15 is an I/O channel protocol diagram showing the state changes of the T bus 153 for an execute input/output (EIO) caused by the microprogram 115 in the CPU 105. The sequence illustrated is initiated by the CPU 105 and is transmitted through the I/O channel 109 of the processor module 33 and on the T bus 153 to a device controller 41 as shown in FIG. 1.
FIG. 16 is an I/O channel protocol diagram showing the state changes of the T bus 153 for a reconnect and data transfer sequence initiated by the I/O channel microprogram 121 in response to a request signal from a device controller 41.
FIG. 17 is an I/O channel protocol diagram showing the state changes of the T bus 153 for an interrogate I/O (IIO) instruction or an interrogate high priority I/O (HIIO) instruction initiated by the CPU microprogram 115. The sequence illustrated is transmitted over the T bus 153 to a device controller 41.
FIG. 18 is a table identifying the functions referred to by the mnemonics in FIGS. 15 through 17.
FIG. 19 is a block diagram showing the general structure of the ports 43 and a device controller 41 as illustrated in FIG. 1.
FIG. 20 is a block diagram of a port 43 shown in FIG. 19. This FIG. 20 shows primarily the data paths within a port 43.
FIG. 21 is a block diagram showing the data path details of the interface common logic 181 of the device controller 41 shown in FIG. 19.
FIG. 22 is a block diagram showing the component parts of a data buffer 189 in the control part of a device controller 41 as illustrated in FIG. 19.
FIG. 23 is a graph illustrating the operation of the data buffer 189 illustrated in FIGS. 22 and 19.
FIG. 24 is a timing diagram illustrating the relationship of SERVICE OUT (SVO) from the channel 109 to the loading of data into the port data register 213 (FIG. 21) and illustrates how the parity check is started before data is loaded into the register and is continued until after the data has been fully loaded into the register.
FIG. 25 is a schematic view showing details of the power on circuit (PON) shown in FIGS. 19 and 21.
FIG. 26 is a logic diagram of the buffer control logic 243 of the data buffer 189 (shown in FIG. 22) of a device controller 41. FIG. 26 shows how the buffer control logic 243 controls the handshakes on the data bus and controls the input and output pointers.
FIG. 27 is a listing of the logic equations for the select register 173 shown in FIG. 20. These logic equations are implemented by the port control logic 191 shown in FIG. 20.
FIG. 28 is a timing diagram showing the operation of the two line handshake between the I/O channel 109 and the ports 43.
FIG. 29 is a logic diagram showing the logic for the general case of the handshake shown in FIG. 28. The logic shown in FIG. 29 is part of the T bus machine 143 of the input/output channel 109 shown in FIG. 13.
FIG. 30 is a block diagram of a power distribution system. FIG. 30 shows how a plurality of independent and separate power supplies 303 are distributed and associated with the dual port device controllers 41 for insuring that each device controller has both a primary and an alternate power supply.
FIG. 31 is an enlarged, detailed view of the switching arrangement for switching between a primary power supply and an alternate supply for a device controller. The switching structure shown in FIG. 31 permits both automatic switching in the event of a failure of the primary power supply and manual switching in three different modes--off, auto and alternate.
FIG. 32 is a block diagram showing details of one of the separate and independent power supplies 303 illustrated in FIG. 30.
FIG. 33 is a blook diagram view showing details of the vertical buses and the horizontal buses for supplying power from the separate power supplies 303 shown in FIG. 30 to the individual device controllers 41. The particular bus arrangement shown in FIG. 33 permits easy selection of any two of the individual power supplies as the primary and the alternate power supply for a particular device controller.
FIG. 34 is a block diagram of the memory system and shows details of the memory 107 of a processor module 33 shown in FIG. 1.
FIG. 35 is a block diagram showing details of the map section 407 of the memory 107 shown in FIG. 34.
FIG. 36 is a block diagram showing the organization of logical memory into four logical address areas and four separate map sections corresponding to the four logical address areas. FIG. 36 also shows details of the bits and fields in a single map entry of a map section.
FIG. 37 is a block diagram showing details of one of the memory modules 403 illustrated in FIG. 34. The memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37 is a semiconductor memory module.
FIG. 38 is a diagram of a check bit generator used in the semiconductor memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37. FIG. 38 also lists logic equations for two of the eight bit parity trees used in the check bit register.
FIG. 39 is a diagram of a check bit comparator used in the semiconductor memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37. FIG. 39 includes the logic equation for nine bit parity tree for syndrome bit zero.
FIG. 40 is a diagram of a syndrome decoder used in the semiconductor memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37. FIG. 37 also lists the logic equations for the operation of the logic section 511 of the syndrome decoder.
FIG. 41 is a logic diagram of a bit complementer used in the semiconductor memory module 403 shown in FIG. 37.
FIG. 42 shows the various states of a two processor system running an application program which is required to be running continuously. The diagrams illustrate the two processors successively failing and being repaired and the application program changing its mode of operation accordingly.
DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENTS The Multiprocessor System
FIG. 1 is an isometric diagrammatic view of a part of a multiprocessor system constructed in accordance with one embodiment of the present invention. In FIG. 1 the multiprocessor system is indicated generally by the reference numeral 31.
The multiprocessor system 31 includes individual processor modules 33. Each processor module 33 comprises a central processing unit 105, a memory 107, an input/output channel 109 and an interprocessor control 55.
The individual processor modules are interconnected by interprocessor buses 35 for interprocessor communications.
In a specific embodiment of the multiprocessor system 31, up to sixteen processor modules 33 are interconnected by two interprocessor buses 35 (indicated as the X bus and the Y bus in FIG. 1).
Each interprocessor bus has a bus controller 37 associated with that bus.
The bus controllers 37, interprocessor buses 35 and interprocessor controls 55 (FIG. 1), together with associated microprocessors 113, microprograms 115 and bus receive tables 150 (FIG. 2) provide an interprocessor bus system. The construction and operation of this interprocessor bus system are illustrated in FIGS. 2-11 and 42 and are described in more detail below under the subtitle The Interprocessor Bus System.
The multiprocessor system 31 has an input/output (I/O) system for transferring data between the processor modules 33 and peripheral devices, such as the discs 45, terminals 47, magnetic tape drives 49, card readers 51, and line printers 53 shown in FIG. 1.
The I/O system includes one I/O bus 39 associated with each I/O channel 109 of a processor module and one or more multi-port device controllers 41 may be connected to each I/O bus 39.
In the specific embodiment illustrated, each device controller 41 has two ports 43 for connection to two different processor modules 33 so that each device controller is connected for access by two processor modules.
The I/O system includes a microprocessor 119 and a microprogram 121 in the I/O channel 109 (See FIG. 12.) which are dedicated to input/output transfers.
As also diagrammatically illustrated in FIG. 12, the microprocessor 113 and microprogram 115 of the central processing unit 105 and an input/output control table 140 in the main memory 107 of each processor module 33 are operatively associated with the I/O channel 109.
The construction and operation of these and other components of the I/O system are illustrated in FIGS. 12-29 and are described in detail below under the subtitle The Input/Output System and Dual Port Device Controller.
The multiprocessor system includes a power distribution system 301 which distributes power from separate power supplies to the processor modules 33 and to the device controllers 41 in a way that permits on-line maintenance and also provides redundancy of power on each device controller.
As illustrated in FIG. 30, the power distribution system includes separate and independent power supplies 303.
A separate power supply 303 is provided for each processor module 33, and a bus 305 supplies the power from the power supply 303 to the central processing unit 105 and memory 105 of a related processor module 33.
As also illustrated in FIG. 30, each device controller 41 is connected for supply of power from two separate power supplies 303 through an automatic switch 311. If one power supply 303 for a particular device controller 41 fails, that device controller is supplied with power from the other power supply 303; and the changeover is accomplished smoothly and without any interruption or pulsation in the power supplied to the device controller.
The power distribution system coacts with the dual port system of the device controller to provide continuous operation and access to the peripheral devices in the event of a failure of either a single port 43 or a single power supply 303.
The multiprocessor system includes a power on (PON) circuit 182 (the details of which are shown in Fig. 25) in several components of the system to establish that the power to that particular component is within certain acceptable limits.
For example, the PON circuit 182 is located in each CPU 105, in each device controller 41, and in each bus controller 37.
The purpose of the PON circuit is to present a signal establishing the level of power applied to that particular component; and if the power is not within certain predetermined acceptable limits, then the signal output is used to directly disable the appropriate bus signal of the component in which the PON is located.
The power-on circuit functions in four states--power off; power going from off to on; power on; and power going from on to off.
The power-on circuit initializes all of the logic states of the system as the power is brought up; and in the present invention, the power-on circuit provides an additional and very important function of providing for a fail-safe system with on line maintenance. To do this, the power-on circuit in the present invention is used in a unique way to control the interface circuits which drive all of the intercommunication buses in the system.
The construction and operation of the power distribution system are illustrated in FIGS. 30-33 and are described in detail below under the subtitle Power Distribution System.
The multiprocessor system includes a memory system in which the physical memory is divided into four logical address areas--user data, system data, user code and system code (See FIG. 36.).
The memory system includes a map 407 and control logic 401 (See FIG. 34.) for translating all logical addresses to physical addresses and for indicating pages absent from primary storage bit present in secondary storage as required to implement a virtual memory system in which the physical page addresses are invisible to users.
The memory system incorporates a dual port access to the memory by the central processing unit 105 and the I/O channel 109. The I/O channel 109 can therefore access the memory 107 directly (without having to go through the central processing unit 105) for data transfers to and from a device controller 41.
The construction and operation of the memory system are illustrated in FIGS. 34-41 and are described in detail below under the subtitle Memory System.
An error detection system is incorporated in the memory system for correcting all single bit and detecting all double bit errors when semiconductor memory is used in the memory system. This error detection system utilizes a 16 bit data field and a 6 bit check field as shown in FIG. 37 and includes a data bit complementer 487 as also shown in FIG. 37 for correcting single bit errors.
FIGS. 37 through 41 and the related disclosure illustrate and describe details of the error detection system.
Before going into the detailed description of the systems and components noted generally above, it should be noted that certain terminology will have the following meanings as used in this application.
The term "software" will refer to an operating system or a user program instructions; the term "firmware" will refer to a microprogram in read only memory; and the term "hardware" will refer to actual electronic logic and data storage.
The operating system is a master control program executing in each processor module which has primary control of the allocation of all system resources accessible to that processor module. The operating system provides a scheduling function and determines what process has use of that processor module. The operating system also allocates the use of primary memory (memory management), and it operates the file system for secondary memory management. The operating system also manages the message system. This provides a facility for information transfer over the interprocessor bus.
The operating system arrangement parallels the modular arrangement of the multiprocessor system components described above, in that there are no "global" components.
At the lowest level of the software system, two fundamental entities are implemented--processes and messages.
A process is the fundamental entity of control within a system.
Each process consists of a private data space and register values, and a possibly shared code set. A process may also access a common data space.
A number of processes coexist in a processor module 33.
The processes may be user written programs, or the processes may have dedicated functions, such as, for example, control of an I/O device or the creation and deletion of other processes.
A process may request services from another process, and this other process may be located in the same processor module 33 as a process making the request, or the other process may be located in some other processor module 33.
The processes work in an asynchronous manner, and the processes therefore need a method of communication that will allow a request for services to be queued without "races" (a condition in which the outcome depends upon the sequence of which process started first)--thus the need for "messages" (an orderly system of interprocessor module communication described in more detail below).
Also, all interprocessor module communication should appear the same to the processes, regardless of whether the processes are in the same or in different processor modules.
As will become more clear from the description to follow, the software structure parallels the hardware; and different processes can be considered equivalent to certain components of the hardware in arrangement and function.
For example, just as the I/O channel 109 communicates over the I/O bus 39 to the device controller 41, a user process can make a request (using the message system) to the process associated with that device controller 41; and then the device process returns status back similar to the way the device controller 41 returns information back to the I/O channel 109 over the I/O bus 39.
The other fundamental entity of the software system, the message, consists of a request for service as well as any required data. When the request is completed, any required values will be returned to the requesting process.
When a message is to be sent between processes in two different processor modules 33, the interprocessor buses 35 are used. However, as noted above, all communication between processes appears the same to the processes, regardless of whether they are in the same or in different processor modules 33.
This software organization provides a number of benefits.
This method of structuring the software also provides for significantly more reliable software. By being able to compartmentalize the software structure, smaller module sizes can be obtained, and the interfaces between modules are well defined.
The system is also more maintainable because of the compartmentalization of function.
The well defined modules and the well defined interfaces in the software system also provide advantages in being able to make it easily expandible--as in the case of adding additional processor modules 33 or device controllers 41 to the multiprocessor system.
Furthermore, there is a benefit to the user of the multiprocessor system and software system in that the user, writing his program, need not be aware of either the actual machine configuration or the physical location of other processes.
Just as the hardware provides multiple functionally equivalent modules with redundant interconnects, so does the software.
For example, messages going between processes in different processor modules 33 may use either interprocessor bus 35. Also, device controllers 41 may be operated by processes in either of the processor modules 33 connected to the device controller 41.
The multiprocessor hardware system and software system described above enable the user to develop a fault tolerant application system by virtue of its replicated modules with redundant interconnects.
The Interprocessor Bus System
As pointed out above, the individual processor modules 33 are interconnected by two interprocessor buses 35 (an X bus and a Y bus) with each bus controlled by a related bus controller 37. Each interprocessor bus 35, in combination with its bus controller 37 and a related interprocessor control 55 in each processor module 33, provides a multi-module communication path from any one processor module to any other processor module in the system. The use of two buses assures that two independent paths exist between all processor modules in the system. Therefore, a failure in one path (one bus) does not prevent communication between the processor modules.
The bus controller 37 for each interprocessor bus 35 is a controller which is, in a preferred form of the invention, separate and distinct from the processor modules 33.
Each interprocessor bus 35 is a synchronous bus with the time synchronization provided by a bus clock generator in the bus controllers 37. The interprocessor control portions 55 of all of the modules associated with the bus make state changes in synchronism with that bus clock during transfers over the bus.
As will be described in more detail below, the CPU 105 operates on a different clock from the interprocessor bus clock. During the filling of an outqueue or the emptying of an inqueue in the interprocessor control 55 by the CPU, the operation takes place at the CPU clock rate. However, transmission of packets over the interprocessor bus always takes place at the bus clock rate.
It is an important feature of the present invention that the information transmitted over the interprocessor bus is transferred at high transmission rates without any required correspondence to the clock rates of the various CPUs 105. The information transfer rate over the interprocessor bus is also substantially faster than would be permitted by direct memory accesses into and out of the memory sections 107 at memory speed. This ensures that there is adequate bus bandwidth even when a large number of processor modules is connected in a multiprocessor system.
A benefit of using separate clocks for each CPU 105 is that a master system clock is not required, and this eliminates a potential source of single component failure which could stop the entire system.
The interprocessor control 55 incorporates logic interlocks which make it possible to operate the interprocessor buses 35 at one clock rate and each CPU 105 at its own independent clock rate without loss of data.
The information transmitted over the bus is transmitted in multiword packets. In a preferred form of the present invention each packet is a sixteen word packet in which fifteen of the words are data words and one word is a check word.
The control logic within the bus controller 37 and the interprocessor controls 55 of the individual modules 33 follows a detailed protocol. The protocol provides for establishing a sender-receiver pair and a time frame for the data packet transfer. At the end of the time frame for the transmission of the data packet, the bus controller 37 is released for another such sequence. The specific manner in which these functions are carried out will become more apparent after a description of the structural features of FIGS. 3-9 below.
X bus 35 is identical in structure to the Y bus 35, so the structure of only one bus will be described in detail.
As illustrated in FIG. 2, each bus 35 comprises sixteen individual bus data lines 57, five individual bus protocol lines 59, and one clock line 61, and one select line 63 for each processor module 33.
As also illustrated in FIG. 2, the interprocessor control 55 of each processor module 33 includes two inqueue sections 65 (shown as an X inqueue section and a Y inqueue section in FIG. 2) and a shared outqueue section 67.
With the specific reference to FIG. 4, the shared outqueue section 67 includes an outqueue buffer 69 which performs a storage function. In a preferred form the buffer 69 has sixteen words of sixteen bits each. The buffer 69 is loaded by the CPU and holds the data until the packet transmission time, at which time the data is gated out to the bus, as will be described in more detail below.
The outqueue section 67 also includes a receive register 71, which in a preferred form of the invention is a four bit register. This register is loaded by the CPU with the number of the processor module to which the data will be sent.
The control part of the outqueue section 67 includes a processor fill state logic section 73 which operates in synchronism with the CPU clock, a bus empty state logic section 75 which operates in synchronism with the X or Y bus clock, and an outqueue counter 77. During filling of the outqueue buffer 69 by the CPU, the outqueue counter 77 scans the buffer 69 to direct the data input into each of the sixteen words of the buffer; and, as the sixteenth word is stored into the outqueue buffer 69, the outqueue counter 77 terminates the fill state.
The outqueue section 67 also includes an outqueue pointer 79 which connects the entire outqueue section to either the X bus or the Y bus 35. The outqueue pointer 79 allows the logic sections 73 and 75 and the buffer 69 to be shared by the X and Y interprocessor buses 35.
As illustrated in FIG. 3, the bus controller 37 comprises a bus control state logic section 81, a sender counter 83, a processor select logic section 85, a receive register 87, a packet counter 89 and a bus clock generator 91.
With reference to FIG. 5, each inqueue section 65 comprises a bus fill state logic section 93 which operates in synchronism with the bus clock, a sender register 95, an inqueue buffer 97, an inqueue counter 99, and a processor empty state logic section 101 which operates in synchronism with the CPU clock.
FIG. 6 is a state diagram of the bus control logic 81 of the bus controller 37.
FIG. 7 is a state diagram of the logic sections 73 and 75 of the outqueue section 67.
FIG. 8 is a state diagram of the logic sections 93 and 101 of the inqueue sections 65.
With reference to FIG. 7, the processor fill state logic section 73 has basically four states--EMPTY, FILL, FULL and WAIT--as indicated by the respective legends. The bus empty state logic section 75 has basically four states--IDLE, SYNC, SEND and DONE--as illustrated by the legends.
Continuing with a description of the notation in FIG. 7, the solid lines with arrows indicate transitions from the present state to the next state. Dashed arrows ending on the solid arrows indicate conditions which must be satisfied for the indicated transition to take place.
The synchronization of state machines running off relatively asynchronous clocks require a careful construction of an interlock system. These important interlocks are noted by the dashed arrows in the state diagrams. These interlocks perform a synchronization of two relatively asynchronous state machines. The dashed arrows in FIG. 7 and FIG. 8 running between the state machines thus indicate signals which synchronize (qualify) the indicated transistions of the state machines.
With reference to the FILL state for the logic section 73, it should be noted that the store outqueue condition will not cause an exit from the FILL state until the outqueue counter 77 has advanced to count 15 (on a count which starts with zero) at which time the FILL state will advance to the FULL state.
Similarly, it should be noted that the SEND state of the logic section 75 will not terminate on the select and send command condition until the outqueue counter 77 reaches count 15, at which time the SEND state advances to the DONE state.
The asterisk in the notation of FIG. 7 indicates an increment of the outqueue counter 77.
FIG. 6 shows the state diagram for logic 81 of the bus controller and illustrates that the logic has basically four states--IDLE, POLL, RECEIVE and SEND.
The notation in FIG. 6 is the same as that described above for FIG. 7. A solid arrow line indicates a state transition from one state to another and a dotted arrow line to that solid arrow line indicates a condition which must occur to allow the indicated (solid line arrow) transition to occur. An asterisk on a state transition in this case indicates that simultaneously with the indicated transition the sender counter 83 is incremented by one.
The dashed arrow output lines in FIG. 6 indicate protocol commands issued from the bus controller to the interprocessor bus.
In both FIG. 7 and FIG. 6 a dashed arrow leaving a state indicates a logic output from that state such as a logic output signal to a protocol line (in the case of the bus empty state logic 75) or to a status line of the processor module (in the case of the processor fill state logic 73).
FIG. 8 shows the state diagrams for the bus fill state logic section 93 and the processor empty state logic section 101.
The state diagram for the logic section 93 includes four states--SYNC, ACKNOWLEDGE, RECEIVE and FULL.
The state diagram for the logic section 101 includes four states--RESET, READY, INTERRUPT and DUMP.
The notation (solid line arrows and dashed line arrows) is the same as described above for FIG. 7 and FIG. 6.
The asterisk in FIG. 8 indicates an increment in the inqueue counter 99.
FIG. 9 is a timing diagram showing the time sequence in which the state changes given in FIGS. 6, 7 and 8 occur.
The sequence shown in FIG. 9 accomplishes the transmission of a packet from one processor module to another processor module at the bus clock rate (assuming that the intended receiver module is ready to receive the packet).
FIG. 9 shows the time sequences for a successful packet transfer with individual signal representations listed from top-to-bottom in FIG. 9 and with time periods of one bus clock each shown from left-to-right in the order of increasing time in FIG. 9.
The top line in FIG. 9 indicates the state of the bus controller, and each division mark represents a clock period or cycle of the bus clock generator 91 shown in FIG. 3. Each time division of the top line carries down vertically through the various signal representations listed by the legends at the left side of the figure.
Taking the signals in the sequence presented from top-to-bottom in FIG. 9, the first signal (below the bus controller state line) is the SEND REQUEST signal (one of the protocol group indicated by the reference numeral 59 in FIG. 3) and specifically is the signal which may be asserted by the outqueue control logic section 67 of any processor module 33. The signal is transmitted to the bus control state logic section 81 of the bus controller 37 (see FIG. 3).
The next signal shown in FIG. 9 (the SELECT signal) represents a signal which originates from the processor select logic section 85 of the bus controller 37 and which is transmitted on only one at a time of the select lines 63 to a related processor module 33.
The next signal represented in FIG. 9, the SEND ACKNOWLEDGE signal, may be asserted only by a particular processor 33 when that processor is selected and when its bus empty state logic section 75 is in the SEND state (as illustrated in the third state of FIG. 7). This SEND ACKNOWLEDGE signal is used by the bus controller 37 to establish the identity of a processor module 33 wishing to send a packet.
The next signal, the RECEIVE COMMAND signal, represents a signal from the bus controller 37 transmitted on one of the protocol lines 59. This signal does two things.
First of all, this signal in combination with receiver SELECT interrogates the receiver processor module 33 to find out whether this receiver module is ready to receive (as indicated by the ACKNOWLEDGE state in FIG. 8).
Secondly, this signal has a secondary function of disabling the bus empty state logic section 75 of the receiving module so that the receiving module cannot gate an intended receiver number to the data bus should the outqueue section of the intended receiver module 33 also have a data packet of its own ready to send.
In this regard, during the time that the sender processor is asserting the SEND ACKNOWLEDGE signal it is also gating the receiver number to the bus for use by the bus controller 37. The bus 35 itself is, of course, a non-directional bus so that the information can be gated to the data bus 57 by any module for use by either the bus controller 37 for a control function or for use by another processor for an information transfer function. It should be noted that a module 33 may gate data to the bus only when its SELECT line is asserted and the RECEIVE COMMAND signal is not asserted.
During the time that the RECEIVE COMMAND signal is asserted the bus controller 37 is gating the sender number to the data bus 57 for capture by the selected receiver processor module.
The next signal line (the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE line in FIG. 9) represents a signal which is transmitted from the selected receiving module's bus fill state logic section 93 to the bus control state logic section 81 of the bus controller 37 (over one of the protocol lines 59) to indicate that the selected receiver module is in the ACKNOWLEDGE state (as indicated by the legend in FIG. 8) and thus ready to receive the packet which the sender module has ready to transmit.
If the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal is not asserted by the receiver module, the sender SELECT, the SEND COMMAND and the time frame transmission of the data packet itself will not occur.
If the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal is asserted, then the sequence indicated by the SEND COMMAND line will occur.
The SEND COMMAND line represents a signal which originates from the bus control state logic section 81 of the bus controller 37 and which is transmitted to the bus empty state logic section 75 of the sender processor module 33 over one of the protocol lines 59.
In combination with a SELECT of the sender processor module the SEND COMMAND signal enables the sender processor module to send a packet to the receiver module during the sixteen clock cycles bracketed by the SEND COMMAND signal.
The final line (the data/16 line) represents the information present on the data lines 57 during the above-described sequence.
The data is gated to the bus by the selected sender processor module and is transmitted to the receiver processor module into the inqueue buffer 97 (see FIG. 5) during this sixteen clock cycle time frame. This assumes that the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal was received by the bus controller in response to the RECEIVE COMMAND signal.
If the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal had not been received by the bus controller, then the SEND COMMAND signal would not have been asserted and the bus controller 37 would have resumed the POLL state as shown in FIG. 6.
With reference to FIGS. 2, 7, 10 and 11, a typical operation of the outqueue buffer and control 67 of one processor module 33 will now be described.
As illustrated in FIG. 10, the processor fill state logic section 73 includes two flip-flops A and B, and the bus empty state logic section 75 includes two flip-flops C and D.
Summarizing the state assignments as shown by the AB and CD tables in FIG. 10, the EMPTY state is defined as A=0, B=0. The FILL state is defined as A=1, B=0. The FULL state is defined as A=1, B=1; and the WAIT state is defined as A=0, B=1.
Similarly, the corresponding combinations of the C and D state variables are defined to be the IDLE, SYNC, SEND and DONE states respectively. State assignments previously listed could also be given in form of logic equations. For example, EMPTY=A·B, and this notation is utilized in the FIG. 11 logic equation listings.
In operation and with specific reference to FIG. 7, the initial state reached through power on initialization or manual reset is the EMPTY state shown in the top left part of FIG. 7.
The EMPTY state of the processor fill state logic 73 provides a ready signal to the central processor unit (CPU) 105 to indicate the presence of that state, as indicated by the dashed arrow RDY shown as leaving the empty state in FIG. 7.
The CPU firmware (microprogram) in response to that ready signal, when a transmission over the interprocessor bus is required, will provide a store receive signa1 (shown by the dashed arrow incoming to the diagram in FIG. 7). This store receive signal qualifies (synchronizes) the transition which advances the EMPTY state to the FILL state.
The CPU firmware, to transfer data into the outqueue buffer 69, will provide a store outqueue signal (the dashed arrow entering the diagram in FIG. 7) for each word to be stored in the buffer 69.
Each occurrence of this store outqueue signal will advance the outqueue counter 77, commencing with a count of zero, until a count of 15 is reached.
On the sixteenth occurrence of the store outqueue signal a transition from the FILL to the FULL state, as illustrated by the solid line arrow in FIG. 7, is allowed.
The FULL state of the processor FILL state logic provides a synchronization condition to the bus empty state logic denoted by the dashed arrow leaving the FULL state of logic 73 and going down to the logic 75 in FIG. 7.
The processor fill state logic 73 will remain in the FULL state until the bus empty state logic 75 has subsequently reached the DONE state.
Now, referring specifically to the bus empty state logic denoted by 75 in FIG. 7, the initial state, IDLE, for the logic section 75 in FIG. 7 is again provided by power on initialization or manual reset.
The bus empty state logic 75 will remain in the IDLE state until the transistion to the SYNC state is allowed as shown by the dashed arrow from the FULL state of the processor fill 73.
The empty state logic 75 will proceed with no qualification required from the SYNC state to the SEND state.
It is in the SEND state that the SEND REQUEST signal to the bus and to the bus cohtroller is asserted (as indicated by the dashed arrow going down and leaving the diagram 75 from the SEND state).
In response to this SEND REQUEST signal, the bus controller logic 81 (FIG. 6) will poll processor modules successively until the sender is identified (as discussed earlier with reference to FIG. 9).
The bus controller will issue a RECEIVE COMMAND and SELECT to the intended receiver processor module; and upon receipt of the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal will proceed to the packet time frame (also identified in FIG. 9).
During the packet time frame the bus controller asserts SELECT of the sender processor module and also asserts the SEND COMMAND signal to the sender processor module.
This SELECT signal and SEND COMMAND signal is shown as entering the diagram and qualifying (synchronizing) transitions leaving and entering the SEND state as noted in FIG. 7.
Each bus clock while SELECT and SEND COMMAND are asserted will advance the outqueue counter 77 commencing with a count of zero.
On the sixteenth clock period of SELECT and SEND COMMAND the transition terminating the SEND state and advancing to the DONE state is qualified (synchronized as shown by the dashed arrow allowing that transition).
When the empty state logic 75 has reached the DONE state, a transition of the processor fill state logic 73 from FULL to WAIT is qualified (as denoted by the dashed arrow leaving the done state).
Next, the WAIT state of the processor fill state logic 73 qualifies a transition of the bus empty state logic 75 from the DONE state to the IDLE state (as denoted by a dashed arrow leaving the WAIT state and qualifying the indicated transition).
Finally, the bus empty state logic 75, being in the IDLE state, qualifies the transition of the processor fill state logic 73 from the WAIT state to the EMPTY state (as denoted by the dashed arrow leaving the IDLE state).
At this point a packet has been loaded into the outqueue buffer 69 by the processor module and transmitted over the bus 35 to the receiver processor module, and the outqueue control processor fill state logic 73 and bus empty state logic 75 have returned to their initial states.
The above description relates to the transitions and qualifications indicated in FIG. 7. The action of the logic sections 73 and 75 involved in the above description of operation of FIG. 7 will now be noted with reference to the logic diagram of FIG. 10 and the logic equation listing of FIG. 11.
With reference to FIG. 10, as noted above, the flip-flops A and B are JK flip-flops and are edge triggered flip-flops in that state changes occur only on clock transitions (as indicated by the small triangular symbols and legends on the lefthand sides of the flip-flops A and B in FIG. 10).
The primary significance of the logic diagram in FIG. 10 is to illustrate the transition from one state to another in the state machines shown in FIG. 7. Thus, to illustrate the transition from IDLE to SYNC in the empty state logic 75, the operation proceeds as follows.
To implement a change from the IDLE state to the SYNC state, the state variable C must be set.
The logic equation for the J input of state variable C is as shown in FIG. 11 and is indicated by the reference numeral 103. In this equation the interlock (shown by the dashed arrow from the full state of the fill state logic 73 in FIG. 7 to the transition) corresponds to the quantity (A·B) or (FULL) in the equation indicated by the reference number 103. The D or (IDLE) in the equation indicated by reference numeral 103 in FIG. 11 corresponds to the IDLE state shown by the legend in FIG. 7. The J in the equation corresponds to the J input of the C flip-flop in FIG. 10. And the (C) corresponds to the true output of the C flip-flop in FIG. 10.
Other state transitions of the FIG. 7 diagram will not be described in further detail with reference to FIGS. 10 and 11 since it is believed that these transitions as carried out by the logic diagram in FIG. 10 and the logic equations in FIG. 11 are clear from the above examples of the transition from IDLE state to SYNC state as described in detail above.
FIGS. 10 and 11 show the logic diagram and logic equations for the state diagram of the outqueue buffer and control 67. Corresponding logic diagrams and logic equations have not been illustrated for the inqueue buffer and control 65 or the bus controller 37 because such logic diagrams and equations are similar to those shown in FIG. 10 and FIG. 11 and are easily obtainable from the state diagrams shown in FIGS. 6 and 8.
Each processor module 33 (FIG. 1) in the multiprocessor system is connected to both interprocessor buses 35 (FIG. 1) and is capable of communicating with any processor module including itself over either bus. For each block data transfer, one processor module is the source or sender and another is the destination or receiver.
Transmission of data by a processor module over one of the interprocessor buses is initiated and accomplished under software control by means of the SEND instruction.
In the SEND instruction the microprogram 115 (FIG. 2) and the CPU microprocessor 113 (FIG. 2) interacts with the shared outqueue section 67 of the interprocessor control 55 to read a data block from memory 101 to break it up into packets, to calculate packet check sum words, and to transmit the block one packet at a time over a bus to the receiving processor module. Parameters supplied to the SEND instruction specify the number of words in the block, the starting address of the block, which bus to use, the destination processor, and a maximum initial timeout value to wait for the outqueue 67 (FIG. 2) to become available.
The SEND instruction terminates only after the entire block has been transmitted; thus sending a block is a single event from the software viewpoint. However, the SEND instruction is interruptable and resumable, so that response of the operating system to other events is not impaired by the length of the time required to complete a SEND instruction.
Receiving of data by a processor module over the interprocessor buses is not done by means of a software instruction, since the arrival times and sources of data packets cannot be predicted. The receiving of data is enabled but cannot be initiated by the receiver.
The CPU microprocessor 113 takes time out from software instruction processing as required to execute the BUS RECEIVE microprogram 115. This microprogram takes the received data packet from one of the inqueue sections 65 (FIG. 2) of the interprbcessor control 55, stores the data into a memory buffer, and verifies correct packet check sum.
Reassembly of received packets into blocks is accomplished using the Bus Receive Table 150 (BRT) in memory. The BRT contains 32 two-word entries, corresponding to the two buses from each of the sixteen processor modules possible in one specific implementation of the multiprocessor system. Each BRT entry corresponding to a bus and a sender contains an address word and a count word. The address word specifies into which buffer in the System Data area incoming data from that sender is to be stored. The count word specifies how many data words remain to complete the block transfer from that sender.
As each data packet is received, the CPU microprocessor 113 suspends processing of software instructions, and the bus receive microprogram 115 is activated. This microprogram reads the address and count words from the sender's BRT entry, stores the data packet into the specified area, verifies correct packet check sum, and restores adjusted values of the address and count words into the BRT entry. If the packet caused the count to reach zero or if the packet contained incorrect check sum, the bus receive microprogram sets a completion interrupt flag to signal termination of the data block to the software. The CPU microprogram then resumes software instruction processing at the point where it left off with no disturbance except delay to the currently executing program.
It is an important feature that data blocks from several senders can all be assembled concurrently by a receiving processor module from data packets received in any sequence. This interleaved assembly of blocks from packets is carried on transparently to the software executing in the receiver processor. Only successful block completions or erroneous transmissions cause the software to be interrupted.
It is also important that a time-sharing or time-slicing of the interprocessor bus hardware has been achieved in two areas.
First, each interprocessor bus and associated bus controller allow packets to be transmitted between any sender and receiver as required. The circular polling by a bus controller to identify a requesting sender ensures that all processor modules have an equal opportunity to send over that bus. Each bus provides a communication path which is shared in time in an unbiased way by all processor modules.
Secondly, each inqueue section 65 of the interprocessor control 55 of a processor module is shared in time by incoming packets from several senders. That is, the inqueue logic and storage of a processor is not dedicated to a single sender for the duration of a block transfer. Instead, each packet received is correctly directed into memory by the BRT entry corresponding to its sender and bus. Data blocks from several senders are assembled correctly in the receiver's memory independently of the order in which the senders make use of the bus.
A processor module has two ways of controlling its ability to receive packets over the X bus or the Y bus.
First, there is a bit in the CPU's interrupt MASK register corresponding to each interprocessor bus. When the MASK bit is on, micro-interrupts for that bus are allowed. Micro-interrupts (activation of the BUS RECEIVE microprogram) occur when the Processor Empty state logic 101 (FIG. 5) of an inqueue section 65 reaches the MICRO-INT state after a packet has been received into an inqueue buffer. If the MASK bit is off when a packet is received, the micro-interrupt and subsequent processing of the packet into memory will be deferred until the MASK bit is set on by a software instruction.
Software operations such as changing a BRT entry are performed with micro-interrupts disabled to avoid unpredictable results. No packets are lost while micro-interrupts are disabled. The first packet received will be held in the inqueue buffer until the micro-interrupt is enabled. Subsequent packet transfers while the inqueue buffer is full are rejected since the Bus Fill state 93 logic will be in the FULL state and thus unable to assert RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE in response to SELECT.
A second means of controlling its ability to receive packets over the bus is the action taken by a processor module after an X bus or Y bus receive completion interrupt (activation of an operating system interrupt handler).
When a check sum error is detected in a received packet or when the BRT word count remaining in a data block reaches zero as a packet is stored into memory, the BUS RECEIVE microprogram sets the X bus or Y bus completion interrupt flag. Otherwise, the microprogram issues the RINT signal (see FIG. 8) to the inqueue Processor Empty state logic 101 to allow another packet to be received. When the completion flag is set, however, the RINT signal is not issued.
It is thus the responsibility of the bus receive completion software interrupt handler to issue the RINT signal (by means of an RIR software instruction) to reenable the inqueue 65. Until this occurs, the inqueue Bus Fill state logic 93 remains in the FULL state and no additional packets will be received.
The completion interrupt signal can therefore designate either a block data transfer that has been sent and received without error, or it can designate a partial transfer in which a check sum error is detected, and in which partial transfer of the completion interrupt is generated as a result of the check sum error detected. In the latter case, the sender continues to send the data block but the receiver discards the data block after the check sum error has been detected. This error shows up in the bus receive table (BRT) count word as a negative value. This will become more apparent from the description of the operation which follows.
The SEND instruction is an instruction that requires four parameter words in the CPU register stack.
The first of the four parameter words is a count of the number of words to be transferred. This value must match the number expected by the BRT in the receiver processor module if the transfer is to complete successfully.
The second parameter word is the address, minus one, in the System Data area in the sender processor's memory where the data to be transferred is located.
The third parameter word is a timeout value allotted to completing a sin91e packet (fifteen data word) transfer. The timeout period is restarted for each packet transferred by the SEND instruction.
The fourth parameter word specifies the bus (whether the X bus or the Y bus) to be used and specifies the receiver processor module. The high order bit of the parameter specifies the bus and the low order four bits, in one specific implementation of the invention, specify the number of the receiver processor module.
At the completion of a SEND instruction, there are two possible conditions.
The first condition is that a packet timeout occurred and the remaining packets were not transmitted and the instruction was terminated at that point. In this event the remaining packets of the block are not transmitted.
The second condition is an indication that a successful data block transfer has been completed.
Thus, in initial summary of the SEND operation, the SEND instruction fills the outqueue buffer 69 (FIG. 4) with fifteen data words, appends an odd-parity check sum, and signals the bus controller 37 that it has a packet ready for transmission. After each sixteen word packet is transmitted, execution of the SEND instruction resumes at the point where it left off. If the last packet of the block has less than fifteen words, the remaining words are filled in with zeros. The instruction terminates when the last packet is transmitted.
FIG. 5 shows the logic diagram and FIG. 7 shows the state diagram for the send hardware.
The first action of the SEND instruction sequence is to issue the S/RECEIVE signal to the processor fill state logic 73 (FIG. 4) and to supply on the M Bus (FIG. 4) the receiver processor number to the receive register 71. Simultaneously, the pointer of the outqueue pointer 79 is set in accordance with the high order bit of the M Bus to connect the outqueue 67 to either the X bus or the Y bus.
The store receive (S/RECEIVE) signal causes the processor fill state logic 73 (which is initially in the empty state as shown in FIG. 7) to advance to the FILL state as shown in FIG. 7. This state transition causes the receive register 71 (FIG. 4) to be loaded with the receiver processor number.
At this point the outqueue section 67 is ready for the data packet to be loaded into the outqueue buffer 69. Now, up to fifteen words are read from memory and are stored, by means of the M bus (FIG. 4), into the outqueue buffer 69. The store outqueue signal causes each word on the M bus to be written into the outqueue buffer 69 in a location specified by the outqueue counter 77. Each store outqueue signal also causes the outqueue counter 77 to be advanced by one.
As the words are being read from memory, the address word is being incremented by one, and the count of the words to be sent is being decremented by one. If the count reaches zero before fifteen words are read from memory, the remainder of the outqueue buffer is filled with zeros to pad out the data packet.
In addition, as the words are being loaded into the outqueue buffer 69, the microprogram 115 (FIG. 2) is calculating a modulo-two sum of the data words. After the fifteenth data word has been loaded, this odd check-sum word is loaded into the sixteenth location of the outqueue buffer 69.
At this time the outqueue counter 77 has a value of count 15 and this value, in combination with the store outqueue signal, causes the processor fill state logic 73 to advance from the FILL state to the FULL state as shown in FIG. 7.
At this point the microprogram 115 has completed loading of the data into the outqueue 69. The microprogram now waits for the packet to be transmitted by testing for occurrence of the ready (RDY) signal shown in FIG. 7.
While waiting for the packet to be transmitted, the microprogram 115 increments a timer; and if the timer runs out or expires before the ready (RDY) signal is asserted, the microprogram issues the clear outqueue (CLOQ) signal to the processor fill state logic 73 (see FIG. 4). This causes the processor fill state logic 73 to return to the empty state as shown in FIG. 7, and the microprogram then terminates the SEND instruction with the time out indication.
In normal operation, the FULL state of the processor fill state logic 73 qualifies the bus empty state logic 75 to advance from the IDLE state to the SYNC state shown in FIG. 7. Next, the SYNC state automatically advances to the SEND state, and this state causes the SEND REQUEST signal to be issued to the bus controller 37. The SEND REQUEST signal initiates a packet transfer sequence described earlier.
As described earlier, when the sender processor module has been identified by the bus controller 37 by polling, and when the receiver processor module has accepted the packet transfer by means of the RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE signal, the data packet is gated from the outqueue buffer 69 through the outqueue pointer 79 to one of the data buses 57 for loading into the inqueue of the receiver processor module.
As the sixteenth word is gated to the bus, the value of the outqueue counter count 15, in combination with the SEND COMMAND signal and the SENDER SELECT signal causes the SEND state of the bus empty state logic 75 to advance to the DONE state.
The DONE state qualifies the FULL state of the processor fill state logic 73 (as shown by the dashed line arrow going from the DONE state to the indicated transition from the FULL state in FIG. 7) to advance to the WAIT state.
Next, the WAIT state qualifies the DONE state to advance to the IDLE state as illustrated by the state diagram in FIG. 7.
Finally, the IDLE state qualifies the WAIT state to advance to the EMPTY state as also indicated in the state diagram of FIG. 7.
The EMPTY state, of the processor fill state logic 73, provides the READY indication to the microprogram 115.
If the packet just transmitted was the last packet in the specified data block, the SEND instruction is terminated and the successful block transfer indication is given.
If the packet transmitted is not the last packet in a data block, then the sequence described above is repeated until all words in the block have been transmitted, or until a timeout error has occurred.
The SEND instruction is interruptable and resumable; however, the SEND instruction is only interruptable between packets; and the interruption of the SEND instruction has no effect on the data transmitted.
Thus, by means of a single software instruction (the SEND instruction) a data block of up to 32,767 words is transmittable from a sender processor module to a receiver processor module, and accuracy of the transmission is checked by the packet check-sum. Also, the transmission occurs at a high data transfer rate, because the buffering provided by the outqueue buffer 69 of the sender processor module enables the transfer to be made at interprocessor bus speed independent of the memory speed of the sender processor module. This allows efficient use of this communication path between a number of processor modules on a time slicing basis.
As noted above, there is no instruction for receive.
For a processor module to receive data over an interprocessor bus, the operating system in that processor module must first configure an entry in the bus receive table (BRT). Each BRT entry contains the address where the incoming data is stored and the number of words expected.
While the sender processor module is executing the send instruction and sending data over the bus, the bus receive hardware and the microprogram 115 in the receiver processor module are storing the data away according to the appropriate BRT entry (this occurs interleaved with software program execution).
When the receiver processor module receives the expected number of words from a given sender, the currently executing program is interrupted, and that particular bus transfer is completed.
FIG. 5 shows the logic diagram and FIG. 8 shows the state diagram for the bus receive hardware.
As previously pointed out, there are identical X and Y inqueue sections 65 in each processor module for the X bus and the Y bus. Only one of the inqueue sections will therefore be referred to the description which follows.
After initial reset of a processor module, or after a previous receive operation, the RESET state of the processor empty state logic 101 advances to the READY state. The READY state qualifies the SYNC state of the bus fill state logic 93 to advance the logic to the ACKNOWLEDGE state.
In this ACKNOWLEDGE state the inqueue section 65 returns RECEIVE ACKNOWLEDGE to the bus controller 37 in response to a SELECT 63 (see FIG. 2) of that processor module 33. This indicates the readiness of the X inqueue section 65 to receive the data packet.
In the packet transfer sequence (described in detail above) the combination of the SELECT of that processor module and the RECEIVE COMMAND signal qualify the ACKNOWLEDGE state of the bus fill state logic 93 and to advance to the RECEIVE state.
At this state transition the sender register 95 (FIG. 5) is loaded with the number of the sending processor module.
In the RECEIVE state the data packet is loaded from the data bus to the inqueue buffer 97 under control of the inqueue counter 99.
As the sixteenth word of the packet is loaded, it causes the RECEIVE state to advance to the FULL state (see FIG. 8).
Now the FULL state qualifies the READY state of the processor empty state logic 101 to advance to the MICROINTERRUPT state as shown in FIG. 8. The MICROINTERRUPT state presents an INQUEUE FULL state to the CPU interrupt logic. This INQUEUE FULL signal causes a microinterrupt to occur at the end of the next software instruction if the MASK bit corresponding to that bus is on.
The bus receive microprogram 115 activated by the interrupt first of all issues a LOCK signal (see FIG. 5) to the processor empty state logic 101. This causes the MICROINTERRUPT state of the processor empty state logic 101 to advance to the DUMP state.
The LOCK signal also selects either the X inqueue or the Y inqueue; subject, however, to the condition if both inqueues are full and enabled, the X queue is selected.
Next, the microprogram 115 issues the K/SEND signal which causes the sender register 95 contents to be gated to the K bus (as shown in FIG. 5) to obtain the packet sender's processor number.
Using this processor number, the microprogram 115 reads the sender processor's BRT entry to obtain the address and count words.
If the count word is zero or negative, the packet is discarded; and in this case, the microprogram 115 issues a RINT signal which causes the processor empty state logic 101 to advance from the DUMP state to the RESET state as shown in FIG. 8. In this event there is no further action. The microinterrupt is terminated, and software ihstruction processing is resumed.
If the count is positive, the microprogram 115 reads words from the inqueue buffer 97 to the K bus by means of the K/INQUEUE signal as shown in FIG. 5.
With each occurrence of the K/INQUEUE signal, the inqueue counter 99 is incremented to scan through the inqueue buffer 97.
As each data word is read from the inqueue buffer 97, the count word is decremented, the memory address word is incremented, and the data word is stored into memory.
If the count word reaches zero, no more words are stored in memory, a completion interrupt flag is set, and the sender processor number is saved in a memory location. In that event the fill state bus logic 93 stays in the FULL state until cleared by a software RIR instruction.
Thus, when a data block has been completely received, the count word will contain a value between minus 14 and zero. After the completion interrupt occurs, no further transfers to the processor over the bus which cause the interrupt are permitted until the inqueue is cleared with an RIR instruction.
As the data words are stored into the memory, a modulo-two sum of packet data is calculated.
If the check sum is bad, the word count in the BRT entry is set to minus 256, a completion interrupt flag is set, and the sender processor number is saved in memory. As above, the bus fill state logic 93 stays in the FULL state until cleared by an RIR instruction.
If the count word does not reach zero, and the check sum is good, the bus receive microprogram 115 issues the RINT signal to the processor empty state logic as shown in FIG. 5 which causes the DUMP state of the processor empty state logic 101 to advanoe to the RESET state as shown in FIG. 8.
The RESET state of the logic 101 qualifies the bus fill state logic 93 to advance from the FULL state to the SYNC state as also shown in FIG. 8.
At this point, the logic has been returned to the state it was in before the packet was received, thus enabling the receipt of more packets.
These packets may be from the same sender, completing that data block, or the packets may be from some other sender.
This completes the action of the bus receive microprogram 115 and the microprocessor 113 resumes processing of software instructions.
When a bus receive completion interrupt has occurred, the software interrupt handler obtains the sender processor number from the memory location where that number was saved, and the software interrupt handler can then detect if a check sum error occurred by examining that sender processor's bus receive table count word.
In the case of a transmission error, the count word has been set to minus 256. Otherwise, the count word will contain a value between minus fourteen and zero.
As mentioned above, it is thus the responsibility of the bus receive completion software interrupt handler to issue the RINT signal (by means of an RIR software instruction) to reenable the inqueue 65.
In summary on the receive operation, just as the sending of a data block by a sender processor module is viewed by software as a single event, the receiving of data by a receiver processor does not cause a software interrupt of the receiver processor module until the entire data block has been received or until an error has has occurred. Also, the inqueues 65 serve as buffers to allow the transmission of data to occur at bus transmission rates while allowing the storing of data into memory and the checking of the data to occur at memory speed. This ability to use the high transmission rate on the bus insures adequate bus bandwidth to service a number of processor modules on a time slicing basis. Finally, the provision of a check sum word in each data packet provides a means in the receiver processor module for checking the accuracy of the data received over the multiprocessor communication path.
Information sent over the interprocessor bus is sent under the control of the operating system and is sent from one process in one processor module 33 to another process in another processor module 33. A process (as described in detail above in the description of the Multiprocessor System) is a fundamental entity of control in the software system; and a number of processes coexist in a processor module 33. The information sent over the interprocessor bus between processes in different processor modules consists of two types of elements, control packets and data.
The control packets are used to inform the receiving processor module 33 about message initiations, cancellations, and data transfers.
In this regard it should be noted that, while the interprocessor buses 35 interconnect the processor modules 33, a process within a particular processor module 33 communicates with another process or with other processes within another processor module 33 through a method of multiplexing the interprocessor bus 35. The bus traffic between two processor modules 33 will therefore contain pieces of interprocess communications that are in various states of completion. Many interprocess communications are therefore being interleaved on an apparently simultaneous basis.
The hardware is time slicing the use of the interprocessor bus 35 on a packet level, and multiple processes are intercommunicating both within the processor modules 33 and to the extent necessary over the interprocessor buses 35 in message transactions which occur interleaved with each other. Under no circumstances is an interprocessor bus 35 allocated to any specific process-to-process communication.
Data information is sent over the interprocessor bus in one or more packets and is always preceded by a control packet and is always followed by a trailer packet.
The control packet preceding the data packets is needed because a bus is never dedicated to a specific message, and the control packet is therefore needed to correctly identify the message and to indicate how much data is to be received in the message.
This information transfer (control packet, data information, trailer packet) is made as an indivisible unit once it is started. The sender processor module sends the data block as an individual transmission (consisting of some number of data packets) and sends the trailer packet as an individual transmission; and only then is the sender processor module able to send information relating to another message.
The trailer packet serves two purposes.
First of all, if there is an error during a data transmission (and therefore the rest of the data block must be discarded), the trailer packet indicates the end of the block.
Secondly, if the sender attempts to send too much data (and again the block must be discarded), the trailer packet provides a means for recognizing data has been transmitted and the data transmission has completed.
The information transmitted is either duplicated over different paths (so that it is insured that the information will get to the receiver) or a receiver acknowledgment is required (so that the information is repeated if necessary). Any single bus error therefore cannot cause information to be lost, and any single bus error will not be seen by the two processes involved.
The bus receive software interlocks with the bus receive hardware (the inqueue section 65 shown in FIG. 2) by controlling the transfer of information from the inqueue into the memory 107.
This allows such operations as changing the bus receive table information to be done without race conditions (synchronization problems).
Once the bus receive table information has been updated, the interlock is removed by clearing the previous completion interrupt and by reenabling the bus receive microinterrupts by setting on the bus mask bit in the mask register.
This does two things. It allows the inqueue hardware to accept a packet into the inqueue, and it also enables the bus receive microprogram to transfer that information from the inqueue into memory.
The hardware/software system is so constructed that no information is lost on a system power failure (such as a complete failure of AC power from the mains) or on a line transient that causes a momentary power failure for part of the system.
This hardware/software system coaction includes a power warn signal (see line 337 of FIG. 3) supplied to the inqueue section 65 (see FIG. 2) so that, at most, one further packet of information can be loaded into the inqueue after the receipt of the power warn signal.
The software action in this event includes a SEND instruction to force the inqueues to be full. The net effect is to insure that no transmissions are completed after the processor module 33 has received its power warn signal, so that the state of every transfer is known when logic power is removed.
The interprocessor buses 35 are used by the operating system to ascertain that other processor modules in the system are operating. Every N seconds, each of the processor modules 33 sends a control packet to each processor module 33 in the system on each interprocessor bus 35. Every two N seconds, each processor module 33 must have received such a packet from each processor module 33 in the system. A processor module that does not respond is considered down. If a processor module does not get its own message, then that processor module 33 knows that something is wrong with it, and it will no longer take over I/O device controllers 41.
FIG. 42 diagrammatically illustrates how a particular application program can run continuously even though various parts of the multiprocessor system can become inoperative.
Each of the separate views shown in FIG. 42 illustrates a multiprocessor system configuration which consists of two processor modules 33 connected by dual interprocessor buses 35 (indicated as an X bus and a Y bus), a device controller 41 which controls a number of keyboard terminals, and another device controller 41 which controls a disc.
The individual views of FIG. 42 indicate various parts of the multiprocessor system rendered unserviceable and then reintroduced into the multiprocessor system in a serviceable state.
The sequence starts with the upper left hand view and then proceeds in the order indicated by the broad line arrows between the views. The sequence thus goes from the condition indicated as (1) Initial State to (2) CPU 0 Down to (3) CPU 0 Restored to (4) CPU 1 Down to (5) CPU 1 Restored (as indicated by the legends above each individual view).
In the initial state of the multiprocessor system shown in the view entitled "Initial State" at the upper left hand corner of FIG. 42, one copy (PA) of the application program is active. This copy makes a system call to create the copy PB as a backup to which the application program PA then passes information. All of the I/O is taking place by way of the processor module 0. In this initial state either interprocessor bus 35 may fail or be brought down (as indicated by the bars on the X bus) and can be then reintroduced into the multiprocessor system without producing any effect on the application program PA.
In the next view (the view entitled "CPU 0 Down") the processor module 0 is rendered unserviceable. The multiprocessor system informs the application program PA that this has happened, and the application program PA no longer tries to communicate with the program PB. All of the I/O is switched by the multiprocessor system to take place by way of the processor module 1, and the application program continues to service the terminals without interruption over the I/O bus 39 connecting the processor module 1 with the device controllers 41 (as indicated by the solid line arrow on the right hand I/O bus 39).
In the next state of operation of the multiprocessor system, as illustrated in the center top view of FIG. 42 and entitled "CPU 0 Restored", the processor module 0 is now brought back into service by way of a console command. The processor module 0 is reloaded with the multiprocessor system from the disc by way of the processor module 1. The application program PA is informed that processor module 0 is now serviceable and the application program PA tells the multiprocessor system to create another copy of the application program in the processor module 0. This other copy is designated as PC. The terminals continue without interruption.
Next, the processor module 1 is rendered inoperative, as illustrated in the view entitled "CPU 1 Down". The application program PC is informed of this fact by the multiprocessor system and the application program PC takes over the application. The multiprocessor system automatically performs all of the I/O by way of the processor module 0. The terminals continue in operation without interruption.
Finally, as indicated by the top right hand view of FIG. 42 entitled "CPU 1 Restored", the processor module 1 is rendered operable by way of a console command and is reloaded with the multiprocessor system from the disc by way of the processor module 0. The application program PC is informed that the processor module is now available, and it tells the multiprocessor system to create another copy of itself (application program PD) in the processor module 1. All elements of the multiprocessor system are now operable.
During the whole of this time both interprocessor buses and both processor modules had been rendered unserviceable and reintroduced into the system, but the application program and the terminals continued without a break.
It is an important feature of the multiprocessor system that not only can the application program continue while something has failed, but also that the failed component can be repaired and/or replaced while the application program continues. This is true not only for the processor modules and interprocessor buses but also for all elements of the multiprocessor system, such as power supplies, fans in the rack, etc. The multiprocessor system 31 thus is a true fault tolerant system.
The Input/Output System and Dual Port Device Controller
The multiprocessor system 31 shown in FIG. 1 includes an input/output (I/O) system and dual port device controllers 41 as noted generally above.
The general purpose of the I/O system is to allow transfer of data between a processor module 33 and peripheral devices.
It is an important feature of the present invention that the data transfer can be accomplished over redundant paths to insure fail soft operations so that a failure of a processor module 33 or a failure of a part of a device controller 41 will not inhibit transfer of data to and from a particular peripheral device.
Each device controller 41 has dual ports 43 and related structure which, in association with two related I/O buses 39, permit the redundant access to a peripheral device as will be described in more detail below.
The I/O system of the present invention also has some particularly significant features in terms of performance. For example, one of the performance features of the I/O system of the present invention is the speed (bandwidth) at which the input/output bus structure operates. The device controllers 41 collect data from peripheral devices which transmit data at relatively slow rates and transmit the collected data to the processor modules in a burst multiplex mode at or near memory speed of the processor modules 33.
As illustrated in FIG. 1, each processor module 33 is attached to and handles a plurality of individual device controllers 41; and this fact makes it possible for each device controller 41 to be connected (through dual ports 43) to more than one processor module 33 in a single multiprocessor system.
With reference now to FIG. 12 of the drawings, each processor module 33 includes, in addition to the interprocessor control 55 noted above, a central processor unit (CPU) part 105, a memory part 107 and an input/output (I/O) channel part 109.
As illustrated in FIG. 12 and also in FIG. 1, each device controller 41 controls one or more devices through connecting lines 111 connected in a star pattern, i.e. each device independently connected to the device controller.
In FIG. 12 a disc drive 45 is connected to one device controller 41 and a tape drive 49 is connected to another device controller 41.
With continued reference to FIG. 12, each CPU part 105 includes a microprocessor 113. A microprogram 115 is associated with each microprocessor 113. A part of the microprogram 115 is executed by the microprocessor 113 in performing I/O instructions for the I/O system. The I/O instructions are indicated in FIG. 12 as EIO (execute I/O), IIO (interrogate I/O), HIIO (interrogate high priority I/O); and these instructions are illustrated and described in greater detail below with reference to FIGS. 15, 16 and 17.
The microprocessor 113 has access to the I/O bus 39 by way of the I/O channel 109 by a collection of paths 117 as illustrated in FIG. 12.
With continued reference to FIG. 12, the I/O channel 109 includes a microprocessor 119, and a microprogram 121 is associated with the microprocessor 119.
The microprogram 121 has a single function in the multiprocessor system, and that function is to perform the reconnect and data transfer sequence illustrated in FIG. 16 (and described in more detail below).
The I/O channel 109 of a processor module 33 also includes (as shown in FIG. 12) data path logic 123.
As best illustrated in FIG. 13, the data path logic 123 includes a channel memory data register 125, an input/output data register 127, a channel memory address register 129, a character count register 131, an active device address register 133, a priority resolving register 135 and parity generation and check logic 137.
The path 117 shown in FIG. 12 includes two buses indicated as the M bus and the K bus in FIG. 13.
The M bus is an outbus from the microprocessor 113 and transmits data into the input/output data register 127.
The K bus is an inbus which transmits data from the data path logic 123 into the microprocessor 113.
With reference to FIG. 12, a path 139 connects the data path logic 123 and the memory subsystem 107.
This path 139 is illustrated in FIG. 12 as including both a hardware path 139A and two logical paths 139B and 139C in the memory subsystem 107 of a processor module 33.
Logical paths 139B and 139C'will be described in greater detail below in connection with the description of FIG. 16.
The hardware path 139A includes three branches as illustrated in FIG. 13.
A first branch 139A-1 transmits from memory into the channel memory data register 125.
A second path 139A-2 transmits from the channel memory address register 129 to memory.
And a third path 139A-3 transmits from the input/output data register 127 to memory.
With reference to FIG. 12, the input/output channel of a processor module 33 includes a control logic section 141.
This control logic section 141 in turn includes a T bus machine 143 (see FIG. 13) and request lines RECONNECT IN (RCI) 145, LOW PRIORITY INTERRUPT REQUEST (LIRQ) 147, HIGH PRIORITY INTERRUPT REQUEST (HIRQ) 149 and RANK 151 (see FIG. 14).
The I/O bus 39 shown in FIG. 14 and FIG. 12 also includes a group of channel function lines 153, 157 and 159. See also FIG. 13. The TAG bus (T bus) 153 consists of four lines which serve as function lines, and there are three lines SERVICE OUT (SVO) 155, SERVICE IN (SVI) 157, and STOP IN (STI) 159 which serve as handshake lines as indicated by the legends in FIG. 14.
As shown in FIG. 14 and FIG. 12, the I/O bus 39 also includes a group of data lines 161, 163, 165, 167 and 169.
The DATA BUS lines 161 and PARITY 163 are bidirectional and serve as data lines and as indicated in FIG. 14, there are sixteen DATA BUS lines 161 and one PARITY line 163 in this group.
The lines END OF TRANSFER (EOT) 165, PAD OUT (PADO) 167 and PAD IN (PADI) 169 serve as data status lines, and indicate special conditions that may occur on the data lines 161 and 163 from time-to-time.
Finally, the I/O bus 39 includes a reset line (IORST) 171 as also shown in FIG. 14 and in FIG. 12.
Each T bus command illustrated in FIG. 18 requires some specific format on the data bus 161 while a T bus command is valid. This specific data bus format is illustrated for the T bus functions Load Address and Command (LAC) and Read Device Status (RDST) shown in FIG. 18, for the preferred embodiment.
In the case of the T bus function LAC, the data or field transmitted on lines .0. to 5 of the data bus 161 specify the operation to be performed; the field transmitted on lines 8 to 12 of the data bus specify the device controller 41 (or more precisely the port 43 of that device controller which is attached to the data bus 161) to which the command is addressed; and the field transmitted on data bus lines 13 to 15 specify which device attached to the device controller is to be operated on by that device controller 41 in response to this command.
In the case of the T bus function RDST, data bus bits .0., 1, 2 and 3 indicate ownership error, interrupt pending, device busy, and parity error respectively. Bits 4 to 15 return device dependent status.
The functions on the T bus are transmitted in three sequences, shown in FIGS. 15, 16 and 17 and described in detail below.
Each T bus function is asserted by the channel and a handshake sequence is performed between the channel 109 and the device controller 41 using the handshake lines 155, 157 and 159 to acknowledge receipt of the T bus function. Control of the T bus and handshake is the function of the T bus machine 143 in FIG. 13.
FIG. 28 is a timing diagram showing the operation of the handshake between the I/O channel 109 and the ports 43.
As illustrated in FIG. 28, line 155 transmits the service out signal (SVO) and line 157 transmits the service in signal (SVI).
The channel clock cycle as shown in vertical orientation with the SVO and SVI signals.
As illustrated in FIG. 28, the service in (SVI) signal is not synchronized with the channel clock and may be asserted at any time by the device controller in response to a service out signal from the I/O channel 109.
Before asserting service out (SVO), the channel 109 asserts the T bus function and, if required, the data bus.
The channel then asserts a service out signal as indicated by the vertical rise 279 in FIG. 28; and, SVO remains true until the device controller responds with service in (SVI) (281), acknowledging the channel command; SVI remains true until the channel drops SVO.
When the device controller 41 asserts the service in (SVI) signal, the channel 109 removes the service out (SVO) signal (as shown by the vertical drop 283 in FIG. 28) in a time period typically between one and two clock cycles; and in response, the device controller drops service in (SVI) as shown by the vertical drop 285 in FIG. 28.
When the device controller drops the service in (SVI) signal, the channel 109 is free to reassert a service out signal (SVO) for the next transfer; however, the channel will not reassert SVO until SVI has been dropped.
The arrows 281A, 283A and 285A in FIG. 28 indicate the responses to the actions 279, 281, 283 respectively.
The handshake is completed at the trailing edge of the vertical drop 285 as shown in FIG. 28.
On an output transfer, the interface data register 213 of the controller accepts the data at the leading edge of service out (vertical rise 279) and transfers the data to the control part of the device controller 187 at the trailing edge of the service out (the vertical drop 283).
On an input transfer the channel 109 accepts data from the device controller at the trailing edge of service out (the vertical drop 283).
Thus, a two line handshake is used to interlock transfer of information between the channel 109 and its device controller 41, since they act asynchronously.
This is the general handshake condition, indicated as handshake 2L in FIGS. 15, 16 and 17.
In addition, two special handshake considerations occur, when appropriate.
First, channel commands used to select a device controller are not handshaken by SVI, since no single device controller is selected during this time. These commands include (as shown in FIG. 18):
SEL--Select;
LAC--Load Address & Command;
HPOL--Hi Priority Interrupt Poll;
LPOL--Lo Priority Interrupt Poll; and
RPOL--Reconnect Interrupt Poll.
Also, commands used to terminate a sequence are not handshaken by SVI since they cause a selected device controller to deselect itself.
These commands include (as also shown in FIG. 18):
DSEL--De-Select;
ABTI--Abort Instruction (I/O); and
ABTD--Abort Data.
For all of the commands noted above which are not handshaken, the channel asserts SVO (155) for a given period of time (e.g., two clock cycles) and then the channel removes SVO. This type of handshake is referred to as Handshake 1L in FIGS. 15, 16 and 17.
Second, data transfer is handshaken normally except that when a device controller wishes to signal that it does not require further service, it returns stop-in (STI) instead of SVI. When SVO is next dropped by the channel, the port deselects itself. STI otherwise handshakes in the same manner as SVI.
As a further condition on all handshakes, when the channel prepares to assert SVO, it initiates a timer (part of T bus machine 143 in FIG. 13) which times out and posts an error if the next handshake cycle is not initiated and completed within the period of time set by the timer. If the timer times out, an error is posted at the appropriate point in the sequence, and either ABTI (EIO, IIO or HIIO sequence) or ABTD (reconnect sequence) is sent to the device controller 41 (see discussions of FIGS. 15, 16 and 17).
FIG. 29 shows the logic for the handshake shown in FIG. 28. The logic shown in FIG. 29 is part of the T bus machine 143 shown in FIG. 13. The logic shown in FIG. 29 is the logic which is effective for the general handshake condition noted above.
The logic shown in FIG. 29 includes a service out flip-flop 287 and a service in synchronization flip-flop 289. As illustrated by the dividing lines and legends in FIG. 29, the flip- flops 287 and 289 are physically located within the channel 109.
The device controller 41 includes combinational logic 291 and a transmitter 293 which transmits a service in signal (SVI) back to the D input of the flip-flop 289.
The functioning of the logic shown in FIG. 29 is as follows.
The channel 109 asserts service out by turning on the J input of the flip-flop 287; and when the next clock cycle starts, the service out signal is transmitted by a transmitter 295 to the device controller.
When the combinational logic 291 in the device controller is ready it enables the transmitter 293 to return the service in signal (SVI) to the flip-flop 289. This completes the handshake.
Turning now to the dual port device controller, as illustrated in FIG. 19, each of the dual ports 43 in a device controller 41 is connected by a physical connection 179 to interface common logic 181 (shown in more detail in FIG. 21) and each of the ports 43 is also associated through a logical connection 183 to the interface common logic 181 as determined by an ownership latch 185.
As shown by the connecting line 180 in FIG. 19, the interface common logic 181 is associated with the control part 187 of the device controller 41. The control part 187 of the device controller includes a buffer 189.
The dual ports 43 shown in block diagram form in FIG. 19 (and in more detail in FIG. 23) are important parts of the multiprocessor system of the present invention because the dual ports provide the failsoft capability for the I/O system.
The ports 43 and related system components are structured in such a way that the two ports 43 of one device controller 41 are logically and physically independent of each other. As a result, no component part of one port 43 is also a component of the other port 43 of a particular device controller 41; and no single component failure (such as an integrated circuit failure) in one port can affect the operation of the other port.
Each port 43 functions to interface (as indicated by the legend in FIG. 19) a processor module 33 with a device controller, and ultimately with a particular device, through the device controller 41. The port 43 is the entity that communicates with the processor module and communicates with the control part of the device controller 187 (conditional on the state of the ownership latch 185).
That is, the port itself makes the connection to a processor module (dependent upon instructions received from the I/O channel 109 as discussed in more detail below) by setting its select bit 173.
Each of the individual ports 43 in a particular device controller 41 can be connected independently to a processor module 33 and at the same time as the other port in that device controller is connected to a different module. However, the ownership latch 185 establishes the logical connection between the control part of the device controller and one of the dual ports 43 so that only one port has control of the device controller at any one point in time.
The decode logic determines what function is being transmitted on the T bus 153 at any particular time.
The control logic combines T bus functions to perform specific port functions, for example, set select bit, clear select bit, read interrupt status.
The functioning of the control logic is illustrated in the logic equations set out in FIG. 27.
When a connection sequence (to be described later in reference to FIGS. 15, 16 and 17) is transmitted over the I/O bus 39, one of the ports 43 (and only the one port 43 in a device controller 41 attached to that I/O bus 39) connects (in a logical sense) to the bus 39 by setting its select bit 173.
This logical connection is determined by part of the data transmitted in that connection sequence. When connected, that particular port 43 subsequently responds to channel protocols in passing information between the channel and the control part of the device controller. The device address comparator 193 is the component part of the port 43 that determines the port's unique address.
The device address comparator 193 determines the unique address for a particular port 43 by comparing the device address field on the data bus 161 during a LAC T bus function, with device address jumpers associated with a particular port 43. When the address transmitted by the channel 109 matches the address determined by the jumpers on a particular port 43, the term ADDCOMP (see FIG. 27) is generated and the select bit 173 for that port is set (assuming that the other conditions set out in FIG. 27 allow the select bit to be set). The port 43 then responds to all T bus operations until the sequence terminates by clearing the select bit.
The abbreviations used in FIG. 27 include the following:
Add Comp--Address Compare (Device Address);
PAROKFF--Parity OK Flip-Flop;
SEL--Select;
OWN--Ownership; and
SELBIT--Select Bit.
The parity check register 177 is related to the parity generator and check logic 137 of FIG. 13 in that on output the parity generator logic 137 generates the parity to be checked by the parity checker 177 of the port 43, and this parity must check or the operation will be aborted by the I/O channel 109 of the processor module 33. On input, the interface common logic 181 generates parity to be checked by the channel parity check logic 137 in a similar fashion.
As shown in FIG. 24, the parity check is started before data is loaded into the register, and the parity check is continued until after the data has been fully loaded into the register. That is, the parity on the D bus is checked by the port parity register whenever the channel asserts SVO with an output T bus function, and the parity is monitored for the duration of SVO to insure that the data on the D bus is stable for the duration of SVO while the port transfers the data into the data register 213.
This parity check occurs on each transaction in a T bus sequence; and if a parity error occurred during any transaction in the sequence, the error is returned as a status bit in response to a T bus function during a sequence. For example, in an EIO sequence (FIGS. 18 and 15) the P bit return for RDST indicates that the port determined a parity error during the EIO sequence.
As illustrated in FIG. 18, the parity error bit is a bit number 3 on the D bus in response to a RDST function on the T bus.
If a parity error occurs at some time other than during an EIO sequence, the parity error is reported during the read interrupt status (RIST) T bus function similar to the manner described above for the RDST T bus function.
The parity error is cleared at the beginning of an EIO, IIO, HIIO or reconnect sequence as shown in FIG. 24.
If a parity error is detected during any sequence it is recorded by the parity check register to be returned on the D bus in response to a RDST or RIST T bus function.
With continued reference to FIG. 20, the function of the enable latch 175 in the port 43 is to allow the I/O system to recover from a certain class of errors that would otherwise render inoperative both of the I/O buses 39 attached to a particular device controller 41. The enable latch 175 accomplishes this by not allowing the port 43 to place any signals on the I/O bus 39.
The enable latch 175 is cleared by a specific disable command. This is a load address and command (LAC) T bus function with a specific operation code transmitted on the D bus 161.
Once the enable latch 175 is cleared, this enable latch cannot be programmatically reset.
The port 43 includes a status multiplexer 195. The status multiplexer 195 returns the ownership error mentioned above if the device controller 41 is logically connected to the other port 43 of that device controller, to indicate that the device controller is owned by the other port and commands to this port will be ignored.
The port 43 includes an interface transceiver 197 for each input line (i.e., SVI, STI, Data Bus, Parity, PADI, RCI, LIRQ, HIRQ) of the I/O bus 39 shown in FIG. 14. The transceivers 197 transmit data from the port 43 to the I/O channel 109 when the port select bit 173 is set and the T bus function on the T bus 153 requires that the device controller 41 return information to the channel. The transceivers 197 pass information from the data bus 161 into the port 43 at all times.
It is a feature of the present invention that the power on circuit 182 acts in association with the transceivers 197 to control the behavior of the transceivers as the device controller 41 is powered up or powered down, in a way which prevents erroneous signals from being placed on the I/O bus while power is going up or down. This feature is particularly significant from the standpoint of on line maintenance.
As shown in FIG. 20, each transceiver 197 comprises a receiver 198 and a transmitter 200.
The transmitter is enabled by an enable line 202.
There are several terms which are on the enable line 202. These include the select bit 173, a required input function on the T bus, and a signal from the PON circuit 182.
The signal from the PON circuit, in a particular embodiment of the present invention, is connected in a "wire or" connection to the output of the gate which combines the other terms so that the output of the PON circuit overrides the other terms by pulling down the enable line 202. This insures that the transmitter 200 (in one specific embodiment, an 8T26A or 7438) is placed in a high impedence state until tne PON circuit detects that the power is at a sufficient level that the integrated circuits will operate correctly. The PON circuit output stage is designed to take advantage of a property of the specific transceiver integrated circuit used. On this particular type IC if the driver enable line 202 is held below two diode drops above ground potential, the transmitter output transistors are forced into the off state regardless of the level of power applied to the integrated circuit. This ensures that the driver cannot drive the bus.
This particular combination of features provides a mode of operation wherein the output of the integrated circuit is controlled as power comes up or goes down, whereas normally the output of an integrated circuit is undefined when power drops below a certain level.
This same circuit is used on the X and Y buses of the interprocessor bus system to control the transceivers and control signals generated by the interprocessor control 55. As indicated in FIG. 30, each central processor unit (CPU) 105 has a PON circuit 182 whioh is similar to the PON circuit 182 in the device controller. The PON circuits therefore control the transmitters for all of the device controllers 41 and all of the interprocessor controls 55.
Details of the power-on (PON) circuit are shown in FIG. 25 where the circuit is indicated generally by the reference numeral 182.
The purpose of the PON circuit is to sense two different voltage levels of the five volt supply.
If power is failing, the circuit senses the point at which power drops below a certain level which renders the logic in the device controller or CPU an indeterminate state or condition. At this point the circuit supplies signals to protect the system against the logic which subsequently goes into an undefinable state.
The second voltage level which the PON circuit will sense is a value that is perceived when power is coming up. This second level at which power is sensed will be greater than the first level by roughly 100 millivolts to provide hysteresis for the system to eliminate any conditions of oscillation.
The PON circuit stays in a stable condition after it senses one of the voltage conditions until it senses the other voltage condition, at which point it changes state. The state at which the PON circuit is in at any particular time determines the voltage level at which the transition to the other state will be made.
The power on circuit 182 thus presents a signal establishing an indication that the power is within predetermined, acceptable operating limits for the device controller 41. If the power is not within those predetermined, acceptable operating limits, the signal output of the power-on circuit 182 is used to directly disable the appropriate bus signals of the device controller 41.
The output of the PON circuit 182 is a binary output. If the output is a one, the power is within satisfactory limits. If the output of the PON circuit is a zero, this is an indication that the power is below the acceptable limit.
The power-on circuit 182 shown in FIG. 25 and to be described in detail below is used with the device controller 41 and has seven output driver stages which are used in the application of the power-on circuit 182 to the device controller 41. However, the same power-on circuit 182 is also used with the CPU 105 and the bus controller 37, but in those applications the power-on circuit will have a lesser number of output driver stages.
As illustrated in FIG. 25, the PON circuit 182 comprises a current source 184 and a differential amplifier 186.
The differential amplifier 186 has, as one input, a temperature compensated reference voltage input on a line 188 and has a second input on a line 190 which is an indication of the voltage that is to be sensed by the power-on circuit.
The reference voltage on line 188 is established by a zener diode 192.
The differential amplifier 186 comprises a matched pair of transistors 194 and 196.
The voltage applied on the line 190 is determined by resistors 198, 200 and 202. The resistors 198, 200 and 202 are metal film resistors which provide a high degree of temperature stability in the PON circuit.
The outputs on lines 204 and 206 of the differential amplifier 186 are applied to a three transistor array (the transistors 208, 210 and 212), and this three transistor array in turn controls the main output control transistor 214.
The main output control transistor 214 drives all output drivers that are attached. For example, in the application of the PON circuit 182 for the device controller 41 (as illustrated in FIG. 25), the main output transistor 214 drives output stages 216 through 228. The output stage 216 is used to clear the logic, the output stages 218, 220 and 222 are used in combination with the interface devices of one port 43 of the device controller 41, and the output stages 224, 226 and 228 are used in combination with the interface device of the other port 43 of the device controller 41.
Finally, the PON circuit 182 includes a hysteresis control 230. The hysteresis control 230 includes resistors 232, 234 and a transistor 236.
In operation, assuming that operation is started from a power off state to a power on condition, the power is applied through the current source 182 to the differential amplifier 186 and to the main output control transistor 214. At this time the voltage on the line 190 is less than the voltage on the line 188 so the differential amplifier 186 holds the output of the main output control transistor 214 in the off state. This, in turn, will force the output stages 216 through 228 on.
This asserts the output of the PON circuit 182 in the zero state, the state indicating that power is not within acceptable limits.
As voltage rises, the input voltage on line 190 will increase until it equals the reference voltage on line 188. At this point the differential amplifier 186 drives the main output control transistor 214, turning it on. This removes the base drive from the output stages 216 through 228, forcing these output stages off. The output of the PON circuit 182 is then a one, indicating that the power is within acceptable limits.
At this point the hysteresis control circuit 230 comes into play. While power was coming on, the transistor 236 of the hysteresis control circuit 230 was on. When the transistor 236 is on, the resistance value of the resistor 202 appears to be less than the resistance value of this resistor 202 is when the transistor 236 is off.
The point at which the main output control transistor 214 turns on is the point at which the hysteresis transistor 236 turns off. Turning off the hysteresis transistor 236 causes a slight voltage jump in the line 190 which further latches the differential amplifier 186 into the condition where the differential amplifier 186 sustains the main output transistor 214 in the on state.
The state of the PON circuit will remain stable in this condition with the main output control transistor 214 on and the output drivers 216 through 228 off until the plus five volts drops below a lower threshold point, as determined by the voltage applied on the line 190.
As the voltage on the line 190 decreases below the reference voltage on the line 188, (because the five volts supply is going down in a power failure condition), then the differential amplifier 186 turns off the main output control transistor 214. This, in turn, turns on the output driver stages 216 through 228.
Since the hysteresis transistor 236 was off as power dropped, the voltage applied to the input of the PON circuit 182 must drop somewhat farther than the point at which the PON circuit 182 sensed that power was within the acceptable limits during the power-up phase of operation.
This differential or hysteresis is used to inhibit any noise on the five volt power supply from causing any oscillation in the circuit that would erroneously indicate that power is failing.
The PON circuit 182 shown in FIG. 25 provides very accurate sensing of the two voltages used by the PON circuit to determine its state (whether a one or a zero output of the PON circuit).
In order to sense these two voltages very accurately the PON circuit must have the capability of compensating for initial tolerances of the different components and also the capability to compensate for changes in temperature during operation. In the PON circuit 182, the zener diode 192 is the only critical part that must be compensated for because of its initial tolerance, and this compensation is provided by selecting the resistor 198.
Temperature compensation is achieved because the zener diode 192 is an active zener diode and is not a passive zener diode. Effective temperature compensation is also achieved because the two transistors in the differential amplifier 186 are a matched pair of transistors and the resistors 198, 200 and 202 are metal film resistors.
Each port 43 includes a number of lines which are indicated by the general reference numeral 179 in FIG. 20 and FIG. 19. This group of lines 179 includes the individual lines 201 (sixteen (16) of which make up the Input Bus - I Bus), device address lines 203, Output Bus lines 205 (of which there are sixteen), a take ownership line 207 and general lines 209 which transmit such signals as parity, the T bus, and other similar lines which are required because of the particular hardware implementation.
These particular lines 201, 203, 205, 207 and 209 correspond to the lines with the same numbers in FIG. 21, which is the block diagram of the interface common logic. However, there are two sets of each of these lines in FIG. 21 because the interface common logic 181 is associated with each of the dual ports 43 in a device controller 41.
With reference to FIG. 21, the interface common logic 181 includes the ownership latch 185 (see also FIG. 19). This ownership latch determines the logical connection between the interface common logic 181 and a port 43 from which TAKE OWNERSHIP signal has been received over the line 207.
As noted above, the TAKE OWNERSHIP signal is derived by the port hardware from a load address and command (LAC) T bus command (see FIG. 18) with a particular operation code in the command field on the D bus. When the port receives the function LAC on the T bus from the channel, the port logic examines the command field (the top six bits) on the D bus. Then, if the command field contains a code specifying a take ownership command, the port hardware issues a signal to set the ownership latch to connect the port to the interface common logic and thence to the control part of the device controller. If the command field specifies a kill command, the port hardware issues a signal to clear the port's enable latch. This operation happens only if the device address field on the D bus matches the port's device address jumpers, and no parity error is detected during the command. That is, no commands (including the take ownership, kill, etc.) are executed if a parity error is detected on the LAC.
As a consequence, the I/O channel 109 issuing the Take Ownership command gains control of the device controller 41, and the other port 43 is logically disconnected. Take Ownership may also cause a hard clear of the controller's internal state.
The state of the ownership latch 185 determines which port may pass information through the multiplexer 211. Once the ownership latch 185 is set in a given direction, it stays in that state until a Take Ownership command is received by the other port. Assertion of the I/O reset line (IORST) will also cause ownership to be given to the other port after the internal state of the device controller has been cleared.
Control signals are chosen by the state of the ownership register 185 and from the appropriate one of the ports 43 and are transmitted by the multiplexer 211 to the control part 187 of a device controller on a set of control lines 215. Data are selected from an appropriate one of the ports 43 on lines 205 and are loaded into the data register 213 and presented to the controller on an Output Bus (O bus) 217.
Some of the control lines 215 (the lines 215A) are used to control the multiplexer 220 in selecting information from the controller as transmitted on lines 219, to be returned by the input bus (I bus) 201 to the ports 43 (FIG. 20) and then to the channel 109 of a processor module 33. A line 221 returns the device address from the appropriate port 43 to the I bus 201 and thence to the I/O channel 109.
The data buffer 189 shown in FIG. 19 is illustrated in more detail in FIG. 22.
In accordance with the present invention many of the device controllers 41 incorporate a multiword buffer for receiving information at a relatively slow rate from a peripheral device and then transmitting that information at or near memory speed to the processor module to maximize channel bandwidth utilization.
In the buffer design itself it is important that the device controllers 41 be able to cooperate with each other in gaining access to the channel 109 to avoid error conditions. In order for the device controllers 41 to cooperate properly, the multiword buffers 189 are constructed to follow certain guidelines.
These guidelines include the following:
First of all, when a device controller makes a reconnect request for the channel 109 it must have enough buffer depth left so that all higher priority device controllers 41 and one lower priority device controller 41 may be serviced and the reconnect latency of the reconnect request can occur without exhausting the remaining depth of the buffer. This is called Buffer Threshold, abbreviated T in FIG. 23.
Secondly, after the buffer has been serviced, it must wait long enough to permit all lower priority device controllers 41 to be serviced before making another reconnect request. This is called Holdoff. The buffer depth (D in FIG. 23) is the sum of the holdoff depth plus the threshold depth.
The holdoff and threshold depths are a function of a number of variables. These include the device rate, the channel rate, the memory speed, the reconnect time, the number of controllers of higher priority on that I/O bus, the number of controllers of lower priority on that I/O bus, and the maximum burst length permissible.
A controller at high priority on an I/O bus has more controllers of lower priority associated with it on the same I/O bus than another controller at lower priority on the same I/O bus, and therefore the higher priority controller requires more holdoff depth than the lower priority controller. Similarly, a controller at low priority on an I/O bus requires more threshold depth than a controller at higher priority. The buffer 189 in a controller is constructed to take advantage of the fact that as holdoff requirement increases the threshold requirement decreases, and as the threshold requirement increases the holdoff requirement decreases. This is accomplished by making the stress at which a reconnect request is made be variable, the actual setting depending on the characteristics of the controllers at higher and lower priority in a particular I/O channel configuration. The buffer depth is therefore the maximum of the worst-case threshold depth or worst-case holdoff depth requirement, rather than the sum of the worst-case threshold depth and worst-case holdoff depth. This allows the buffer depth to be minimized, and shortens the time required to fill or empty the buffer.
A number of these parameters are graphically illustrated in FIG. 23. In FIG. 23 time has been plotted on the horizontal axis versus words in the buffer on the vertical axis for an output operation.
Starting at point D on the upper left hand part of FIG. 23 (and assuming a buffer filled to the full buffer depth), data is transferred to a device at a rate indicated by the line of slope -RDD and this data transfer continues without any reconnect signal being generated until the buffer depth decreases to the threshold depth as indicated by the intersection of the line of slope -RD with the threshold depth line T at point 223.
At this point the reconnect request is made to the channel 109 as indicated by the legend on the horizontal axis in FIG. 23.
The transfer of data continues from the buffer at the rate indicated by the line of slope -RD and the request is held off by higher priority device controllers 41 until point 225 at which point the request is honored by the channel 109, and the I/O channel begins its reconnect sequence for this device controller.
At point 227 the first data word has been transmitted by the channel 109 to the device controller buffer 189, and the channel 109 then transfers data words at a rate indicated by the line of slope RC into the buffer 189.
At the same time the device controller 41 continues to transfer data words out of the buffer at the rate -RD so that the overall rate of input to the buffer 189 is indicated by the line of slope RC -RD until the buffer is again filled at the point 229. At 229 the buffer is full, and the device controller disconnects from the channel 109, and the data transfer continues at the rate indicated by the slope line -RC.
The notation tr in FIG. 23 indicates the time required for the polling and selection of this device controller and the transfer of the first word. This will be discussed again below in relation to FIG. 16.
The letter B in FIG. 23 indicates the burst time. The burst time is a dynamic parameter. The length of any particular burst is dependent upon the device transfer rate, the channel transfer rate, the number of devices with transfers in progress and the channel reconnect time. The maximum time permitted for a burst is chosen to minimize the amount of buffer depth required while accomodating high device transfer rates and also the number of devices that can transfer concurrently.
FIG. 22 is a block diagram of a particular embodimcnt of a buffer 189 constructed in accordance with the present invention to accomplish the holdoff and threshold requirements illustrated in FIG. 23.
The buffer 189 shown in FIG. 22 comprises an input buffer 231, a buffer memory 233, an output buffer 235, an input pointer 237, an output pointer 239, a multiplexer 241, buffer control logic 243 (described in more detail in FIG. 26), a multiplexer 245 connected to the buffer control logic 243 and a stress counter 247.
As also illustrated in FIG. 22, two groups of data input lines (lines 217 and 249) are fed into the input buffer 231.
One group of data input lines include sixteen device data input lines 249.
The other group of input lines include sixteen Output Bus lines (O bus lines) 217.
One or the other of these two groups of input signals is then fed from the input buffer 231 to the buffer memory 233 by a group of lines 251. There are sixteen of the lines 251.
Data is taken from the buffer memory 233 and put into the output buffer 235 by a group of lines 253. There are sixteen of the lines 253.
The output buffer 335 transmits the data back to the interface common logic 181 (see FIG. 19 and FIG. 21) on a group of sixteen lines 219 and to the devices 45, 47 (such as 49, 51, 53 shown in FIG. 1) on a group of sixteen lines 255 as indicated by the legends in FIG. 22.
The input and output pointers 237 and 239 function with the multiplexer 241 as follows.
When data is being transferred from the input buffer 231 to the buffer memory 233, the input pointer 237 is connected to the buffer memory 233 through the multiplexer 241 to determine the location into which the word is written.
When data is being transferred out of the buffer memory 233 into the output buffer 235, the output pointer 239 is connected to the buffer memory 233 through the multiplexer 241 to determine the location from which the word is taken.
The purpose of the buffer control logic 243 illustrated in FIG. 22 and FIG. 26 is to keep track of the stress placed on the buffer 189. In this regard, the degree of the full or empty condition of the buffer in combination with the direction of the transfer with respect to the processor module (whether input or output) determines the degree of stress. Stress increases as the device accesses the buffer and decreases as the channel accesses the buffer.
In the implementation shown in FIGS. 22 and 26 the stress counter measures increasing stress from 0-15 on an input, and decreasing stress from 0-15 on an output. Another implementation (not shown in the drawings) would add the direction of transfer in the buffer oontrol logic such that two new lines would access the pointers 237 and 239 and the stress counter would always measure increasing stress.
With continued reference to FIG. 22, a channel request line 215 (see also FIG. 21) and a device request line 257 (coming from the control part 187 of the device controller) are asserted to indicate access to the buffer 189.
The multiplexer 245 chooses one of these lines as a request to increase the buffer fullness and chooses the other line as a request to decrease the buffer fullness based on the direction of the transfer (whether input or output) with respect to the processor module.
The line chosen to increase buffer fullness is also used to load data from the appropriate data lines 249 or 217 (see FIG. 22) into the input buffer 231 by means of the line 259.
The channel and the device may access the buffer 189 at the same time, and the buffer control logic 243 services one request at a time. The buffer control logic 243 chooses one of the lines for service and holds the other line off until the buffer control logic 243 has serviced the first request, then it services the other request.
The servicing of a request by the buffer control logic 243 includes the following.
First of all, it determines the direction of transfer (into or out of) the buffer memory 233, and it asserts line 261 (connected to the multiplexer 241) as appropriate to select the input pointer 237 or the output pointer 239 through the multiplexer 241.
Secondly, on an output request, the buffer control logic 243 asserts line 263 which does three things.
(A) It writes the word from the input buffer 231 into the buffer memory 233 at the location determined by the input pointer 237 and the multiplexer 241.
(B) It increments the stress counter 247.
(C) The buffer control logic 243 increments the input pointer 237.
Thirdly, on an output transfer, the buffer control logic 243 asserts line 265 which accomplishes the following three operations.
(A) The buffer control logic 243 writes the word being read from the buffer memory 233 as determined by the output pointer 239 and multiplexer 241 into the output buffer 235.
(B) The buffer control logic 243 decrements the stress counter 247.
(C) The buffer control logic 243 increments the output pointer 239.
The stress counter 247 determines when the buffer 189 is full (D), or at threshold depth (T) as shown by the output line legends in FIG. 22.
The output of the stress counter is decoded, and any one of the decoded values may be used to specify that the buffer is at threshold depth. In the preferred embodiment, wire jumpers are used to select one of sixteen possible stress values, and a reconnect request is made to the channel 109 when the stress on the buffer 189 reaches that value.
The control part 187 of the device controller uses these three signals (which correspond to the legends in FIG. 23) to make reconnect requests and disconnect requests on respective lines 145 (see FIG. 14 and FIG. 12) and 159 (see FIG. 14 and FIG. 12).
The STI (stop in) signal transmitted on line 159 shown in FIG. 14 and FIG. 12 is related to the buffer depth (D), the full or empty conditions of the buffer and the direction of transfer; and the RCI (reconnect in) signal on line 145 of FIG. 14 and FIG. 12 is related to the threshold depth (T) indication from the stress counter 247 in FIG. 22. Thus, the STI signal is asserted when the buffer 189 reaches a condition of minimum stress (full on output and empty on input). The STI signal signals the channel 109 that the controller 41 wishes to terminate the burst data transfer. When the buffer passes through its threshold, it asserts the RCI signal on line 145 to indicate to the channel 109 that the buffer wishes to transfer a burst of data.
FIG. 26 shows details of the multiplexer 245, the buffer control logic 243 and the stress counter 247 of the buffer 189 shown in FIG. 22.
In FIG. 26 the multiplexer 245 is shown as two sets of gates 245A and 245B, request flip-flops 267A and 267B, a clock flip-flop 269, request synchronization flip- flops 271A and 271B, a priority resolving gate 273 and request execution gates 275A and 275B.
The stress counter 247 comprises a counter section 247A and a decoder section 247B as indicated by the legends in FIG. 26.
As illustrated in FIG. 26, the two sets of gates 245A and 245B have used the channel request signal (line 215) and the device request signal (line 257) and the read and write signals to determine which of the channel or the device is putting data onto the buffer 189 and which is taking data out of the buffer 189.
The request flip-flops 267A and 267B store the requests until the control logic has serviced the request.
The clock flip-flop 269 generates a two phase clock used by the request synchronization flip- flops 271A and 271B and the request execution gates 275A and 275B.
The request synchronization flip- flops 271A and 271B synchronize the request to the clock generation flip-flop 269 and stabilize the request for execution.
The priority resolving gate 273 picks one of the requests for execution and causes the other request to be held off.
The request execution gates 275A and 275B execute the requests in dependence on the synchronized request.
Each output signal on the lines 263 and 265 performs the functions described above (incrementing and decrementing the stress counter, updating the buffer memory or output buffer, and updating the input pointer or output pointer).
In addition, each signal clears the appropriate request flip-flop through the lines 277A and 277B illustrated in FIG. 26.
As noted above, FIGS. 15, 16 and 17 show the three sequences of operation of the I/O system.
In the operation of the I/O system, the normal data transfer between a processor module 33 and a particular device, such as a disc 45, includes an EIO sequence to initiate the transfer.
The EIO instruction selects the particular device controller and device and specifies the operation to be performed.
The device controller 41 initiates the I/O between the device controller 41 and the particular device.
The device controller 41 periodically reconnects to the channel 109 and transfers data between the device controller 41 and the channel 109. The periodic reconnection may be for the purpose of either transferring data from the channel to the device or for the purpose of transferring data from the device to the channel.
When the transfer of data is complete the device controller 41 interrupts the CPU 105, which responds by issuing an IIO or an HIIO sequence.
The IIO sequence determines the identity of the interrupting device and conditions under which the transfer completed.
The HIIO sequence is similar to the IIO sequence but is issued in response to a high priority I/O interrupt.
The "Execute I/O" CPU instruction (EIO) is defined by the T bus state changes shown in FIG. 15.
The first state shown in FIG. 15 (the state farthest to the left) is the no-operation (NOP) or idle state. The other states are the same as those listed in FIG. 18 by the corresponding mnemonics--load address and command (LAC), load parameter (LPRM), read device status (RDST), deselect (DSEL) and abort instruction (ABTI).
As in the state changes shown in FIGS. 6, 7 and 8, the solid line arrows indicate a state change, and a dashed line arrow indicates a condition which must occur before a state change can occur.
The EIO instruction and execution shown in FIG. 15 is directly under control of the microprocessor 113 (see FIG. 12) of the CPU 105.
This CPU initiation is shown as transmitted to the state machine in FIG. 15 by the line 117; the initiation signal is accepted only when the T bus is in the idle state.
Once the CPU initiation signal is applied, the T bus goes from the NOP (idle) state to the LAC state.
In the LAC state or function a word is taken from the top of the register stack 112 in the CPU 105 (see FIG. 12) and is put on the D bus 161 (see FIG. 14).
As desoribed above, this word is used to select a particular device controller 41 and a partioular peripheral device 45, 47, 49, 51 or 53 (see FIG. 1), and the word is also used to specify the operation to be performed.
In the next T bus cycle the T bus goes to the LPRM state.
In the load parameter state (LPRM) the word just below the top of the register stack in the CPU 105 (see FIG. 12) is put on the T bus 161 (see FIG. 14) by the I/O channel 109 and is passed to the device controller 41 selected during the previous LAC state.
At the conclusion of the handshake cycle, as shown by the dashed line arrow in FIG. 15, the T bus goes to the RDST state. In this state the device controller 41 returns the device status (the status of a particular device selected and comprising the set of signals describing the state of that device) from the device controller 41 and places it on the top of the register stack 112 in the CPU 105.
During the load parameter and read device status state several errors may have occurred. These include parity error, handshake time out, and an error indication in the status word. If an error did occur, then the T bus machine 143 (FIG. 13) goes from the RDST state to the abort instruction (ABTI) state.
The ABTI state instructs the device controller 41 to ignore the previous LAC and LPRM information passed to it by the I/O channel 109 and then the T bus (channel) returns to the NOP (idle) state.
If, after the RDST state no error was detected, (as shown by the dashed line arrow 114 in the top branch of FIG. 15), the T bus goes to the deselect state (DSEL).
With the T bus in the deselect state, the device controller 41 clears its select latch 173 and responds to the instruction issued to it (passed to it during the LAC state) and the T bus returns to the NOP (idle) state.
In the operation of the I/O system there are a number of device request signals that can happen asynchronously. For example, a reconnect signal may be generated after an EIO sequence to request that the channel transfer data to the controller. Or the device controller 41 may assert an interrupt request line under a number of different conditions, e.g. to signal the completion of an EIO sequence or to report an unusual condition in a peripheral device.
The device request lines are common to all device controller ports 43 attached to a particular I/O bus 39.
The channel 109 responds to reconnect requests made on the line RCI (145 of FIG. 14), and the CPU 105 responds to requests made on the LIRQ line 147 (see also FIG. 14) with an IIO sequence, and to a request made on the HIRQ line 149 with an HIIO sequence.
The first thing that the channel 109 or CPU 105 does in response to a Device Request signal is to determine the identity of the highest priority device controller 41 asserting a request. That is, there may be several device controllers 41 asserting a request to the channel 109 at one time, and the channel will select a particular device controller in accordance with a predetermined priority scheme.
In a particular embodiment of the present invention up to thirty-two device controllers 41 can be connected to a single channel 109.
The thirty-two device controllers are connected in a star poll using the sixteen bit data bus 161. One additional line 151 is used to divide the thirty-two device controllers into two groups of sixteen each. One group of sixteen device controllers is assigned priority over the other group; and priority is also assigned among the sixteen within each group. The device responding on bit zero of the D bus during a polling sequence has the highest priority within a rank, and the one responding on bit 15 has the lowest priority.
In initial introduction, it may be noted that polling (which will now be described) involves the state descriptions shown in FIG. 16 and 17 up to and including that handshake which occurs during the select (SEL) state in each figure.
With continued general reference to FIGS. 16 and 17, the channel 109 sets the rank line to zero and then presents the T bus function RPOL (FIG. 16) if the response is to a reconnect request, while the CPU 105 presents an LPOL (FIG. 17) T bus function if the CPU is responding with an IIO sequence, or an HPOL T bus function if the CPU is responding with an HIIO sequence. This is the only major point of difference between the showings in FIG. 16 (the channel response) and FIG. 17 (the CPU response) with regard to polling.
Referring specifically to FIG. 16 and the response of the channel 109 to assertion of the RCI line 145 (see FIG. 14), all devices with a reconnect request pending that would respond on rank zero place a one bit response on the D bus. That is, all these devices assert a line of the D bus 161 corresponding to their priority within the rank.
The channel 109 transfers the D bus response into the priority resolve register 135 (see FIG. 13). This priority resolve register 135 output determines which device controller has the highest priority (in accordance with the scheme described above) and asserts the appropriate bit back onto the D bus 161, if there is a bit asserted in rank zero by the attached device controllers.
If there are one or more devices asserting a response to the priority resolve register on rank zero, the output of the priority resolve register is presented to all device controllers attached, along with the select function (SEL) on the T bus, and the device controller whose priority on rank zero matches the output of the priority resolve register sets its select bit 173 (see FIG. 19), and then that port will respond to subsequent states in the sequence. This is the mode of operation indicated by the solid line arrow going from the state indicated by RPOL with a rank equals zero to select (SEL).
If the priority resolving register 135 determines that no device responded when the rank line equalled zero, then the channel 109 sets the rank line to one and reissues the RPOL T bus command. Then, if the priority resolving register determines that a response occurred on rank 1, the channel asserts the T bus select function as before.
However, if the priority resolving register 135 determines that no response was made on rank 1, the channel returns to the idle state indicated by state NOP in FIG. 16.
This latter event is an example of a failure which might occur in one port 43 and which would result in the system 31 accessing that particular device controller 41 through the other port 43.
As noted above, the action of the priority resolving register 135 in response to an IIO or an HIIO sequence initiated by the CPU 105 is the same as the response of the priority resolving register 135 to a reconnect sequence initiated by the channel in response to a reconnect in on the line 145 from a device controller 41.
With continued reference to FIG. 16, the reconnect sequence begins with the poll sequence described above for reconnecting the highest priority device controller 41 making a request.
The next step in the reconnect sequence is to determine the actual device controller number contained in the device address comparator 193. As noted above, the device address comparator 193 includes jumpers to determine a physical device controller number. These are the same jumpers that are used on a LAC T bus function during an EIO sequence to determine a particular port. In the reconnect sequence the address determined by these jumpers is returned to the I/O channel via the D bus during the T bus RAC state to access a table defining the buffer area for this device.
It is also necessary to determine the direction of the transfer (whether an input or output transfer to the processor module). To accomplish this determination of the direction of the requested transfer and the device address, the channel asserts the RAC T bus function and the device controller 41 returns the device controller address and the transfer direction.
The channel uses the device address returned by the device controller 41 to access a two word entry (142) in an I/O control table (IOC) 140 (FIG. 12) which defines a buffer area 138 in the memory 107 for this particular device controller and device.
The format of a two word entry 142 is shown enlarged in FIG. 12 to show details of the fields of the two words.
There is a two word entry 142 in the IOC table 140 for each of the eight possible devices of each of the thirty-two possible device controllers 41 attached to an I/O bus 39 associated with a particular processor module 33, and each processor module 33 has its own IOC table.
Each two word entry describes the buffer location in main memory and remaining length to be transferred at any particular time for a particular data transfer to a particular device. Thus, as indicated by the legends in FIG. 12, the upper word specifies the transfer address to or from which the transfer will be made by a burst; and the lower word specifies the byte count specifying the remaining length of the buffer area and the status of the transfer.
The fields representing the status of the transfer include a protect bit P and a channel error field CH ERR. The channel error field comprises three bits which can be set to indicate any one of up to seven numbered errors.
The transfer address and byte count are updated in the IOC table 140 at the conclusion of each reconnect and data transfer sequence (burst). The transfer address is counted up and the byte count is counted down at the conclusion of each burst. The amount reflects the number of bytes transferred during the burst.
The second word also contains (1) a field in which any error encountered during a reconnect and data transfer sequence may be posted for later analysis, and (2) a protect bit to specify that the buffer area in memory 107 may be read from but not written into.
The protect bit serves to protect the processor memory 107 from a failure in the device controller 41. That is, when the device controller 41 returned the transfer direction to the channel 109 during a read address and command (RAC) T bus function, a failure in the device controller 41 could cause the device controller to erroneously specify an input transfer. Then the channel would go to the IN state and transfer data from the device controller into memory, thus causing data in the buffer 138 to be lost. The protect bit allows the program to specify that the channel may not write into this buffer area; that is, the device may only specify an output transfer.
The transfer address specifies the logical path 139B (see FIG. 12).
The channel places the transfer address in the channel memory address register 129 (see FIG. 13) and places the byte count in the character count register 131 (see FIG. 13).
Depending upon the direction of the transfer, (which the channel retrieved from the device during the RAC state shown in FIG. 16), the channel puts the T bus in either the IN state or OUT state and transfers data between the device controller 41 and memory 107 using the channel memory address register 129 to specify the logical path 139C (see FIG. 12). The channel memory address register 129 and character count register 131 are updated with each word transferred during the burst to reflect the next address in the buffer and the number of characters yet to be transferred. At the conclusion of a burst the contents of the channel memory address register 129 and of the character count register 131 are written into the IOC table 140.
In operation, for each word transferred in from the device on an in transfer, the channel 109 accepts the word by the handshake mechanism described above and places the word in the I/O data register 127 (see FIG. 13) and then transfers the word to the buffer area in memory defined by the logical path 139C (see FIG. 12).
On an out transfer the channel 109 takes a word from the buffer area over logical path 139C and transfers the word to the channel memory data register 125. The channel then transfers the word into the I/O data register 127 (FIG. 13) and handshakes with the device controller which accepts the word into its interface data register 213.
The high speed of the I/O channel is accomplished by pipelining where the word in the I/O data register 127 is handshaken to the device while the channel concurrently requests and accepts the next word in the transfer from memory 107 and places it in the channel memory data register 125. Since it takes just as long to put a word out to the device as it does to accept a word from memory for the device, the two operations can be overlapped.
During the burst, the channel decremented the character count register by two for every word transferred, since there are two bytes in every word.
The burst transfer can terminate in two ways. The burst transfer can terminate normally or the burst transfer can terminate with an error condition.
In the normal case there are two possibilities.
In a first condition of operation, the character count register 131 can reach a count of either one or two bytes remaining to be transferred. In this situation the channel puts up EOT (line 165 as shown in FIG. 14) signifying that the end of transfer has been reached. If the count reaches one, then the channel asserts EOT and PAD OUT (line 167 of FIG. 14) signifying the end of transfer with an odd byte.
If the character count reaches two, the channel puts up EOT, but PAD OUT (PADO on line 167 of FIG. 14) is not required because both bytes on the bus are valid.
In either case, the device controller 41 responds by asserting STOP IN (STI) on line 159 (see FIG. 14), and the device controller 41 also asserts PAD IN (PADI) on line 169 (FIG. 14) if the channel asserted PAD OUT (PADO).
In this first case of normal termination, the transfer as a whole, not just the burst, is terminated by the channel 109.
The other normal completion is when the device controller 41 ends the burst by asserting STOP IN (STI) in response to the channel SERVICE OUT (SVO). This signifies that the buffer 189 (see FIG. 19) has reached a condition of minimum stress (as indicated by point 229 in FIG. 23).
The STOP IN (STI) can occur on an output transfer or on an input transfer.
On an input transfer, if the device controller 41 wishes to terminate the transfer as well as the burst, the device controller 41 can assert STOP IN (STI); and, to signify an odd byte on the last word, the device controller 41 can also assert PAD IN (PADI).
As shown in FIG. 16, when the transfer is terminated by a non-error condition (STI OR EOT) on either an output transfer or an input transfer (as shown by the balloons OUT and IN in FIG. 16), the channel 109 updates the IOC table entries as noted above, and returns to the idle (NOP) state shown in FIG. 16.
As noted above, the transfer can also be terminated by an error condition.
During the burst several errors may occur as follows.
First, the device controller 41 may request an input transfer into a buffer whose protect bit P is set in the IOC table as mentioned above.
Second, the device controller 41 may not return a PAD IN (PADI) signal in response to a PAD OUT (PADO) signal from the channel 109.
Third, the channel 109 may detect a parity error on the D bus 161.
Fourth, the device controller 41 may not respond to a SERVICE OUT (SVO) signal from the channel 109 within the allotted time as mentioned above in the discussion on handshakes.
Fifth, the buffer area specified by the IOC table entries may cross into a page whose map marks it absent (see the discussion of the mapping scheme in the memory system).
Sixth, a parity error may be detected in accessing the map while accessing the memory during the reconnect in and data transfer sequence. See the description in the memory system relating to the parity error check.
Seventh, the memory system may detect an uncorrectable parity error when the channel 109 accesses the memory. See the description of the memory system for this parity error check.
If any of these error conditions occur, the channel 109 goes to the abort data transfer state (ABTD) as shown in FIG. 16. This instructs the device controller 41 that an error has occurred and that the data transfer should be aborted. The channel 109 then goes back to the idle state which is (NOP) as shown in FIG. 16.
When an error occurs, the channel 109 updates the IOC table entries and puts an error number indicating one of the seven errors noted above in the error field of the second word of the IOC table entry as mentioned above.
Thus, if a single error occurs, the number of that error is entered in the error field of the IOC table entry.
If more than one error occurs, the channel 109 selects the error from which recovery is least likely to occur and enters only the number of that error in the error field of the IOC table entry.
There is one other type of error that can occur. The device controller 41 may try to reconnect to the channel when the count word in the IOC table is zero. In this event, the channel will not let the device controller reconnect and the channel goes through the sequence as described above with reference to FIG. 16, but when the channel determines that the count word in the IOC table is zero, the channel 109 goes directly to the abort (ABTD) state. This is an important feature of the present invention because it protects the processor memory from being overwritten by a failing device.
If the count is zero in the byte count count of the second word of the IOC table entry 142 for a particular device, and if the device controller 41 attempts to reconnect to the channel 109, the channel issues an abort (ABTD) to the device controller 41 as noted above and leaves the channel error field of the two word entry 142 at zero.
In response to an abort data (ABTD) T bus function, the device controller 41 makes an interrupt request on the line HIRQ or LIRQ ( lines 149 or 147 as shown in FIG. 14) to the channel 109.
The device controllers 41 may at any time request an interrupt on these two lines.
An interrupt generally indicates that a data transfer has been completed or terminated by an abort from the channel (an ABTD from the channel) or by an error condition within the device controller 41 or attached device, or that a special condition has occurred within the device controller or an attached device. For example, when the power is applied and the PON circuit indicates that power is at an acceptable level, the device controller interrupts the processor module to indicate that its internal state is Reset because power was off or had failed and has been reset by the PON circuit.
In response to an interrupt, the program running within the processor module 33 issues an interrogate I/O instruction (IIO) or an interrogate high priority I/O instruction (HIIO) over the I/O bus 39.
The IIO instruction is issued in response to a low priority I/O interrupt, that is, one issued on the low priority interrupt request (LIRQ) line 147 (see FIG. 14).
The HIIO instruction is issued in response to a high priority I/O interrupt, that is, one requested on a high priority interrupt request (HIRQ) line 149 (see FIG. 14).
The microprocessor 113 (see FIG. 12) executes the EIO, IIO or HIIO instruction by taking control of the channel control logic 141 and data path logic 123.
The sequence for these instructions is illustrated in FIG. 17; and, as noted above, the sequence starts with a polling sequence.
The IIO instruction polls in a sequence using the T bus function low priority interrupt poll (LPOL) while the HIIO instruction polls in a sequence using the T bus function high priority interrupt poll (HPOL).
The polling sequence which is also described above completes by selecting the appropriate device controller 41 by using the T bus function select (SEL) as shown in FIG. 17.
The appropriate device controller 41 selected is that device controller which has the highest priority and is making an interrupt request.
The sequence continues with a read interrupt cause (RIC) T bus function as shown in FIG. 17. The device controller 41 responds by returning device dependent status on the D bus 161 (see FIG. 14).
The microprocessor 113 (FIG. 12) reads the status from the D bus 161 and places the status on the top of the register stack 112 (FIG. 12).
The sequence then continues with a read interrupt status (RIST) T bus function as shown in FIG. 17. The device controller 41 responds to this RIST T bus function by returning the device controller number, the unit number and four dedicated status bits on the D bus.
Of the four bit status field, two of the bits indicate respectively, abort (ABTD) and parity error (which parity error may have occurred during a reconnect and data transfer sequence).
The mioroprocessor 113 oopies the content of the D bus--the controller number, the device number and the interrupt status--and places that content on the top of the register stack 112.
If no error occurred during the sequence, then the sequence continues with the deselect (DSEL) state which deselects the device controller 41; and then the sequence goes into the idle (NOP) state as indicated by the line at the top of FIG. 17.
If an error did occur (and the error can be a parity error detected by the channel or a handshake time out), the channel goes from the RIST state to the abort instruction (ABTI) state as shown in FIG. 17. This deselects the device controller 41, and then the channel 109 goes back into the idle (NOP) state as shown by the bottom line in FIG. 17.
As noted above, an I/O operation between a processor module and an I/O device typically consists of a group of sequences, e.g. an EIO followed by some number of reconnect and data transfer sequences, terminating with an IIO sequence. Sequences from several different I/O operations may be interleaved, resulting in apparent simultaneous I/O operation by several devices. Thus, a large number of devices may be accessed concurrently; the exact number depends on the channel bandwidth and the actual bandwidth used by each device.
The I/O system and dual port device controller architecture and operation described above provide a number of important benefits.
These benefits include (a) flexibility to interface a wide variety of devices, (b) a maximum usage of resources, (c) a fail soft environment in which to access peripheral devices in a multiprocessor system, (d) on line maintenance and upgrade of the multiprocessor system capability, and (e) maximum system through put (as opposed to emphasizing processor through put or I/O through put exclusively) in an on line transaction system in which a large number of concurrent transactions must be processed by the I/O system and CPU.
Flexibility to interface a wide variety of devices is achieved because the system of the present invention does not presuppose any inherent characteristics of a device type. Instead, the present invention provides a structure and operation which can accommodate a wide variety of device operations.
The present invention provides for a maximum usage of resources, primarily by making a maximum usage of memory bandwidth. Each device uses a minimum of the memory bandwidth. This allows a relatively large number of devices to be associated with the particular I/O bus. Because of the inherent speed of the I/O bus, and the buffering technique of the present invention, each particular transfer is made at a relatively high speed limited only by memory speed. Because the transfers are in a burst mode, the overhead associated with each transfer is minimized. This maximizes the use of the channel bandwidth and also permits the use of high speed devices.
The present invention provides for failsoft access to peripheral devices. There are redundant paths to each peripheral device, and containment of failure on any particular path. Failure of a particular module in one path does not affect the operation of a module in another path to that device.
There are comprehensive error checks for checking data integrity over a path, sequence failures and timing failures.
Protection features prevent a peripheral device from contaminating its own buffer or the memory of the system. These protection features include a separate count word in each IOC table and a protect bit in the IOC table. The IOC table is accessible by the channel, but not by the device. This is a second level of protection to prevent the device from accessing any memory not assigned to that device.
The present invention requires only a small number of lines in the I/0 bus to provide a flexible and powerful I/0 system.
The operation of the device controller is well defined as power is turned on or off to protect the I/0 bus from erroneous signals during this time and also to permit on line maintenance and system upgrade.
The present invention uses stress to allow the buffers to cooperate without communicating with each other.
An on line transaction system is obtained through overlapped transfers and processing.
Multichannel direct memory access provides interleaved bursts to give overlapped transfers and minimum waits for accesses to a device. Each burst requires a minimum memory overhead and allows the processor to make maximum use of the memory. This combination allows maximum use of the I/0 bandwidth and minimal tie up of the processor.
Power Distribution System
The multiprocessor system of the present invention incorporates a power distribution system that over comes a number of problems associated with prior art systems.
In many prior art systems it was necessary to stop the processor system in order to perform required maintenance on a component of the system. Also, in many prior art systems, a failure in the power supply could stop the entire processor system.
The power distribution system of the present invention incorporates a plurality of separate and independent power supplies and distributes the power from the power supplies to the processor modules and to the device controllers in a way that permits on-line maintenance and also provides redundancy of power on each device controller.
In this regard "on-line" is used in the sense that when a part of the system is on-line, that part of the system is not only powered on, but it is also functioning with the system to perform useful work.
The term "on-line maintenance" therefore means maintaining a part of the system (including periodic preventative maintenance or repair work) while the remainder of the system is on-line as defined above.
In the present invention any processor module or device controller can be powered down so that on-line maintenance can be performed in a power off condition on that processor module or a device controller while the rest of the multiprocessor system is on-line and functional. The on-line maintenance can be performed while fully meeting Underwriters Laboratory safety requirements.
Also, in the power distribution system of the present invention each device controller is connected for supply of power from two separate power supplies and by a diode switching arrangement that permits the device controller to be supplied with power from both power supplies when both power supplies are operative and to be supplied with power from either one of the power supplies in the event the other power supply fails; and the changeover in the event of failure of one of the power supplies is accomplished smoothly and without any interruption or pulsation in the power supply so that an interrupt to a device controller is never required in the event of a failure of one of its associated power supplies.
A power distribution system for insuring both a primary supply and an alternate power supply for each individual dual port device controller 41 is illustrated in FIG. 30. The power distribution system is indicated generally by the reference numeral 301 in FIG. 30.
The power distribution system 301 insures that each dual port device controller 41 has both a primary power supply and an alternate power supply. Because each device controller does have two separate and independent sources of power supply, a failure of the primary power supply for a particular device controller does not render that device controller (and all of the devices associated with that controller) inoperative. Instead, in the present invention, a switching arrangement provides for an automatic switchover to the alternate power supply so that the device controller can continue in operation. The power distribution system thus coacts with the dual port system of the device controller to provide continuous operation and access to the devices in the event of a failure of either a single port or a single power supply.
The power distribution system 301 shown in FIG. 30 provides the further advantage that each processor module 33 and associated CPU 105 and memory 107 has a separate and independent power supply which is dedicated to that processor module. With this arrangement, a failure of any one power supply or a manual disconnection of any one power supply for repair or servicing of the power supply or associated processor module is therefore limited in effect to only one particular processor module and cannot affect the operation of any of the other processor modules in the multiprocessor system.
The power distribution system 301 shown in FIG. 30 thus works in combination with the individual processor modules and the dual port device controllers to insure that a failure or disconnection of any one power supply does not shut down the overall system or make any of the devices ineffective.
The power distribution system 301 includes a plurality of separate and independent power supplies 303, and each power supply 303 has a line 305 (actually a multiline bus 305 as shown in FIG. 33) which is dedicated to supplying power to the CPU and memory of a particular, related processor module.
Each device controller 41 is associated with two of the power supplies 303 through a primary line 307 and an alternate line 309 and an automatic switch 311.
A manually operated switch 313 is also associated with each device controller 41 between the device controller and the primary line 307 and the alternate line 309.
The switches 311 and 313 are shown in more detail in FIG. 31.
FIG. 32 shows details of the component construction of a power supply 303.
As shown in FIG. 32, each power supply 303 has an input connector 315 for taking power from the mains. The input 315 is connected to an AC to DC converter 317, and the output of the AC to DC converter provides, on a line 319, a five volt interruptable power supply (IPS). This five volt interruptable power supply is supplied to the CPU 105, the memory 107 and the device controller 41. See also FIG. 33.
The AC to DC converter 317 also provides on a second output line 321 a sixty volt DC output which is supplied to a DC to DC converter 323. See FIG. 32.
The DC to DC converter in turn provides a five volt output on a line 325 and a twelve volt output on a line 327.
The outputs from the lines 325 and 327 are, in the system of the present invention, uninterruptable power supply (UPS) outputs in that these power supply outputs are connected to the CPU and memory when semiconductor memory is used. The power supply to a semiconductor memory must not be interrupted because a loss of power to a semiconductor memory will cause loss of all data stored in the memory.
The five volt interruptable power supply on line 319 is considered an interruptable power supply because this power is supplied to parts of the multiprocessing system in which an interruption of power can be accepted. Thus, the five volts interruptable power is supplied to parts of the CPU other than semiconductor memory and to only those parts of the memory which are core memory (and for which a loss of power does not cause a loss of memory) and to the device controller which (as will be described in more detail below) is supplied with an alternate source of power in the event of a failure of the primary power supply.
Since the power supply on lines 325 and 327 must be an uninterruptable power supply, the present invention provides a battery back-up for the input to the DC to DC converter 323. This battery back-up includes a battery and charger module 329. The module 329 is connected to the DC to DC converter 323 by a line 331 and a diode 333.
In a particular embodiment of the present invention the battery 323 supplies power at 48 volts to the converter 323, which is within the input range of the converter 323.
The diode 333 insures that power from the battery is supplied to the converter 323 if the voltage on the line 321 drops below 48 volts. The diode 333 also stops the flow of current from the battery and the line 333 when the output of the AC to DC converter on line 321 exceeds 48 volts.
Each power supply 303 also includes a power warning circuitry 335 for detecting a condition in the AC power input on line 315 that would result in insufficient power out on the output lines 319, 325 and 327. The power warning circuit 335 transmits a power failure warning signal on a line 337 to the related CPU 105.
Because of the capacity storage in the power supply 303, there is enough time between the power warning signal and the loss of the five volts interruptable power on line 319 for the CPU to save its state before the power is lost.
However, the uninterruptable power supply on lines 325 and 327 must not be interrupted, even for an instant of time; and the battery back-up provided by the arrangement shown in FIG. 32 insures that there is no interruption in the power supply on lines 325 and 327 in the event of a power failure in the input line 315.
One particular power supply 303 itself can fail for some reason with the other power supplies 303 still operating. In that event, the power distribution system 301 of the present invention limits the effect of the failure of the power supply 303 to the loss of one particular, associated CPU and memory; and the automatic switch 311 provides for an automatic switchover from the failed power supply to the alternate power supply to keep the associated device controller 41 in operation. The device controller 41 which had been connected to the failed power supply therefore continues in operative association with the other processor modules and components of the multiprocessor system, because the required power is automatically switched in from the alternate power supply.
As best illustrated in FIG. 31, each automatic switch 311 includes two diodes--a diode 341 associated with the primary power line 307 and a diode 343 associated with the alternate power line 309.
The function of the diodes 341 and 343 is to permit power to be supplied to a device controller 41 from either the primary power line 307 and a related power supply 303 or the alternate power line and its related power supply 303 while keeping the supplies isolated. This prevents a failed power supply from causing its associated alternate or primary from failing.
In normal operation each diode permits a certain amount of current to flow through the diode so that the power to each device controller 41 is actually being supplied by both the primary and alternate power supplies for that device controller.
In the event that one of the power supplies fails, the full power is supplied by the other power supply, and this transition occurs without any loss of power at all.
Since there is a small voltage drop across the diodes 341 and 343, the voltage on the lines 307 and 309 must be enough higher than five volts to accomodate the voltage drop across the diodes 341 and 343 and still supply exactly five volts to the device controller 41. The lines 305 are in parallel with the lines 307 and 309, and the power actually received at the CPU in memory must also be five volts; so balancing diodes 339 are located in the lines 305 to insure that the voltage after the diodes 339 as supplied to each CPU is exactly five volts.
The manual switch 313 permits a device controller 41 to be disconnected from both the primary and the alternate power sources when the device controller needs to be disconnected for removal and service.
Details of the construction of the switch 313 are shown in FIG. 31. As shown in FIG. 31, the switch 313 includes a manual switch 345, a transistor 347, a capacitor 348 and a resistor 350 and a resistor 352.
The manual switch 345 is closed to turn on the transistor 347 which then supplies power to the device controller 41.
It is important that both the turn on and the turn off of power to the device controller 41 be accomplished in a smooth way and without fluctuations which could trigger the PON circuit 182 more than once. The feedback capacitor 348 acts in conjunction with the resistor 352 to cause the required smooth ramp build-up of power when the switch 345 is closed to turn the transistor 347 on.
When the transistor 347 is turned off by opening the switch 345, the feedback capacitor 348 acts in conjunction with resistor 350 to provide a smooth fall off of power.
In a preferred embodiment of the invention all of diodes 341, 343 and 339 are Schottky diodes which have a very low forward voltage drop, and this reduces power dissipation.
As noted above in the description of the I/0 system and dual port device controller 41, each device controller 41 does have a power on circuit (PON) 182 for detecting when the five volt power is below specifications. The PON circuit 182 is shown in more detail in FIG. 25 and resets the device controller 41 to lock everything off of the device controller and holds the device controller itself in a state that is known when the power is turned off by the switch 313. The PON circuit 182 also releases the device controller and returns it to operation after the power is turned on by switch 313 and five volt power supply at the proper specification is supplied to the device controller 41.
Further details of the power on circuit 182 shown in FIG. 25 are described above in relation to the I/0 and dual port controller system.
With reference to FIG. 33, the power from each power supply 303 is transmitted to a related CPU by the vertical bus 305, and each vertical bus 305 is a laminated bus bar which has five layers of electrical conductors.
As indicated by the legends in FIG. 33, each vertical bus 305 has two different conductors connected to ground.
One conductor provides the ground for both the five volt interruptable power supply (IPS) and the five volt uninterruptable power supply (UPS).
A separate conductor provides a ground for the memory voltage. This separate ground for the memory voltage insures that the relatively large fluctuations in current to the memory will not have any effect on either the five volt IPS or the five volt UPS supplied to the CPU.
The horizontal bus 307, 309 includes the primary and alternate power supply lines 307 and 309 (as indicated by the reference numerals in Fi9. 30). In a particular embodiment of the present invention the bus 307, 309 is actually a nine layer laminated bus which has a single ground and eight voltage layers (V1 through V8 as indicated by the legends and notations in FIG. 33).
Each voltage layer is connected to the five volt interruptable output of a different power supply 303. Thus, the layer V1 is connected at 351 to the five volt IPS power for the power supply 303 and related processor module farthest to the left as viewed in FIG. 33, and the layer V2 is connected at 353 to the five Volt IPS power supply 303 for the processor module at the center as viewed in FIG. 33, and so on.
Since there are eight layers (V1 through V8) and a common ground available to each device controller in the horizontal bus, upstanding vertical taps 355 to these eight layers at spaced intervals along the horizontal bus permit each device controller 41 to be associated with any two of the power supplies 303 merely by connecting the primary line 307 and the alternate line 309 to a particular set of taps. By way of example, the device controller 41 on the lefthand side of FIG. 33 is shown connected to the taps V111 and V2 and the device controller 41 on the righthand side of FIG. 33 is shown connected to the taps V2 and V3.
Thus, any device controller 41 can be connected to any two of the power supplies 303 with any one of the power supplies serving as the primary power supply and any one of the other power supplies serving as the alternate power supply.
The power distribution system of the present invention thus provides a number of important benefits.
The power distribution system permits on line maintenance to be performed because one processor module or device controller can be powered down while the rest of the multiprocessor system is on line and functional.
The power distribution system fully meets all Underwriter Laboratory safety requirements for doing on line maintenance of a powered down component while the rest of the multiprocessor system is on line and in operation.
Each device controller is associated with two separate power supplies so that a failure in one of the power supplies does not cause the device controller to stop operation. Instead, the electronic switch arrangement of the present invention provides such a smooth transition of power from the two power supplies to only one of the power supplies that the device controller is maintained in continuous operation without an interrupt.
Memory System
Each processor module 33 (see FIG. 1) in the multiprocessor system 31 contains a memory.
This memory is indicated by the general reference numeral 107 in FIG. 1 and is shown in greater detail in FIG. 34.
The memory 107 of each processor module 33 is associated with both the CPU 105 and the I/0 channel 109 of that module. There is a dual port access to the memory by the CPU and the channel. That is, the CPU 105 (see FIG. 1 and FIG. 34) can access the memory for program or data references, and the I/0 channel 109 can also access the memory directly (without having to go through the CPU) for data transfers to and from a device controller 41. This dual access to the memory is illustrated in FIG. 34 and will be described in greater detail below in the description of the FIG. 34 structure and operation.
One benefit of this dual access to the memory is that CPU and channel accesses to the memory can be interleaved in time. There is no need for either the CPU or the channel to wait for access to the memory, except in the case where both the CPU and the channel are trying to access the memory at exactly the same time. As a result, both the CPU and the channel can be performing their separate functions simultaneously, subject to an occasional wait by the CPU or channel if one of these units is accessing the memory at the exact time the other unit needs to access the memory.
The dual port access also allows background I/0 operation. The CPU 105 needs to be involved with the channel 109 only in the initiation and termination of I/0 data transfers. The CPU can be performing other functions during the actual I/0 data transfer itself.
The memory 107 shown in FIG. 34 comprises a physical memory which consists of up to 262,144 words of sixteen data bits each.
In addition to the sixteen data bits, each word in memory has an additional parity bit if the memory is a core memory or six additional error correction bits if the memory is a semiconductor memory.
The parity bit permits detection of single bit errors.
The six error correction bits permit detection and correction of single bit errors and also permit detection of all double bit errors.
The physical memory is conceptually subdivided into contiguous blocks of 1024 words each (which are called pages). The pages in physical memory are numbered consecutively from page zero, starting at physical location zero. The address range of physical memory in one specific embodiment of the present invention, which address range is zero through 262,143, requires eighteen bits of physical address information.
The basic architecture of the present invention is, however, constructed to accommodate and utilize twenty bits of physical address information, as will become more apparent from the description to follow.
In one specific embodiment of the invention the physical memory is physically divided into physical modules of 32,768 words. Thus, eight of these modules provide the 262,143 words noted above.
All accesses to memory are made to one of four logical address areas--user data, system data, user code and system code areas. All CPU instructions deal with these logical (as distinct from physical) addresses exclusively. Thus, a programmer need not be concerned with an actual physical address but can instead write a program based entirely on logical addresses and the logical addresses are translated by the map section of memory system into physical addresses. The range of addressing in any given logical address area is that of a sixteen bit logical address, zero through 65,535. Thus, each logical address area comprises sixty-four logical pages of 1024 words each.
In the memory system of the present invention there is no required correspondence between a logical page and a physical page. Instead, the various logical pages comprising an operating system program or a user program need not reside in contiguous physical pages. In addition, the logical pages need be in physical main memory but may be in secondary memory, such as on a disc.
This allows implementation of a virtual memory scheme.
Virtual memory has two benefits.
First, virtual memory allows the use of a physical main memory space which is smaller than the logical address areas would require, because the physical memory can be supplemented by a secondary physical memory.
Secondly, virtual memory permits address spaces of a plurality of users (multiprogramming) to share the physical memory, and each user does not have to be concerned with the allocation of physical memory among the operating system, himself, or other users.
The memory system of the present invention provides protection between users in the multiprogramming environment by guaranteeing that one user program cannot read from or write into the memory space of another user program. This is accomplished by the paging and mapping system. When one user program is running, the map for that user program points only to the memory pages (up to sixty-four pages of code and sixty-four pages of data) for that particular user program. That particular user program cannot address outside its own logical address space and therefore cannot write into or read from the memory space of another user program.
The fact that code pages are non-modifiable also prevents a user program from destroying itself.
Thus, there are two levels of protection for user programs operating in a multiprogramming environment--the fact that each user map points only to its own pages in memory and the fact that code pages are non-modifiable. Also, in the present invention, this protection is achieved without protection limit registers or by protection keys as often used in the prior art.
The required translation of a sixteen bit logical address to an eighteen bit physical address is accomplished by a mapping scheme. As part of this mapping scheme, a physical page number is obtained by a look-up operation within a map. This physical page number is then combined with the address within a page to form the complete physical memory address.
Only the page number is translated. The offset or address within a page is never changed in the mapping.
In the present invention there are four map sections. Each map section corresponds to one of the four logical addressing areas (user data, system data, user code and system code).
The separation of the logical address into these four separate and distinct areas provides significant benefits.
The separation provides isolation of programs from data so that programs are never modified. The separation also provides isolation of system programs and data from user programs and data, and this protects the operating system from user errors.
The four map sections are designated as follows:
Map 0--user data map. All addresses to variable user data areas are translated through this user data map.
Map 1--system data map. The system data map is similar to the user data map and in addition, all memory references by either the I/0 channel, the interprocessor bus handling microprogram, or the interrupt handling microprogram specifies this map. The system data map provides channel access to all of physical memory via only a sixteen bit address word.
Map 2--user code map. This map defines the active user program. All user instructions and constant data are obtained via this user code map.
Map 3--system code map. This map defines the operating system program. All operating system instructions and constant data are obtained via this system code map.
Each map section has sixty-four entries corresponding to the sixty-four pages possible in each logical address area. Each entry contains the following information.
(1) The physical page number field (which can have a value of zero through 255).
(2) An odd parity bit for the map entry. The parity bit is generated by the map logic whenever a map entry is written.
(3) A reference history field. The reference history field comprises reference bits, and the high order bit of the reference bits is set to a "one" by any use of the page corresponding to that map entry.
(4) A dirty bit. The dirty bit is set to a "one" when a write access is made to the corresponding memory page.
The reference bits and the dirty bit are used by the memory manager function of the operating system to help select a page for overlay. The dirty bit also provides a way to avoid unnecessary swaps of data pages to secondary memory.
(5) An absent bit. The absent bit is initially set to a "one" by the operating system to flag a page as being absent from main memory. An access to a page with this bit set to "one" causes an interrupt to the operating system page fault interrupt handler to activate the operating system virtual memory manager function. The absent bit is also used as a protection mechanism to prevent erroneous access by a program outside its intended logical address area for either code or data.
Three instructions are used by the operating system in connection with the map. These three instructions are: SMAP, RMAP, AMAP.
The SMAP (set map entry) instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to insert data into a map entry. This instruction requires two parameters--the map entry address and the data to be inserted.
The RMAP (read map entry) instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to read a map entry. This instruction requires one parameter, the map entry address, and the result returned by the instruction is the map entry content.
The AMAP (age map entry) instruction causes the reference history field of a map entry to be shifted one position to the right. This is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to maintain reference history information as an aid in selecting a page for overlay.
A page fault interrupt provided by the absent bit occurs when a reference is made to a page that does not currently reside in main memory or which is not part of the logical address space of the program or its data. When a page fault is detected, an interrupt through to the operating system page fault interrupt handler occurs.
The page fault interrupt sequence includes the following events:
1. An address reference is made to a page that is absent from physical memory (absent bit="one").
2. The page fault interrupt occurs. The 8 interrupt handler microcode places an interrupt parameter indicating the map number and the logical page number in a memory location known to the operating system. Then the current environment is saved in an interrupt stack marker in memory.
3. The page fault interrupt handler executes. If the page fault occurred because of a reference outside the logical address space of the program, then the program is terminated with an error condition. On the other hand, if a page fault occurred because the logical page was absent from physical main memory (but present in secondary memory), an operating system process executes to read the absent page from the secondary memory (usually disc) to an available page in primary memory . That physical page information and a zero absent bit are inserted into the map entry. When this memory management function completes, the environment that caused the page fault is restored.
4. The instruction previously causing the page fault is reexecuted. Since the absent bit in the map entry of the logical page has now been set to a "zero", a page fault will not occur, the page address is translated to the physical page just brought in from secondary memory, and the instruction completes.
As noted above, the I/0 channel has access to the memory through its own port.
Data transfers to and from memory by the I/0 channel are via the system data map. That is, the sixteen bit logical addresses provided by the I/0 channel are translated to an eighteen bit physical address by means of the system data map.
Thus, the mapping scheme allows I/0 access to more words of physical memory than its address counter would normally allow.
In one specific embodiment of the present invention 262,144 words of physical memory (for an eighteen bit address) can be accessed with only a sixteen bit logical address by going through the map. The extra address information (the physical page information) is contained in the map and is supplied by the operating system before each I/0 transfer is initiated.
As will become more apparent from the detailed description to follow, the present invention is also readily extendible to a twenty bit physical address.
FIG. 34 is a block diagram showing details of the memory 107 of a processor module 33 and showing also connections from the memory 107 to the CPU 105 and the I/0 channel 109 of that processor module.
As illustrated in FIG. 34, the memory system 107 provides access ports for both the CPU 105 and the I/0 channel 109 to the memory 107, and the I/0 channel 109 therefore is not required to access the memory through the CPU 105.
The memory 107 includes map memory control logic 401 which controls initiation and completion of access to physical memory modules 403.
The memory 107 also includes a data path section 405 containing registers (as indicated by the legends in FIG. 34 and described in detail below) which supply data to be written to memory and which hold data read from memory.
The memory 107 also includes a map section 407. The map section 407 includes logical address registers from both the CPU and the channel and a map storage 409 from which physical page numbers are obtained.
The map section 407 thus contains a processor memory address (PMA) register 411 and a channel memory address (CMA) register 129.
These two registers are connected to an address selector 415.
The address selector 415 is connected to the map 409 by a logical page address bus 417, and the address selector 415 is also connected directly to the memory modules by a page offset bus 419.
As indicated by the numerals 8 and 10 adjacent to the buses 417 and 419, the logical page address bus 417 transmits the eight high order bits to the map 409 for translation to a physical page number, and the page offset bus 419 transmits the ten low order bits (of an eighteen page address from the address selector 415) to the memory modules 403.
An output bus 421 supplies the physical page address to the modules 403. This output bus 421 contains the translated eight high order bits for the address of the physical page.
The data path section 405 contains the following registers: A processor memory data (PMD) register 423; a channel memory data (CMD) register 425; a next instruction (NI) register 431; a memory data (MD) register 433; and a channel data (CD) register 125.
The outputs of the PMD and CMD registers are supplied to a data selector 427. This data selector 427 has an output bus 429 which supplies data to be written to memory in the modules 403.
Data read out from one of the memory modules 403 is read into one of the three data registers NI, MD and CD over a bus 437.
As illustrated in FIG. 34, the map memory control logic 401 is also connected with each of the memory modules 403 by a bus 439. The bus 439 comprises command lines which initiate read or write operations, completion signals from the memory modules, and error indicators or flags.
With reference now to FIG. 35, the map section 407 includes, in addition to the map 409, a map page register 441, a map output latch 443, a map memory data (MMD) register 445, a map data selector 447, a map parity generator 449, a map parity checker 451, reference bit logic 453, and dirty bit logic 455.
The map memory control logic 401 is shown in FIG. 35 as associated with the map section 407 by control signal lines 457.
The map memory control logic 401 controls the loading of registers and selection of registers by the selectors, controls (in conjunction with map absence and parity error outputs) the initiation of memory modules 403 operations, and provides interrupts to the CPU 105 (as indicated by the page fault and map parity error interrupt signals indicated by the legends in FIG. 35)--all as will be described in more detail below.
In a particular embodiment of the invention the memory system shown in FIGS. 34 and 35 utilizes a physical page address field of eight bits and a page offset of ten bits which combine to give a total eighteen bits. As noted above, the numbers 8, 10, 12, 13, 14 and 18 which are not in parenthesis on certain bus lines in FIG. 34 and FIG. 35 relate to this specific eighteen bit implemented embodiment of the present invention. However, the memory system is easily expandable to a twenty bit implemented embodiment (with a physical page address of ten bits) and this is indicated by the numbers (10), (12), (14), (15), (16) and (20) which are within parenthesis on the same bus lines of FIG. 35.
FIG. 36 illustrates the organization of logical memory in four separate and distinct logical address areas 459, 461, 463 and 465. These four logical address areas are: user data area 459; system data area 461; user code area 463; and system code area 465.
FIG. 36 also illustrates the four map sections corresponding to the logical address areas.
Thus, the user data map section 467 corresponds to the logical user data address area 459, the system data map section 469 corresponds to the logical system data address area 461, the user code map section 471 corresponds to the logical user code address area 463 and the system code map section 473 corresponds to the logical system code address area 465.
As also illustrated in FIG. 36, each map section has sixty-four logical page entries (page zero through page sixty-three), and each map entry comprises sixteen bits (as illustrated by the enlarged single map entry in FIG. 36).
As indicated by the legends associated with the enlarged map entry shown in FIG. 36, each map entry comprises a ten bit physical page number field, a single parity bit P, a reference history field comprising three reference bits R, S and T, a single dirty bit D, and a single absent bit A.
The physical page number field provided by the ten high order bits provides the physical page number corresponding to the logical page called for by the program.
The parity bit P is always generated as odd parity to provide a data integrity check on the map entry contents.
The reference history field bits R, S and T are used by the memory manager function of the operating system to maintain reference history information for selecting the least recently used page for overlaying.
The R bit is set to a one by any read or write operation to that logical page.
The S and T bits are storage bits which are manipulated by the AMAP (age a map entry) instruction.
The dirty bit D is set to a one by a write access to that logical page. The operating system uses the dirty bit to determine whether a data page has been modified since it was last brought in from secondary memory.
The absent bit A is set to a one by the operating system to flag a logical page which is absent from main memory but present in secondary memory or to flag a page which is outside the logical address area of that user.
The two high order bits for the map entry shown in FIG. 36 are not used in the specific embodiment of the invention illustrated in the drawings, but these two bits are used when the full twenty bit physical addressing is used.
As noted above, three instructions are used by the operating system in connection with the map. These three instructions are: SMAP, RMAP and AMAP.
The SMAP instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to insert data into a map entry like that illustrated in FIG. 36.
The SMAP instruction is implemented by the microprogram 115 (FIG. 12) in the CPU 105. The microprogram interacts with the map memory control logic 401 (see FIG. 34), first of all, to select (with the first instruction parameter)a location in the map 409 and then, second, to insert in that location the second instruction parameter--the new map entry data.
In operation, and referring to FIG. 35, in the first step in the sequence the microprogram 115 loads the new map entry data into the processor memory data (PMD) register 423.
In the next step in the sequence, the map address, including two high order bits for map selection, are loaded into the processor memory address (PMA) register 411.
At this point the two instruction parameters containing the map entry address and the data to be inserted have been loaded in their respective registers 411 and 423.
Next, the microprogram 115 in the CPU 105 initiates a map write operation sequence of the map memory control logic 401. This map write operation sequence is initiated after any previous memory operations have been completed.
The steps noted above in the operation sequence have all been performed by the microprogram (the firmware).
The remaining actions of the SMAP instruction are performed under the control of the map memory control logic. Thus, the remaining actions are all performed automatically by hardware.
In the map write operation sequence, the map address is transmitted from the PMA register through the address selector 415 over the bus 417 to the map 409. Only the eight high order bits (the map select and map address) are used in this operation. The two high order bits specify the map selection--whether user data, system data, user code or system code.
The ten low order bits of the logical address bus from the address selector (ASEL) 415 (which bits are the offset within a page for a memory read or write access) are not used in this operation.
As the map is being addressed as described above, the new map data is transmitted from the PMD register 423 through the map data selector 447 to the map parity generator 449 and to the map 409. The map parity generator computes odd parity on the new map data and supplies this parity bit to the map.
Now, at this point, the map memory control logic 401 generates a map write strobe signal (on one of the lines indicated by 457 in FIG. 35) to the map 409 which causes the new data and parity to be written into the selected map section at the specific map entry selected by the logical page address on the bus 417.
This completes the SMAP instruction sequence.
At the end of this SMAP instruction the proper map section has been selected, the particular logical page entry on that map section has been selected, the data and computed odd parity have been supplied to the map, and the map write strobe has caused that data to be written at the desired map entry.
The SMAP instruction (SMAP) is used by the operating system to initialize each logical page entry in each of the four map sections as required.
One use of the set map instruction is therefor to insert a physical page address for a logical page to provide for translation of logical page numbers to physical page numbers after a page has been swapped in from secondary memory.
Another use of the set map instruction is to set on an absent bit for a logical page swapped out to secondary memory.
The read map (RMAP) instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to examine the content of a map entry.
In this RMAP instruction the microprogram 115 in the CPU 105 interacts with the map memory control logic 401 to select (with the instruction parameter) a location in the map 409 and to return to the register stack 112 (see FIG. 12) as a result of the content of that map entry.
In the operation of the read map (RMAP) instruction, referring to FIG. 35, the microprogram 115 loads the map address, including the two high order bits for the map selection, into the PMA register 411. The microprogram 115 then initiates a map read operation sequcnce of the map memory control logic 401.
This sequence is then carried out by the hardware, and in this sequence the map address is transmitted from the PMA register 411 through the address selector 415 to the map 409. Again, only the map select and page address bits are used in this operation.
The content of the selected map entry is transmitted from the map 409 to the map parity checker 451 (see FIG. 35) and to the map output latch 443. The map parity checker 451 compares the parity bit from the map entry with the odd parity computed on the data.
If the parity is incorrect, the map address is loaded into the map page register 441; and the map parity error signal sets an error flag which causes a map parity error interrupt to the CPU 105.
Otherwise, in the case of correct parity, the map entry data is loaded from the map output latch 443 into the map memory data register (MMD) 445.
Finally, the RMAP instruction microprogram returns the data in the map memory data (MMD) register 445 to the register stack 112 (see FIG. 12) as the result of the instruction.
At the end of the read map (RMAP) instruction the proper map section has been selected, the particular logical page entry on that map section has been selected, and the content of that map entry has been read out from the map and returned as an instruction result to the CPU's register stack.
The uses of the RMAP instruction include the following.
The main function of this read map (RMAP) instruction is to allow the operating system to examine the reference history field and dirty bit of a map entry (see the map entry format shown in FIG. 36) to determine a page for overlaying (as will become more apparent from the description of the operation to follow).
The read map (RMAP) instruction is also used in diagnostics to determine whether the map storage is functioning properly.
The age map (AMAP) instruction is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to maintain useful reference history information in the map. This reference history information is maintained in the map by map entries (the R,S and T bits of the map entry format shown in FIG. 36) within a map section which are typically "aged" after each page fault interrupt occurrence in that map section.
This AMAP instruction has just a single para-meter which is the map address specifying the map location to be aged.
In the operation of the age map (AMAP) instruction, the microprogram 115 in the CPU 105 selects a map location with the instruction map address parameter. The microprogram 115 loads the map address parameter into the PMA register just as in the RMAP instruction.
At this point a map read operation sequence of the map memory control logic 401 is initiated, and this sequence proceeds identically as in the RMAP instruction described above.
The microprogram 115 (FIG. 12) reads the content of the map entry from the MMD register 445 (Fig. 35) extracts the reference history field (the R, S and T bits 10, 11 and 12 shown in FIG. 36), shifts the field right one position, and reinserts the field to form the new map entry data. Thus, a zero has been entered in the R bit, the R bit has been shifted into the S bit, the S bit has been shifted into the T bit, and the old T bit is lost.
Now the microprogram 115 takes the modified map entry and loads this new data into the PMD register 423 (FIG. 34) and writes the new map entry data back into the selected map entry (similar to the SMAP sequence).
This completes the age map (AMAP) instruction.
As a result of the age map (AMAP) instruction, a map entry has been read from the map, its reference history field has been shifted, and this modified entry has been reinserted into the selected map location.
As previously noted, the R bit is set to one by any memory reference to the corresponding logical page, so that when this bit is a one, it is an indication that this page has been used since the last set map (SMAP) or age map (AMAP) operation instruction.
This setting of the R bit in conjunction with the age map (AMAP) instruction provides a means for maintaining frequency of use information in the reference history field of the map.
The reference history field of all of the map entries in a given map are typically aged after a page fault interrupt. Thus, the value of the three bit reference field in a map entry is an indication of the frequency of access since the previous three page fault interrupts.
For example, a binary value of seven (all three reference bits set at one), indicates accesses in each of the intervals between the proceeding page fault interrupts.
A binary value of four in the reference history field (the R bit set at one and the S and T bits set at zero) indicates an access in the interval since the last page fault interrupt and indicates that there were no accesses in the intervals previous to the most recent page fault interrupt.
As a final example, a binary value of zero for the three bit reference field indicates that that logical page has not been accessed in any of the three intervals since the last three page fault interrupts.
Thus, the higher the binary number represented by the three bit reference history field, the higher the frequency of recent accesses to that logical page.
This reference history information is maintained so that when it is necessary to select a page for overlay, a page which has been infrequently used in the recent past can be identified. A page infrequently accessed in the recent past is likely to continue that behavior, and that page will therefore probably not have to be swapped back into memory after being overlayed.
This frequency of use history is used by the memory manager function of the operating system to select infrequently used pages for overlay so as to minimize swapping from secondary memory to implement an efficient virtual memory system.
As noted above, memory may be accessed by the CPU or by the I/O system.
The action of the memory system and map during a CPU memory access sequence will now be described. The access sequence is similar for the various CPU memory accesses such as writing data, reading data, or reading instructions from memory.
The CPU memory access sequence is started either by the CPU microprogram 115 or by the CPU instruction-fetch logic. In either event, the CPU 105 loads an eighteen bit logical address into the PMA register 411 and initiates a data read, data write, or instruction read operation sequence of the map memory control logic 401.
The eighteen bit logical address is composed of two high order logical address space select bits and sixteen low order bits specifying a location within that logical address space. The two select bits may be specified by the CPU microprogram 115 or may be automatically generated in the CPU, based on the contents of the instruction (I) and environment (E) registers.
The eighteen bit logical address also includes, in addition to the two high order logical address select bits, six bits which specify the logical page within the selected map and ten low order bits which specify the offset within the page in the selected map.
In the data read, data write, or instruction read operation sequence of the map memory control logic 401, after any previous map or memory operations have completed, the eighteen bit address in the PMA register 411 (FIG. 35) is transmitted through the address selector 415 to the buses 417 and 419 (see FIGS. 34 and 35).
The bus 419 transmits the page offset portion of the address. This page offset portion of the address is transmitted directly to the physical memory modules 403 (FIG. 403) by the bus 419.
The bus 417 transmits the logical page address portion (which must be translated to a physical page address) to the map 409.
The map entry selected by the logical page address is read out from the map 409 to the map memory control logic 401 (FIG. 34), the map parity checker 451 (FIG. 35), and the map output latch 443.
If the absent bit is a one, the logical page address is loaded into the map page register 441, a page fault interrupt signal is transmitted to the CPU 105, and the map memory control logic 401 terminates the memory access sequence.
Similarly, if the parity checker 451 detects incorrect parity in the map entry, the logical page address is loaded into the map page register 441, a map parity error signal is transmitted to the CPU, and the memory access sequence is terminated.
Otherwise, if there is no error, the physical page address is transmitted from the map output latch 443 over the bus 421 to the physical memory modules 403; and the map memory control logic 401 issues a command over the bus 439 to cause the selected memory module 403 to perform a read or write operation.
In a CPU write operation the data to be written is transmitted from the PMD register 423 through the data selector 427 to the memory module over the bus 429.
While the memory module is performing a read or write operation, the map memory control logic 401 causes the map entry data to be modified and rewritten.
The map entry data, without the parity bit P or the reference bit R, is transmitted from the map output latch 443 to the dirty bit logic 455 (see FIG. 35) and to the map data selector 447.
In this operation the physical page field of a map entry (shown in enlarged detail in the lower righthand part of FIG. 36) and the S and T bits of the reference field and the absent bit are always rewritten without modification.
If a CPU data write operation is being performed, the dirty bit D supplied to the map data selector is set to a one by the dirty bit logic 455. Otherwise, the dirty bit is not modified.
The reference bit R supplied to the map data selector by the reference bit logic 453 is set to a one in either a read or a write operation.
The physical page field and the S, T and A bits are not modified, as noted above.
The map data selector 447 supplies this new map data to the parity generator 449 and to the map 409.
An odd parity bit P is generated from the new data by the parity generator 449 (see FIG. 35).
A map write strobe from the map memory control logic 401 then causes the new data and parity to be written into the map entry selected by the logical page address bus 417.
Thus, the logical page has been translated through the map entry, and the map entry has been rewritten with updated parity, reference, and dirty bits.
When the physical memory module 403 completes its read or write operation, it sends a completion signal to the map memory control logic 401 over the bus 439 (see FIG. 34).
In a read operation the memory module 403 gates the memory data to the bus 437 (FIG. 34).
In a data read operation sequence the data is loaded into the MD register 433 (FIG. 34) for use by the CPU 105.
In an instruction read operation sequence the data is loaded into the NI register 431 (FIG. 34) for subsequent execution by the CPU 105.
The CPU memory accesses of data read, data write and instruction read are thus completed as described above.
An I/O channel access to read or to write data to memory proceeds similar to a CPU memory access as described above except for the following.
The channel memory address (CMA) register 129 (FIG. 34) is used to provide the logical address, and this register always specifies the system data map 469 (see FIG. 35).
The channel memory data (CMD) register 425 (FIG. 34) is used to supply data to memory in a write operation.
The channel data (CD) register 125 (FIG. 34) is used to receive data from memory in a read operation.
In an I/O channel 109 memory access, the access is always a read or write data to memory access, and there is no instruction read access as in the case of a CPU access.
In addition, map parity and absent conditions are transmitted to the I/O channel 109 if they occur in an I/O channel access to memory.
As noted at several points above, either semiconductor memory core memory is used for the memory modules 403.
When the memory is core memory, errors are detected by a parity error detection system. The parity error detection system for core memory modules is effective to detect all single bit errors. Conventional parity error generation and checking techniques are used, and details of the core memory will therefore not be illustrated.
The probability of failures in semiconductor memory is great enough to justify an error detection and correction system, and the present invention provides a detection and correction system which incorporates a six bit check field for each sixteen bit data word. FIGS. 37-41 and related Table 1 (set out below) illustrate details of an error detection and correction system used when the mexory modules 403 are constructed with semiconductor memory.
The six bit check field error detection and correction system of the present invention is, as will be described in detail below, capable of detecting and correcting all single bit errors and is also capable of detecting all double bit errors. In addition, most errors of three or more bits are detected.
While the error detection and correction system will be described with reference to a semiconductor memory, it should be noted that the system is not limited or restricted to semiconductor memory but is instead useful for any data storage or transmission application.
An important benefit of the error detection and correction system of the present invention results from the fact that not only are single bit errors corrected but also that any subsequent double bit errors are reliably detected after a single bit has failed.
The multiprocessor system incorporating the error detection and correction system of the present invention is therefore tolerant of single failures and can be operated with single bit failures in semiconductor memory until such time as it is convenient to repair the memory.
The error detection and correction system utilizes a systematic linear binary code of Hamming distance four. In this code each check bit is a linear combination of eight data bits (as shown in FIG. 38). Also, each data bit is a component of exactly three check bits (as also shown in FIG. 38). An advantage of this code is that uniform coverage of the data bits by the check bits is obtained.
The error correction and detection system embodies a syndrome decoder which provides the combination of fast logic speed and low parts count.
In initial summary, the error detection and correction system of the present invention operates to add six check bits to each data word written into storage. When a data word is subsequently read out of memory, the check field portion of the storage word is used to identify or to detect the loss of information in that word since the time it was stored.
In semiconductor memory there are two possible mechanisms for loss of information (error). One is hard failure of a memory device which makes that device permanently unable to retain information, and the other is soft failure in which electrical noise can cause a transient loss of information.
The detection of errors is accomplished by a check bit comparator which produces a six bit syndrome. The syndrome is the difference between the check field obtained from the stored word and the check field which would normally correspond to the data field obtained from the stored word.
This syndrome is then analyzed (decoded) to determine whether an error has occurred and, if an error has occurred, to determine what type of correction is required.
In the case of single data bit errors, the syndrome decoder output causes a data bit complementer to invert the bit that was in error; and this corrected data is supplied as the output of that memory module.
If the syndrome decoder indicates a multiple error, then the fact of the multiple error is communicated to the map memory control section by means of one of the control and error lines to cause an interrupt to the CPU.
With reference now to FIG. 37, the memory module 403 includes a timing and control logic section 475 and a semiconductor storage array 477. The storage array 477 provides storage for 32,768 words of twenty-two bits each. Each word has (as illustrated in FIG. 37) a sixteen bit data field and a six bit check field.
Each semiconductor memory module 403 also has, as illustrated in FIG. 37, an output latch 479, a check bit generator 481, a check bit comparator 483, a syndrome decoder 485 and a data bit complementer 487.
The memory module 403 interfaces to the rest of the system through the signal and data paths illustrated in FIG. 37. These paths include: 429 (data to memory bus), 439 (control and error lines to the map memory control section 401), 419 and 421 (physical address bus), and 437 (data from memory bus). These signal and data paths are also shown in FIG. 34.
With continued reference to FIG. 37, the content of the output latch 479 is transmitted on a bus 489 to both the check bit comparator 483 and the data bit comparator 487.
The output of the check bit comparator 483 is transmitted on a syndrome bus 491 to both the syndrome decoder 485 and the timing and control logic section 475.
The output of the syndrome decoder 485 is transmitted on a bus 493 to the data bit complementer 487.
Other outputs of the syndrome decoder 485 are transmitted on lines 495 and 497 to the timing and control logic section 475. The line 495 transmits a SINGLE ERROR (correctable error) signal, and the line transmits a MULTIPLE ERROR (uncorrectable error) signal.
The timing and control logic 475 provides control signals on a control bus 499 to the semiconductor storage array 477 and also to the output latch 479.
The output of the check bit generator 481 is transmitted to the storage array 477 by a bus 501.
With reference to FIG. 38, the check bit generator 481 includes six separate eight-bit parity trees 503.
As shown in FIG. 39, the check bit comparator 483 includes six separate nine-bit parity trees 505.
As shown in FIG. 40, the syndrome decoder 485 includes a decoder section 507 and a six-bit parity tree 509.
With continued reference to FIG. 40, the outputs of the decoder section 507 and six-bit parity tree 509 are combined in error identification logic indicated generally by the reference numeral 511.
As illustrated in FIG. 41, the bit complementer 437 comprises sixteen exclusive-or gates 513.
In operation the sixteen bit data word is supplied by the bus 429 to the storage array 477 and also to the check bit generator 481 (see FIG. 37).
The check bit generator 481, as best illustrated in FIG. 38, generates six check bits C0 through C5 by means of the six eight-bit parity trees 503.
As also illustrated in FIG. 38, the eight-bit parity tree 503 farthest to the left generates check bit zero (C0) as specified by the logic equation for C0 as set out at the lower part of FIG. 38. Check bit zero (C0) is therefore the complement of the modulo-two sum of data bits 8 through 15.
By way of further example, the check bit C3 is generated by an eight bit parity tree 503 as specified by the logic equation for C3 set out at the lower part of FIG. 38. Check bit three (C3) is the modulo-two sum of data bits 0, 1, 2, 4, 7, 9, 10 and 12 as shown by the logic equation and as also illustrated by the connections between the eight bit parity tree and the corresponding data bit lines in the logic diagram in the upper part of FIG. 38.
Similarly, each of the other check bits is generated by a modulo-two addition of eight data bits as illustrated in the logic diagram in the top part of FIG. 38.
To accomplish a memory write operation, these six check bits, as thus generated by the check bit generator 481, and the sixteen data bits, as transmitted on the data bus 429, are entered in a particular location in the storage array 477. As illustrated in FIG. 37, the six check bits and the sixteen data bits are entered in the storage array 477 under the control of the timing and control logic 475 and the physical address information on the physical address bus 419, 421.
Every word stored in the storage array 477 has a six bit check field generated for that word in a similar manner. This check field is retained with the stored word in the storage array 477 until the time when that location in the storage array is subsequently accessed for a read operation.
When a particular word is to be read out of the storage array 477, the timing and control logic 475 and the address on the physical address bus 419, 421 causes the content of the selected storage location to be loaded into the output latch 479. The output latch is twenty-two bits wide to accommodate the sixteen data bits and the six bit check field.
From the output latch 479 the sixteen data bits and the six bit check field are transmitted by a bus 489 to the check bit comparator 483.
As illustrated in FIG. 39, the check bit comparatpor 483 forms six syndrome bits S0 through S5.
Each syndrome bit is the output of a nine-bit parity tree 505 whose inputs are eight data bits and one check bit. Each syndrome bit is related to a correspondingly numbered check bit. Thus, check bit zero is used only for computing syndrome bit zero, check bit one is used only for computing syndrome bit one, and so forth.
As an example, syndrome bit zero (S0) is the complement of the modulo-two sum of check bit zero and data bits 8 through 15 (as shown in the logic equation at the bottom of FIG. 39).
Similarly, each of syndrome bits S 1 through S 5 is generated from the modulo two sum of a corresponding check bit and eight of the data bits, as shown by the connections to the particular data bit lines for each syndrome bit in the logic diagram part of FIG. 39.
The presence or absence of errors and the types of errors, if any, are identified by interpreting the value of the six syndrome bits on the bus 491.
Table 1 enumerates the sixty-four possible values of the six bit syndrome code and gives the interpretation for each possible value.
                                  TABLE 1
__________________________________________________________________________
SYNDROME CODES
S0
  S1
    S2
      S3
        S4
          S5
            ERROR IN
                    S0
                      S1
                        S2
                          S3
                            S4
                              S5
                                ERROR IN
__________________________________________________________________________
0 0 0 0 0 0 (No Error)
                    1 0 0 0 0 0 C0
0 0 0 0 0 1 C5        0   0 0 1 (Double)
  0   0 1 0 C4        0   0 1 0 (Double)
  0   0 1 1 (Double)  0   0 1 1 D8
  0   1 0 0 C3        0   1 0 0 (Double)
  0   1 0 1 (Double)  0   1 0 1 D9
  0   1 1 0 (Double)  0   1 1 0 D10
0 0 0 1 1 1 D0        0   1 1 1 (Double)
0 0 1 0 0 0 C2      1 0 1 0 0 0 (Double)
  0   0 0 1 (Double)  0   0 0 1 D11
  0   0 1 0 (Double)  0   0 1 0 (Multi-All 0's)
  0   0 1 1 (Multi)   0   0 1 1 (Double)
  0   1 0 0 (Double)  0   1 0 0 D12
  0   1 0 1 D1        0   1 0 1 (Double)
  0   1 1 0 D2        0   1 1 0 (Double)
  0   1 1 1 (Double)  0   1 1 1 (Multi)
0 1 0 0 0 0 C1      1 1 0 0 0 0 (Double)
  0   0 0 1 (Double)  0   0 0 1 D13
  0   0 1 0 (Double)  0   0 1 0 D14
  0   0 1 1 D3        0   0 1 1 (Double)
  0   1 0 0 (Double)  0   1 0 0 (Multi)
  0   1 0 1 (Multi-All 1's)
                      0   1 0 1 (Double)
  0   1 1 0 D4        0   1 1 0 (Double)
  0   1 1 1 (Double)  0   1 1 1 (Multi)
0 1 1 0 0 0 (Double)
                    1 1 1 0 0 0 D15
  0   0 0 1 D5        0   0 0 1 (Double)
  0   0 1 0 D6        0   0 1 0 (Double)
  0   0 1 1 (Double)  0   0 1 1 (Multi)
  0   1 0 0 D7        0   1 0 0 (Double)
  0   1 0 1 (Double)  0   1 0 1 (Multi)
  0   1 1 0 (Double)  0   1 1 0 (Multi)
  0   1 1 1 (Multi)   0   1 1 1 (Double)
__________________________________________________________________________
 THUS (NUMBER OF 1's IN SYNDROME)
 0 BITS  NO ERROR
 1 BIT  CHECK BIT ERROR
 2 BITS  DOUBLE
 3 BITS  DATA BIT OR MULTI
 4 BITS  DOUBLE
 5 BITS  MULTI
 6 BITS  DOUBLE
For example, if all of the syndrome bits S 0 through S 5 are zero, there is no error in either the data field or the check field. This is the condition illustrated at the upper left of Table 1.
The presence or absence of errors and the type of error is summarized at the bottom of Table 1.
In this summarization, when all six syndrome bits are zero, there is no error, as noted above.
If only one of the six syndrome bits is on, this indicates an error in the corresponding check bit. It should be noted at this point that check bit errors are single bit errors which do not require correction of the data word.
As also illustrated in the summary at the bottom of Table 1, when two bits are on there is a double bit error; and the two errors could be (a) one error in a data bit and one error in a check bit or (b) two errors in the data bits or (c) two errors in the check bits.
When three bits are on in the six bit syndrome code, that condition can correspond to either a single data bit error or a multiple error.
As an example of a single bit error in a data bit, see the syndrome code 111,000 indicating a single bit error in data bit D-15 in the lower right hand part of Table 1. As will be described in more detail below, the syndrome decoder 485 (FIG. 37 and FIG. 40) will cause the incorrect value of data bit 15 to be inverted (corrected).
The syndrome decoder 485 provides two functions.
First, the syndrome decoder 485 provides an input to the data bit complementer 487 (see FIG. 37) by way of the bus 493 in the case of single data bit errors , which input causes the erroneous bit to be inverted within the data bit complementer 487.
Secondly, the syndrome decoder 485 provides one of two error signals in the event of an error.
A single data or check bit error is transmitted on the SINGLE ERROR line 495 to the timing and control logic 475.
A multiple error indication is transmitted on the MULTIPLE ERROR line 497 to the timing and control logic 475.
A MULTIPLE ERROR signal is generated in the case of all double bit errors and most three or more bit errors. This MULTIPLE ERROR signal, as noted above, causes an interrupt to the CPU 105 (see FIG. 34).
The construction of the syndrome decoder 485 is shown in detail in FIG. 40. The syndrome decoder 485 comprises a decoder 507, a six bit parity tree 509 and error identification logic 511.
The decoder 507 decodes five of the six syndrome bits (bits S1 through S5) to provide sufficient information (thirty-two outputs) to generate both the error types (whether single errors or double or multiple errors) and the sixteen output lines required for inversion of data bit errors in the sixteen data bits. These sixteen output lines required for inversion of data bit errors are indicated generally by the bus 493 and are identified individually by T0 through T15 in FIG. 40.
The decoder 507 outputs which are not connected to the OR gate 512 correspond to errors in the six check bits. Errors in the six check bits do not need to be corrected (since the errors are not data bit errors), and these outputs of the decoder are therefore not used.
The remaining outputs (the outputs connected to the OR gate 512) represent double or multiple errors and are so indicated by the legends in FIG. 40. All of these cases are collected by the OR gate 512 and are one component of the multiple error signal on the line 497 at the output of the error identification logic 511.
As also illustrated in FIG. 40, the syndrome decoder 45 includes a parity tree 509 which forms the modulo-two sum of syndrome bits S0 through S5.
The resulting even or odd output of the parity tree 509 corresponds to the error classes shown at the bottom of Table 1.
Thus, the EVEN output 514 corresponds to syndromes containing no bits on, two bits on, four bits on, or six bits on.
The EVEN syndrome corresponding to no bits on (no error) is excluded from the MULTIPLE ERROR output signal 497 by an AND gate 515 which excludes the zero syndrome case (the other input from decoder 507 to the gate 515).
Syndromes containing two bits on, four bits on or six bits on are thus the only remaining EVEN syndromes which in combination with the MULTIPLE signal constitute multiple errors as transmitted on the output line MULTIPLE ERROR (497).
An output is desired on the SINGLE ERROR indicator line 495 only for single bit errors. Since the odd output on the line 510 of the parity tree 509 corresponds to one bit on (check bit error), three bits on (data bit error or multibit errors), or five bits on (multibit errors) in the six-bit syndrome (as indicated in the summary at the bottom of Table 1), the odd output on line 510 must be qualified so that only single bit errors are transmitted through the logic 511 to the line 495. Those three-bit syndrome codes corresponding to multibit errors and all of the five-bit syndrome codes must therefore be excluded so that only the single bit errors are transmitted on the line 495. This is accomplished by an inverter 517 and an AND gate 519.
A SINGLE ERROR output is generated on the line 495 for syndrome codes containing a single one bit (check bit errors) and also for those syndrome codes containing three one bits corresponding to data bit errors. As noted above, the odd output of the parity tree 509 indicates syndromes containing one, three or five bits on. The inverter 517 and the AND gate 519 exclude multiple error three bit syndromes and all five bit syndromes. Thus, the SINGLE ERROR output 495 includes only single check bit errors and single data bit errors. Single check bit errors do not need to be corrected, and single data bit errors are corrected by the bit complementer 487.
The logic equations for MULTIPLE ERROR and for SINGLE ERROR listed on the bottom of FIG. 40 represent the operation described above.
There are some errors of three or more bits which are not identified as multiple errors and in fact can be incorrectly identified as no errors or as single bit errors (correctable errors). However, the normal pattern of error generation is such that the deterioration of storage is normally detected before three bit errors occur. For example, the normal pattern of deterioration of memory storage would first involve a single bit error from noise or component failure, then would later involve a double bit error from additional failure, etc.; and the double bit errors would be detected before the three or more bit errors could develop.
The function of the data bit complementer 487 (see FIG. 37) is to invert data bit errors as detected by the syndrome decoder 485.
FIG. 41 shows details of the construction of the bit complementer 487. As illustrated in FIG. 41, the bit complementer 487 is implemented by exclusive-or gates 513. Each of these gates 513 inverts a given data bit on a line 489 when a corresponding decoder output on a line 493 is asserted.
The corrected output is then transmitted on an output line 437 of the bit complementer 487 as the output of that physical memory module.
This completes the description of the error detection and correction system.
The memory system of the present invention provides a number of significant features.
First of all, the memory map provides four separate and distinct logical address spaces--system code, system data, user code and user data--and provides for a translation of logical addresses within these address spaces to physical addresses.
The division of logical memory into four address spaces isolates the system programs from the actions of the user programs and protects the system programs from any user errors. The division into four logical address areas also provides for a separation of code and data for both user code and data and system code and data. This provides the benefits of non-modifiable programs.
There are specific fields within each map entry for this page address translation and for other specific conditions.
One field permits translation of logical page addresses to physical page addresses.
Another field provides an absence indication. This field is an absence bit which allows implementation of a virtual memory scheme where logical pages may reside in a secondary memory.
Another field is a reference history field. This reference history field allows frequency of use information to be maintained for use by the memory manager function of the operating system to make the virtual memory scheme an efficient scheme. Frequently accessed pages are retained in primary memory, and infrequently used pages are selected for necessary overlaying.
A dirty bit field is maintained in each entry of the system data map and the user data map so that unmodified data pages can be identified. The unmodified data pages so identified are not swapped out to secondary memory because a valid copy of that data page is already present in secondary memory.
The memory system includes map memory control logic which automatically maintains the reference and dirty bit information as CPU and I/O channel accesses are made to memory.
The memory system of the present invention provides for three CPU instructions--SMAP, RMAP and AMAP--which are used by the operating system's memory manager function to maintain and to utilize information in the map.
The memory system of the present invention includes a dual port access to the memory. The memory can be accessed separately by the CPU and by the I/O channel. Accesses to memory by the I/O channel do not need to involve the CPU, and the CPU can be performing other functions during the time that an I/O data transfer is being made into or out of memory.
The operation of the dual port access to the memory also involves arbitration by the map memory control logic in the event that the CPU and the I/O channel attempt a simultaneous access to the memory. In the case of simultaneous access, the I/O channel is given priority and the CPU waits until that particular I/O channel access has completed.
Physical memory is expandible by the modular addition of physical memory modules.
The physical memory modules incorporate, in the case of semiconductor memory, error detection and correction under certain conditions. Single errors are detected and corrected so that operation of the CPU and I/O channel can be continued even in the event of a transient or permanent failure within the physical memory module. The error detection and correction system comprises a twenty-two bit word within the storage medium. Sixteen bits represent the data and six bits provide an error detection and correction check field. The six bit check field allows the detection and correction of all single errors and the detection of all double errors.
The core memory includes parity for the detection of single errors.
In the overall multiprocessor system of the present invention each processor module incorporates its own primary memory system.
Since each processor module has its own memory system, problems of shared memory in a multiprocessing system are avoided.
The problems of shared memory in a multiprocessing system include reduced memory bandwidth available to a particular processor because of contention, and this reduction of available memory bandwidth becomes more severe as additional CPU's are combined with a single shared memory.
The problems of interlocks relating to the communication between CPU's by means of areas within a shared memory are avoided by the present invention which does not include shared memory and which does, instead, provide for communication between processor modules by an interprocessor bus communication system.
An additional problem of shared memory is that a failure in the shared memory can result in simultaneous failure of some or all of the CPU's in the system. That is, in a shared memory system, a single memory failure can stop all or part of the system; but a memory failure will not stop the multiprocessor system of the present invention.
The dual port access by the CPU and the I/O channel to the memory utilizes and is permitted because of separate address registers and separate data registers to and from memory.
The CPU has a specific register (the NI register) specifically for receiving instructions from memory. This separate and specific register allows overlapped fetching of the next instruction during execution of the current instruction (which may involve the reading of data from memory). As a result, at the end of a current instruction, the next instruction can be initiated immediately without waiting for an instruction fetch.
The map is constructed to provide significantly faster access than the access to physical main memory. This provides a number of benefits in the translation of addresses through the map.
As one result, in the memory system of the present invention, the map can be rewritten in the time that the physical memory access is being accomplished.
Because the rewriting is so fast, the rewriting of the map does not increase memory cycle time.
Also, the high speed at which the map can be accessed reduces the overall time including page translation required for a memory access.
Parity is maintained and checked in the actual map storage itself. This provides immediate indication of any failure in the map storage before resulting incorrect operation in the processor module can occur.
While we have illustrated and described the preferred embodiments of our invention, it is to be understood that these are capable of variation and modification and we therefore do not wish to be limited to the precise details set forth, but desire to avail ourselves of such changes and alterations as fall within the purview of the following claims.

Claims (3)

We claim:
1. An input/output system for a multiprocessor system of the kind in which a plurality of separate processor modules are interconnected for parallel processing, each of said processor modules having a central processing unit and a memory, at least some of the processor modules having an input/output channel, said input/output system comprising,
at least one device controller for controlling the transfer of data between multiple different ones of the processor modules and a peripheral device,
multiple ports in the device controller and multiple input/output buses each for connecting each port of the device controller to a respective one of said input/output channels for access by the multiple different processor modules,
the device controller including interface common logic means for selecting one of the ports to the exclusion of the other ports in the device controller for data transfers between the peripheral device and the one processor module connected to the selected port through its associated input/output channel, and
the device controller including parity check means operably coupled to receive data transferred between the device controller and an associated one of the processor modules for starting a parity check before data on the input/output bus is gated into a register in the selected port of the device controller and for continuing the parity check for a period of time after the data has been placed into the register so that the parity is checked during a time window bracketing the period the data is gated into the register to insure that data lines of the input/output bus are not in the process of changing while data is being accepted into the register.
2. The input/output system of claim 1, wherein each of the multiple ports includes enable latch means responsive to a specific disable command for dynamically disabling the port receiving such disable command from placing any signals on the input/output bus means, and wherein the corresponding one of the plurality of separate processor modules connected to such port includes means for generating the specific disable command.
3. The input/output system of claim 2, wherein the enable latch means is configured to be unresponsive to programmatic re-enablement.
US06/727,614 1976-09-07 1985-04-29 Data error detection and device controller failure detection in an input/output system Expired - Lifetime US4672537A (en)

Priority Applications (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US06/727,614 US4672537A (en) 1976-09-07 1985-04-29 Data error detection and device controller failure detection in an input/output system
US07/052,095 US4807116A (en) 1976-09-07 1987-05-18 Interprocessor communication

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US05/721,043 US4228496A (en) 1976-09-07 1976-09-07 Multiprocessor system
US06/727,614 US4672537A (en) 1976-09-07 1985-04-29 Data error detection and device controller failure detection in an input/output system

Related Parent Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US06147123 Continuation 1980-05-06
US06543810 Continuation 1983-10-24

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US07/052,095 Division US4807116A (en) 1976-09-07 1987-05-18 Interprocessor communication

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US4672537A true US4672537A (en) 1987-06-09

Family

ID=24896297

Family Applications (10)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US05/721,043 Expired - Lifetime US4228496A (en) 1976-09-07 1976-09-07 Multiprocessor system
US06/147,305 Expired - Lifetime US4356550A (en) 1976-09-07 1980-05-06 Multiprocessor system
US06/147,091 Expired - Lifetime US4378588A (en) 1976-09-07 1980-05-06 Buffer control for a data path system
US06/147,135 Expired - Lifetime US4639864A (en) 1976-09-07 1980-05-06 Power interlock system and method for use with multiprocessor systems
US06/147,309 Expired - Lifetime US4365295A (en) 1976-09-07 1980-05-06 Multiprocessor system
US06/504,596 Expired - Lifetime US4484275A (en) 1976-09-07 1983-06-17 Multiprocessor system
US06/713,583 Expired - Lifetime US4672535A (en) 1976-09-07 1985-03-18 Multiprocessor system
US06/727,614 Expired - Lifetime US4672537A (en) 1976-09-07 1985-04-29 Data error detection and device controller failure detection in an input/output system
US07/052,095 Expired - Lifetime US4807116A (en) 1976-09-07 1987-05-18 Interprocessor communication
US07/052,094 Expired - Lifetime US4817091A (en) 1976-09-07 1987-05-19 Fault-tolerant multiprocessor system

Family Applications Before (7)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US05/721,043 Expired - Lifetime US4228496A (en) 1976-09-07 1976-09-07 Multiprocessor system
US06/147,305 Expired - Lifetime US4356550A (en) 1976-09-07 1980-05-06 Multiprocessor system
US06/147,091 Expired - Lifetime US4378588A (en) 1976-09-07 1980-05-06 Buffer control for a data path system
US06/147,135 Expired - Lifetime US4639864A (en) 1976-09-07 1980-05-06 Power interlock system and method for use with multiprocessor systems
US06/147,309 Expired - Lifetime US4365295A (en) 1976-09-07 1980-05-06 Multiprocessor system
US06/504,596 Expired - Lifetime US4484275A (en) 1976-09-07 1983-06-17 Multiprocessor system
US06/713,583 Expired - Lifetime US4672535A (en) 1976-09-07 1985-03-18 Multiprocessor system

Family Applications After (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US07/052,095 Expired - Lifetime US4807116A (en) 1976-09-07 1987-05-18 Interprocessor communication
US07/052,094 Expired - Lifetime US4817091A (en) 1976-09-07 1987-05-19 Fault-tolerant multiprocessor system

Country Status (9)

Country Link
US (10) US4228496A (en)
JP (10) JPS5925257B2 (en)
BE (1) BE892627Q (en)
CA (1) CA1121481A (en)
DE (1) DE2740056A1 (en)
FR (4) FR2473197B1 (en)
GB (5) GB1588806A (en)
HK (5) HK62381A (en)
MY (5) MY8200207A (en)

Cited By (48)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4855899A (en) * 1987-04-13 1989-08-08 Prime Computer, Inc. Multiple I/O bus virtual broadcast of programmed I/O instructions
US4872106A (en) * 1983-04-06 1989-10-03 New Forney Corp. Industrial process control system with back-up data processors to take over from failed primary data processors
US4885699A (en) * 1986-12-26 1989-12-05 Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba Data processing apparatus for editing, filing, and printing image data by means of visual observation of the data on a display screen
US5023774A (en) * 1987-11-13 1991-06-11 Hitachi Software Engineering Co., Ltd. Data I/O transaction method and system
US5097410A (en) * 1988-12-30 1992-03-17 International Business Machines Corporation Multimode data system for transferring control and data information in an i/o subsystem
US5136500A (en) * 1987-02-27 1992-08-04 Honeywell Information Systems Inc. Multiple shared memory arrangement wherein multiple processors individually and concurrently access any one of plural memories
US5157595A (en) * 1985-07-19 1992-10-20 El Paso Technologies, Company Distributed logic control system and method
US5287483A (en) * 1988-07-06 1994-02-15 Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba Prefetched operand storing system for an information processor
US5303351A (en) * 1988-12-30 1994-04-12 International Business Machines Corporation Error recovery in a multiple 170 channel computer system
US5434997A (en) * 1992-10-02 1995-07-18 Compaq Computer Corp. Method and apparatus for testing and debugging a tightly coupled mirrored processing system
US5471586A (en) * 1992-09-22 1995-11-28 Unisys Corporation Interface system having plurality of channels and associated independent controllers for transferring data between shared buffer and peripheral devices independently
US5548743A (en) * 1990-05-18 1996-08-20 Fujitsu Limited Data processing system with duplex common memory having physical and logical path disconnection upon failure
US5603049A (en) * 1981-01-05 1997-02-11 Texas Instruments Incorporated Bus system servicing plural module requestors with module access identification known to system user
US5717852A (en) * 1993-03-10 1998-02-10 Hitachi, Ltd. Multiple bus control method and a system thereof
US5784394A (en) * 1996-11-15 1998-07-21 International Business Machines Corporation Method and system for implementing parity error recovery schemes in a data processing system
US6330701B1 (en) * 1997-12-10 2001-12-11 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Method relating to processors, and processors adapted to function in accordance with the method
US20030091002A1 (en) * 2001-11-09 2003-05-15 Adc Dsl Systems, Inc. Hardware controller and monitor
US6594735B1 (en) 1998-12-28 2003-07-15 Nortel Networks Limited High availability computing system
DE10249592A1 (en) * 2002-10-24 2004-06-17 Abb Research Ltd. Fail-silent data processing node configuration design for a replicated data network, whereby each partial node only transmits if all other partial nodes transmit at the same time
US6807514B2 (en) * 2000-07-27 2004-10-19 Infineon Technologies Ag Apparatus for monitoring the proper operation of components of an electrical system carrying out the same or mutually corresponding actions
US20040230861A1 (en) * 2003-05-15 2004-11-18 International Business Machines Corporation Autonomic recovery from hardware errors in an input/output fabric
US20040244011A1 (en) * 2000-11-30 2004-12-02 Microsoft Corporation Operating system event tracker
US20060279264A1 (en) * 2005-03-31 2006-12-14 O2Micro International Limited Method Circuitry and Electronic Device for Controlling a Variable Output DC Power Source
US20070050582A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Multi-voltage synchronous systems
US20070050608A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporatin Of The State Of Delaware Hardware-generated and historically-based execution optimization
US20070050555A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Multiprocessor resource optimization
US20070050558A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Bran Ferren Multiprocessor resource optimization
US20070050660A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Handling processor computational errors
US20070050556A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Multiprocessor resource optimization
US20070050609A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc Cross-architecture execution optimization
US20070050605A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Bran Ferren Freeze-dried ghost pages
US20070050776A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Predictive processor resource management
US20070050672A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Power consumption management
US20070055848A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-08 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Processor resource management
US20070067611A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-22 Bran Ferren Processor resource management
US20090076628A1 (en) * 2007-09-18 2009-03-19 David Mark Smith Methods and apparatus to upgrade and provide control redundancy in process plants
US20090132853A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2009-05-21 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Hardware-error tolerant computing
US20090150713A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2009-06-11 William Henry Mangione-Smith Multi-voltage synchronous systems
US20100174967A1 (en) * 2009-01-07 2010-07-08 Hitachi, Ltd. Control apparatus and control method
US7779213B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2010-08-17 The Invention Science Fund I, Inc Optimization of instruction group execution through hardware resource management policies
US20100228402A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2010-09-09 William Henry Mangione-Smith Power sparing synchronous apparatus
US8209524B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2012-06-26 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Cross-architecture optimization
US8443230B1 (en) * 2010-12-15 2013-05-14 Xilinx, Inc. Methods and systems with transaction-level lockstep
FR3010540A1 (en) * 2013-09-10 2015-03-13 Schneider Electric Ind Sas AUTOMATION SYSTEM COMPRISING MULTIPLE PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLERS CONNECTED ON A COMMUNICATION NETWORK
US20170345233A1 (en) * 2016-05-25 2017-11-30 Caterpillar Inc. Model generation and monitoring system for a machine
US9984182B2 (en) * 2016-05-25 2018-05-29 Caterpillar Inc. Model generation system for a machine
US10528413B2 (en) 2017-04-03 2020-01-07 Intel Corporation Criticality-based error detection
CN111274237A (en) * 2020-01-20 2020-06-12 重庆亚德科技股份有限公司 Medical data checking and correcting system and method

Families Citing this family (800)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JPS52123137A (en) * 1976-04-09 1977-10-17 Hitachi Ltd Duplication memory control unit
JPS5619575A (en) * 1979-07-25 1981-02-24 Fujitsu Ltd Data processing system having hierarchy memory
WO1981001066A1 (en) * 1979-10-11 1981-04-16 Nanodata Computer Corp Data processing system
US4516199A (en) * 1979-10-11 1985-05-07 Nanodata Computer Corporation Data processing system
US4527237A (en) * 1979-10-11 1985-07-02 Nanodata Computer Corporation Data processing system
US4491916A (en) * 1979-11-05 1985-01-01 Litton Resources Systems, Inc. Large volume, high speed data processor
US4318173A (en) * 1980-02-05 1982-03-02 The Bendix Corporation Scheduler for a multiple computer system
US4333144A (en) * 1980-02-05 1982-06-01 The Bendix Corporation Task communicator for multiple computer system
US4323966A (en) * 1980-02-05 1982-04-06 The Bendix Corporation Operations controller for a fault-tolerant multiple computer system
US4383300A (en) * 1980-04-04 1983-05-10 The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Navy Multiple scanivalve control device
US4527236A (en) * 1980-04-04 1985-07-02 Digital Equipment Corporation Communications device for data processing system
NL8002787A (en) * 1980-05-14 1981-12-16 Philips Nv MULTIPROCESSOR CALCULATOR SYSTEM FOR PERFORMING A RECURSIVE ALGORITHME.
US4363096A (en) * 1980-06-26 1982-12-07 Gte Automatic Electric Labs Inc. Arbitration controller providing for access of a common resource by a duplex plurality of central processing units
US4374414A (en) * 1980-06-26 1983-02-15 Gte Automatic Electric Labs Inc. Arbitration controller providing for access of a common resource by a duplex plurality of central processing units
US4374413A (en) * 1980-06-26 1983-02-15 Gte Automatic Electric Labs Inc. Arbitration controller providing for access of a common resource by a plurality of central processing units
US4376975A (en) * 1980-06-26 1983-03-15 Gte Automatic Electric Labs Inc. Arbitration controller providing for access of a common resource by a plurality of central processing units
US4412281A (en) * 1980-07-11 1983-10-25 Raytheon Company Distributed signal processing system
US4468738A (en) * 1980-07-16 1984-08-28 Ford Aerospace & Communications Corporation Bus access arbitration using unitary arithmetic resolution logic and unique logical addresses of competing processors
FR2490434B1 (en) * 1980-09-12 1988-03-18 Quinquis Jean Paul DEVICE FOR RESOLVING CONFLICTS OF ACCESS AND ALLOCATION OF A BUS-TYPE LINK INTERCONNECTING A SET OF NON-HIERARCHISED PROCESSORS
CH651950A5 (en) * 1980-10-20 1985-10-15 Inventio Ag MULTIPROCESSOR ARRANGEMENT.
US4378594A (en) * 1980-10-24 1983-03-29 Ncr Corporation High speed to low speed data buffering means
US4433374A (en) * 1980-11-14 1984-02-21 Sperry Corporation Cache/disk subsystem with cache bypass
US4446514A (en) * 1980-12-17 1984-05-01 Texas Instruments Incorporated Multiple register digital processor system with shared and independent input and output interface
US4520441A (en) * 1980-12-15 1985-05-28 Hitachi, Ltd. Data processing system
FR2497373B1 (en) * 1980-12-30 1986-09-05 Bull Sa MICROPROGRAMMABLE POWER SUPPLY SYSTEM FOR A DATA PROCESSING SYSTEM HAVING A SERVICE PANEL FOR MAINTENANCE OPERATIONS AND METHODS OF OPERATING THIS SERVICE PANEL
USRE37496E1 (en) * 1981-01-21 2002-01-01 Hitachi, Ltd Method of executing a job
JPS57121750A (en) * 1981-01-21 1982-07-29 Hitachi Ltd Work processing method of information processing system
US4435762A (en) 1981-03-06 1984-03-06 International Business Machines Corporation Buffered peripheral subsystems
JPS57153359A (en) * 1981-03-18 1982-09-21 Ibm Data processing system with common memory
AU551032B2 (en) * 1981-03-31 1986-04-17 British Telecommunications Public Limited Company Safety arrangement in computer control system
US4814979A (en) * 1981-04-01 1989-03-21 Teradata Corporation Network to transmit prioritized subtask pockets to dedicated processors
US4445171A (en) * 1981-04-01 1984-04-24 Teradata Corporation Data processing systems and methods
US4493021A (en) * 1981-04-03 1985-01-08 The United States Of America As Represented By The Administrator Of The National Aeronautics And Space Administration Multicomputer communication system
US4493024A (en) * 1981-05-22 1985-01-08 Data General Corporation Digital data processing system
US4455602A (en) * 1981-05-22 1984-06-19 Data General Corporation Digital data processing system having an I/O means using unique address providing and access priority control techniques
US4419728A (en) * 1981-06-22 1983-12-06 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated Channel interface circuit providing virtual channel number translation and direct memory access
US4453213A (en) * 1981-07-30 1984-06-05 Harris Corporation Error reporting scheme
US4590551A (en) * 1981-08-24 1986-05-20 Burroughs Corporation Memory control circuit for subsystem controller
US4438494A (en) 1981-08-25 1984-03-20 Intel Corporation Apparatus of fault-handling in a multiprocessing system
JPS5846428A (en) * 1981-09-11 1983-03-17 Sharp Corp Processing system for power failure protection of document editing device
EP0088789B1 (en) * 1981-09-18 1987-08-05 CHRISTIAN ROVSING A/S af 1984 Multiprocessor computer system
US4482950A (en) * 1981-09-24 1984-11-13 Dshkhunian Valery Single-chip microcomputer
ATE25779T1 (en) * 1981-10-01 1987-03-15 Stratus Computer Inc DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING SYSTEM WITH RELIABILITY BUS PROTOCOL.
US4486826A (en) * 1981-10-01 1984-12-04 Stratus Computer, Inc. Computer peripheral control apparatus
US4926315A (en) * 1981-10-01 1990-05-15 Stratus Computer, Inc. Digital data processor with fault tolerant peripheral bus communications
US4597084A (en) * 1981-10-01 1986-06-24 Stratus Computer, Inc. Computer memory apparatus
US4866604A (en) * 1981-10-01 1989-09-12 Stratus Computer, Inc. Digital data processing apparatus with pipelined memory cycles
AU560352B2 (en) * 1981-10-05 1987-04-02 Digital Equipment Corporation Secondary storage facility employing serial communications between drive and controller
US4811279A (en) * 1981-10-05 1989-03-07 Digital Equipment Corporation Secondary storage facility employing serial communications between drive and controller
US4811278A (en) * 1981-10-05 1989-03-07 Bean Robert G Secondary storage facility employing serial communications between drive and controller
US4825406A (en) * 1981-10-05 1989-04-25 Digital Equipment Corporation Secondary storage facility employing serial communications between drive and controller
US4837675A (en) * 1981-10-05 1989-06-06 Digital Equipment Corporation Secondary storage facility empolying serial communications between drive and controller
US4495567A (en) * 1981-10-15 1985-01-22 Codex Corporation Multiprocessor/multimemory control system
JPS5868109A (en) * 1981-10-17 1983-04-22 Toshiba Mach Co Ltd Programmable sequential controller with function expansibility
EP0176712B1 (en) * 1981-10-22 1991-01-02 Nec Corporation Data-processing system comprising a host processor and data-driven modules
US4482951A (en) * 1981-11-12 1984-11-13 Hughes Aircraft Company Direct memory access method for use with a multiplexed data bus
JPS5884308A (en) * 1981-11-16 1983-05-20 Toshiba Mach Co Ltd Programmable sequence controller
US4488256A (en) * 1981-11-23 1984-12-11 Motorola, Inc. Memory management unit having means for detecting and preventing mapping conflicts
US4473878A (en) * 1981-11-23 1984-09-25 Motorola, Inc. Memory management unit
US4477871A (en) * 1981-11-23 1984-10-16 Motorola, Inc. Global operation coordination method and circuit
US4476526A (en) * 1981-11-27 1984-10-09 Storage Technology Corporation Cache buffered memory subsystem
US4608689A (en) * 1981-12-04 1986-08-26 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Data processing and transfer apparatus
US4476527A (en) * 1981-12-10 1984-10-09 Data General Corporation Synchronous data bus with automatically variable data rate
US4543627A (en) * 1981-12-14 1985-09-24 At&T Bell Laboratories Internal communication arrangement for a multiprocessor system
US4480307A (en) * 1982-01-04 1984-10-30 Intel Corporation Interface for use between a memory and components of a module switching apparatus
IL67664A (en) * 1982-01-19 1987-01-30 Tandem Computers Inc Computer memory system with data,address and operation error detection
US4672609A (en) * 1982-01-19 1987-06-09 Tandem Computers Incorporated Memory system with operation error detection
US4472712A (en) * 1982-03-05 1984-09-18 At&T Bell Laboratories Multipoint data communication system with local arbitration
US4464658A (en) * 1982-03-05 1984-08-07 At&T Laboratories Multipoint data communication system with collision detection
DE3215080A1 (en) * 1982-04-22 1983-10-27 Siemens AG, 1000 Berlin und 8000 München ARRANGEMENT FOR COUPLING DIGITAL PROCESSING UNITS
DE3215177A1 (en) * 1982-04-23 1983-10-27 Hartmann & Braun Ag, 6000 Frankfurt MONITORING SYSTEM FOR ONE OR MULTIPLE, SIMILAR DESIGN PROCESS STATIONS
US4490785A (en) * 1982-05-07 1984-12-25 Digital Equipment Corporation Dual path bus structure for computer interconnection
JPS58221453A (en) * 1982-06-17 1983-12-23 Toshiba Corp Multi-system information processor
US4564899A (en) * 1982-09-28 1986-01-14 Elxsi I/O Channel bus
US4503534A (en) * 1982-06-30 1985-03-05 Intel Corporation Apparatus for redundant operation of modules in a multiprocessing system
EP0112912A4 (en) * 1982-06-30 1987-04-28 Elxsi I/o channel bus.
US4484272A (en) * 1982-07-14 1984-11-20 Burroughs Corporation Digital computer for executing multiple instruction sets in a simultaneous-interleaved fashion
US4628158A (en) * 1982-07-16 1986-12-09 At&T Bell Laboratories Stored program controller
FR2531550B1 (en) * 1982-08-06 1987-09-25 Ozil Maurice UNIVERSAL COUPLING DEVICE FOR THE COMMUNICATION OF INFORMATION PROCESSING ASSEMBLIES AND AT LEAST ONE PERIPHERAL UNIT
JPS5935209A (en) * 1982-08-20 1984-02-25 Koyo Denshi Kogyo Kk Sequence controller
US4539637A (en) * 1982-08-26 1985-09-03 At&T Bell Laboratories Method and apparatus for handling interprocessor calls in a multiprocessor system
US4484308A (en) * 1982-09-23 1984-11-20 Motorola, Inc. Serial data mode circuit for a memory
US4527157A (en) * 1982-09-30 1985-07-02 Gte Automatic Electric Inc. Single fault tolerant CCIS data link arrangement
US4663706A (en) * 1982-10-28 1987-05-05 Tandem Computers Incorporated Multiprocessor multisystem communications network
US4502114A (en) * 1982-10-29 1985-02-26 Gte Automatic Electric Incorporated Circuit for reliable data transfer between two central processing units
US4590554A (en) * 1982-11-23 1986-05-20 Parallel Computers Systems, Inc. Backup fault tolerant computer system
US4488228A (en) * 1982-12-03 1984-12-11 Motorola, Inc. Virtual memory data processor
EP0109981B1 (en) * 1982-12-07 1987-06-16 Ibm Deutschland Gmbh Fail-safe data processing equipment
US4524415A (en) * 1982-12-07 1985-06-18 Motorola, Inc. Virtual machine data processor
US4493035A (en) * 1982-12-07 1985-01-08 Motorola, Inc. Data processor version validation
US4819154A (en) * 1982-12-09 1989-04-04 Sequoia Systems, Inc. Memory back up system with one cache memory and two physically separated main memories
WO1984002409A1 (en) * 1982-12-09 1984-06-21 Sequoia Systems Inc Memory backup system
JPS59133624A (en) * 1983-01-20 1984-08-01 Sharp Corp Interface system
JPS59146345A (en) * 1983-02-10 1984-08-22 Masahiro Sowa Control flow parallel computer system
US4599689A (en) * 1983-02-28 1986-07-08 Data Translations, Inc. Continuous data transfer system
US4703449A (en) * 1983-02-28 1987-10-27 Data Translation Inc. Interrupt driven multi-buffer DMA circuit for enabling continuous sequential data transfers
US4604689A (en) * 1983-04-15 1986-08-05 Convergent Technologies, Inc. Bus repeater
US4571671A (en) * 1983-05-13 1986-02-18 International Business Machines Corporation Data processor having multiple-buffer adapter between a system channel and an input/output bus
US4733366A (en) * 1983-05-16 1988-03-22 Data General Corporation Apparatus for providing an interrupt signal in response to a permanent or transient power failure
US4593350A (en) * 1983-05-25 1986-06-03 Rca Corporation Distributed processor with periodic data transfer from each memory to like addresses of all other memories
US5224124A (en) * 1983-06-16 1993-06-29 Hitachi, Ltd. Data transmission system
US4577272A (en) * 1983-06-27 1986-03-18 E-Systems, Inc. Fault tolerant and load sharing processing system
US4587609A (en) * 1983-07-01 1986-05-06 Honeywell Information Systems Inc. Lockout operation among asynchronous accessers of a shared computer system resource
US4549274A (en) * 1983-07-11 1985-10-22 Honeywell Inc. Distributed electric power demand control
US4591975A (en) * 1983-07-18 1986-05-27 Data General Corporation Data processing system having dual processors
US4868741A (en) * 1983-07-22 1989-09-19 Texas Instruments Incorporated Computer bus deadlock prevention
US4858111A (en) * 1983-07-29 1989-08-15 Hewlett-Packard Company Write-back cache system using concurrent address transfers to setup requested address in main memory before dirty miss signal from cache
JPS6054052A (en) * 1983-09-02 1985-03-28 Nec Corp Processing continuing system
US4493000A (en) * 1983-09-30 1985-01-08 Magnetic Peripherals Incorporated Power on/off protect circuit
US4649384A (en) * 1983-10-07 1987-03-10 Dialogic Systems Corp. Method and apparatus for fault tolerant serial communication of digital information
US4875154A (en) * 1983-10-13 1989-10-17 Mitchell Maurice E Microcomputer with disconnected, open, independent, bimemory architecture, allowing large interacting, interconnected multi-microcomputer parallel systems accomodating multiple levels of programmer defined heirarchy
US4583222A (en) * 1983-11-07 1986-04-15 Digital Equipment Corporation Method and apparatus for self-testing of floating point accelerator processors
US4860244A (en) * 1983-11-07 1989-08-22 Digital Equipment Corporation Buffer system for input/output portion of digital data processing system
US4639891A (en) * 1983-11-14 1987-01-27 Digital Equipment Corporation Signals path control circuitry for a data terminal
US4608688A (en) * 1983-12-27 1986-08-26 At&T Bell Laboratories Processing system tolerant of loss of access to secondary storage
US4881164A (en) * 1983-12-30 1989-11-14 International Business Machines Corporation Multi-microprocessor for controlling shared memory
NL8400186A (en) * 1984-01-20 1985-08-16 Philips Nv PROCESSOR SYSTEM CONTAINING A NUMBER OF STATIONS CONNECTED BY A COMMUNICATION NETWORK AND STATION FOR USE IN SUCH A PROCESSOR SYSTEM.
US5581732A (en) * 1984-03-10 1996-12-03 Encore Computer, U.S., Inc. Multiprocessor system with reflective memory data transfer device
GB2156554B (en) * 1984-03-10 1987-07-29 Rediffusion Simulation Ltd Processing system with shared data
US5255369A (en) * 1984-03-10 1993-10-19 Encore Computer U.S., Inc. Multiprocessor system with reflective memory data transfer device
US4821174A (en) * 1984-03-20 1989-04-11 Westinghouse Electric Corp. Signal processing system including a bus control module
US4633394A (en) * 1984-04-24 1986-12-30 International Business Machines Corp. Distributed arbitration for multiple processors
US4905145A (en) * 1984-05-17 1990-02-27 Texas Instruments Incorporated Multiprocessor
US4704599A (en) * 1984-06-20 1987-11-03 Kimmel Arthur T Auxiliary power connector and communication channel control circuit
DE3424587A1 (en) * 1984-07-04 1986-01-09 Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag, 7000 Stuttgart CIRCUIT ARRANGEMENT FOR CONTROLLING THE BIDIRECTIONAL DATA TRANSMISSION BETWEEN A COMPUTER UNIT AND TRANSMISSION LINKS CONNECTED BY INPUT / OUTPUT UNITS
US4669056A (en) * 1984-07-31 1987-05-26 International Business Machines Corporation Data processing system with a plurality of processors accessing a common bus to interleaved storage
US4688168A (en) * 1984-08-23 1987-08-18 Picker International Inc. High speed data transfer method and apparatus
JPS6194433A (en) * 1984-10-15 1986-05-13 Mitsubishi Electric Corp Control system for serial bus
US4754394A (en) * 1984-10-24 1988-06-28 International Business Machines Corporation Multiprocessing system having dynamically allocated local/global storage and including interleaving transformation circuit for transforming real addresses to corresponding absolute address of the storage
US4870704A (en) * 1984-10-31 1989-09-26 Flexible Computer Corporation Multicomputer digital processing system
US4697232A (en) * 1984-11-30 1987-09-29 Storage Technology Corporation I/O device reconnection in a multiple-CPU, dynamic path allocation environment
US4692894A (en) * 1984-12-18 1987-09-08 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. Overflow/Underflow detection for elastic buffer
DE3508048A1 (en) * 1985-03-07 1986-09-11 Standard Elektrik Lorenz Ag, 7000 Stuttgart INTERFACE DEVICE
US4967344A (en) * 1985-03-26 1990-10-30 Codex Corporation Interconnection network for multiple processors
US4752928A (en) * 1985-05-06 1988-06-21 Tektronix, Inc. Transaction analyzer
AU568977B2 (en) 1985-05-10 1988-01-14 Tandem Computers Inc. Dual processor error detection system
US5101478A (en) * 1985-06-28 1992-03-31 Wang Laboratories, Inc. I/O structure for information processing system
JPS623366A (en) * 1985-06-28 1987-01-09 Toshiba Corp Multi-processor system
JPH0752876B2 (en) * 1985-07-20 1995-06-05 ソニー株式会社 Internal bus type digital device
JPH067380B2 (en) * 1985-08-30 1994-01-26 株式会社日立製作所 Multiprocessor system
US4787028A (en) * 1985-09-03 1988-11-22 Ncr Corporation Multicommunication protocol controller
US4700330A (en) * 1985-10-30 1987-10-13 Digital Equipment Corporation Memory for a digital data processing system including circuit for controlling refresh operations during power-up and power-down conditions
US4783732A (en) * 1985-12-12 1988-11-08 Itt Corporation Two-wire/three-port RAM for cellular array processor
US4736339A (en) * 1985-12-16 1988-04-05 Gte Communication Systems Corporation Circuit for simplex I/O terminal control by duplex processors
US4979108A (en) * 1985-12-20 1990-12-18 Ag Communication Systems Corporation Task synchronization arrangement and method for remote duplex processors
JPS62210436A (en) * 1986-03-11 1987-09-16 Minolta Camera Co Ltd Data transmitting device for camera
US4746920A (en) * 1986-03-28 1988-05-24 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method and apparatus for clock management
US5151999A (en) * 1986-03-31 1992-09-29 Wang Laboratories, Inc. Serial communications controller for transfer of successive data frames with storage of supplemental data and word counts
GB2189168B (en) 1986-04-21 1989-11-29 Aligena Ag Composite membranes useful in the separation of low molecular weight organic compounds from aqueous solutions containing inorganic salts
US4920481A (en) * 1986-04-28 1990-04-24 Xerox Corporation Emulation with display update trapping
US5113517A (en) * 1986-04-28 1992-05-12 Xerox Corporation Concurrent display of data from two different processors each having different display font and user interface for controlling transfer of converted font data therebetween
US4939507A (en) * 1986-04-28 1990-07-03 Xerox Corporation Virtual and emulated objects for use in the user interface of a display screen of a display processor
US4937036A (en) * 1986-04-28 1990-06-26 Xerox Corporation Concurrent display of data from two different display processors and user interface therefore
US5088033A (en) * 1986-04-28 1992-02-11 Xerox Corporation Data processing system emulation in a window with a coprocessor and I/O emulation
US5153577A (en) * 1986-04-28 1992-10-06 Xerox Corporation Mapping character color attributes into grey pixel patterns
US4899136A (en) * 1986-04-28 1990-02-06 Xerox Corporation Data processor having a user interface display with metaphoric objects
US4860193A (en) * 1986-05-22 1989-08-22 International Business Machines Corporation System for efficiently transferring data between a high speed channel and a low speed I/O device
US5301322A (en) * 1986-05-23 1994-04-05 Hitachi, Ltd. System for converting job/process identifiers into processor/process identifiers in transferring data between processes in a multiprocessor system
US4835674A (en) * 1986-07-28 1989-05-30 Bull Hn Information Systems Inc. Computer network system for multiple processing elements
US4819159A (en) * 1986-08-29 1989-04-04 Tolerant Systems, Inc. Distributed multiprocess transaction processing system and method
US4951193A (en) * 1986-09-05 1990-08-21 Hitachi, Ltd. Parallel computer with distributed shared memories and distributed task activating circuits
US4791641A (en) * 1986-09-15 1988-12-13 Thinking Machines Corporation Parallel processor error checking
EP0260392A3 (en) * 1986-09-19 1992-03-11 International Business Machines Corporation An input output interface controller connecting a synchronous bus to an asynchronous bus and methods for performing operations on the buses
GB2196762B (en) * 1986-10-27 1990-12-19 Burr Brown Ltd Interleaved access to global memory by high priority source
US4933836A (en) * 1986-10-29 1990-06-12 United Technologies Corporation n-Dimensional modular multiprocessor lattice architecture
US4816990A (en) * 1986-11-05 1989-03-28 Stratus Computer, Inc. Method and apparatus for fault-tolerant computer system having expandable processor section
US5146575A (en) * 1986-11-05 1992-09-08 International Business Machines Corp. Implementing privilege on microprocessor systems for use in software asset protection
US4912461A (en) * 1986-11-05 1990-03-27 Cellular Control Systems Corporation Apparatus and network for transferring packets of electronic signals and associated method
US4914653A (en) * 1986-12-22 1990-04-03 American Telephone And Telegraph Company Inter-processor communication protocol
JPH0440549Y2 (en) * 1986-12-26 1992-09-22
JP2530829B2 (en) * 1987-01-16 1996-09-04 株式会社日立製作所 Direct memory access controller and data transfer method in multi-microcomputer system
US5020024A (en) * 1987-01-16 1991-05-28 Stratus Computer, Inc. Method and apparatus for detecting selected absence of digital logic synchronism
US5293597A (en) * 1987-03-09 1994-03-08 At&T Bell Laboratories Concurrent context memory management unit
US4989134A (en) * 1987-03-20 1991-01-29 Hewlett-Packard Company Method and apparatus for enhancing data storage efficiency
US5241627A (en) * 1987-04-09 1993-08-31 Tandem Computers Incorporated Automatic processor module determination for multiprocessor systems for determining a value indicating the number of processors
US5276807A (en) * 1987-04-13 1994-01-04 Emulex Corporation Bus interface synchronization circuitry for reducing time between successive data transmission in a system using an asynchronous handshaking
US4821170A (en) * 1987-04-17 1989-04-11 Tandem Computers Incorporated Input/output system for multiprocessors
US4920477A (en) * 1987-04-20 1990-04-24 Multiflow Computer, Inc. Virtual address table look aside buffer miss recovery method and apparatus
US5307506A (en) * 1987-04-20 1994-04-26 Digital Equipment Corporation High bandwidth multiple computer bus apparatus
US4933846A (en) * 1987-04-24 1990-06-12 Network Systems Corporation Network communications adapter with dual interleaved memory banks servicing multiple processors
US4805228A (en) * 1987-05-04 1989-02-14 The Johns Hopkins University Cellular logic processor
US5155857A (en) * 1987-05-29 1992-10-13 Hitachi, Ltd. Communication processing system in which communication by terminals is controlled according to a terminal management table
CA1296103C (en) * 1987-06-02 1992-02-18 Theodore Jay Goodlander High-speed, high capacity, fault-tolerant, error-correcting storage system
US5257367A (en) * 1987-06-02 1993-10-26 Cab-Tek, Inc. Data storage system with asynchronous host operating system communication link
AU605598B2 (en) * 1987-06-02 1991-01-17 Storage Computer Corporation Fault-tolerant, error-correcting storage system
US4942579A (en) * 1987-06-02 1990-07-17 Cab-Tek, Inc. High-speed, high-capacity, fault-tolerant error-correcting storage system
US5201040A (en) * 1987-06-22 1993-04-06 Hitachi, Ltd. Multiprocessor system having subsystems which are loosely coupled through a random access storage and which each include a tightly coupled multiprocessor
US5317717A (en) * 1987-07-01 1994-05-31 Digital Equipment Corp. Apparatus and method for main memory unit protection using access and fault logic signals
US5278840A (en) * 1987-07-01 1994-01-11 Digital Equipment Corporation Apparatus and method for data induced condition signalling
US5063497A (en) * 1987-07-01 1991-11-05 Digital Equipment Corporation Apparatus and method for recovering from missing page faults in vector data processing operations
US5047923A (en) * 1987-08-21 1991-09-10 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Modularly structured digital communication system for interconnecting terminal equipment and public networks
US4958273A (en) * 1987-08-26 1990-09-18 International Business Machines Corporation Multiprocessor system architecture with high availability
US4999771A (en) * 1987-08-31 1991-03-12 Control Data Corporation Communications network
US4912680A (en) * 1987-09-03 1990-03-27 Minolta Camera Kabushiki Kaisha Image memory having plural input registers and output registers to provide random and serial accesses
US4907228A (en) * 1987-09-04 1990-03-06 Digital Equipment Corporation Dual-rail processor with error checking at single rail interfaces
US5185877A (en) * 1987-09-04 1993-02-09 Digital Equipment Corporation Protocol for transfer of DMA data
CA1320276C (en) * 1987-09-04 1993-07-13 William F. Bruckert Dual rail processors with error checking on i/o reads
US4916704A (en) * 1987-09-04 1990-04-10 Digital Equipment Corporation Interface of non-fault tolerant components to fault tolerant system
EP0306244B1 (en) * 1987-09-04 1995-06-21 Digital Equipment Corporation Fault tolerant computer system with fault isolation
JPS6479841A (en) * 1987-09-22 1989-03-24 Aisin Seiki Abnormality monitoring device for microcomputer
CA1297593C (en) * 1987-10-08 1992-03-17 Stephen C. Leuty Fault tolerant ancillary messaging and recovery system and method within adigital switch
AU616213B2 (en) * 1987-11-09 1991-10-24 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method and apparatus for synchronizing a plurality of processors
US5084816A (en) * 1987-11-25 1992-01-28 Bell Communications Research, Inc. Real time fault tolerant transaction processing system
EP0323013B1 (en) * 1987-11-30 1995-08-30 International Business Machines Corporation Method of operating a multiprocessor system employing a shared virtual memory
JP2807010B2 (en) * 1988-01-27 1998-09-30 ストレイジ テクノロジー コーポレイション Tape drive control unit for interconnection between host computer and tape drive and method of operating the same
US5247692A (en) * 1988-02-08 1993-09-21 Nec Corporation Multiple file system having a plurality of file units holding the same files in which loss of data is prevented in a failure of a file unit
US5050070A (en) * 1988-02-29 1991-09-17 Convex Computer Corporation Multi-processor computer system having self-allocating processors
US5159686A (en) * 1988-02-29 1992-10-27 Convex Computer Corporation Multi-processor computer system having process-independent communication register addressing
US5113508A (en) * 1988-03-08 1992-05-12 International Business Machines Corporation Data cache initialization
US4982325A (en) * 1988-03-18 1991-01-01 At&T Bell Laboratories Applications processor module for interfacing to a database system
JPH01256843A (en) * 1988-03-25 1989-10-13 Ncr Corp Link control system
US4979100A (en) * 1988-04-01 1990-12-18 Sprint International Communications Corp. Communication processor for a packet-switched network
JPH0769882B2 (en) * 1988-05-11 1995-07-31 富士通株式会社 Input / output control system having cross-call function and dynamic configuration change method in the system
US5003464A (en) * 1988-05-23 1991-03-26 Bell Communications Research, Inc. Methods and apparatus for efficient resource allocation
US5179683A (en) * 1988-06-14 1993-01-12 Hitachi, Ltd. Retrieval apparatus including a plurality of retrieval units
US4891785A (en) * 1988-07-08 1990-01-02 Donohoo Theodore J Method for transferring data files between computers in a network response to generalized application program instructions
JPH0237422A (en) * 1988-07-28 1990-02-07 Oki Electric Ind Co Ltd Numerical management system
US5337411A (en) * 1988-10-20 1994-08-09 Westinghouse Electric Corporation Multi-processor computer system bus architecture
DE68924040T2 (en) * 1988-10-24 1996-04-18 Ibm Method for exchanging data between programs in a data processing system.
JPH0797328B2 (en) * 1988-10-25 1995-10-18 インターナシヨナル・ビジネス・マシーンズ・コーポレーシヨン False tolerant synchronization system
US5155858A (en) * 1988-10-27 1992-10-13 At&T Bell Laboratories Twin-threshold load-sharing system with each processor in a multiprocessor ring adjusting its own assigned task list based on workload threshold
JPH0833799B2 (en) * 1988-10-31 1996-03-29 富士通株式会社 Data input / output control method
US4994963A (en) * 1988-11-01 1991-02-19 Icon Systems International, Inc. System and method for sharing resources of a host computer among a plurality of remote computers
JPH02130647A (en) * 1988-11-11 1990-05-18 Toshiba Corp Updating system for index tree structure
US5123047A (en) * 1988-12-09 1992-06-16 The Exchange System Limited Partnership Method of updating encryption device monitor code in a multichannel data encryption system
US5128996A (en) * 1988-12-09 1992-07-07 The Exchange System Limited Partnership Multichannel data encryption device
US4965717A (en) * 1988-12-09 1990-10-23 Tandem Computers Incorporated Multiple processor system having shared memory with private-write capability
US4997288A (en) * 1988-12-09 1991-03-05 The Exchange System Limited Partnership Power supply arrangement for fault-tolerant operation in a microcomputer-based encryption system
US5249298A (en) * 1988-12-09 1993-09-28 Dallas Semiconductor Corporation Battery-initiated touch-sensitive power-up
AU625293B2 (en) * 1988-12-09 1992-07-09 Tandem Computers Incorporated Synchronization of fault-tolerant computer system having multiple processors
US4984240A (en) * 1988-12-22 1991-01-08 Codex Corporation Distributed switching architecture for communication module redundancy
GB2226666B (en) * 1988-12-30 1993-07-07 Intel Corp Request/response protocol
EP0378398B1 (en) * 1989-01-13 1996-07-24 International Business Machines Corporation Data processing system with means for detecting status of data processing device receiving commands
US5237676A (en) * 1989-01-13 1993-08-17 International Business Machines Corp. High speed data transfer system which adjusts data transfer speed in response to indicated transfer speed capability of connected device
DE69027788D1 (en) * 1989-01-17 1996-08-22 Landmark Graphics Corp Method for transferring data between computer programs running simultaneously
US5089958A (en) * 1989-01-23 1992-02-18 Vortex Systems, Inc. Fault tolerant computer backup system
US5148433A (en) * 1989-03-13 1992-09-15 Square D Company Transfer network interface
IT1228728B (en) * 1989-03-15 1991-07-03 Bull Hn Information Syst MULTIPROCESSOR SYSTEM WITH GLOBAL DATA REPLICATION AND TWO LEVELS OF ADDRESS TRANSLATION UNIT.
US5276818A (en) * 1989-04-24 1994-01-04 Hitachi, Ltd. Bus system for information processing system and method of controlling the same
US5283868A (en) * 1989-05-17 1994-02-01 International Business Machines Corp. Providing additional system characteristics to a data processing system through operations of an application program, transparently to the operating system
US5325517A (en) * 1989-05-17 1994-06-28 International Business Machines Corporation Fault tolerant data processing system
US5155809A (en) * 1989-05-17 1992-10-13 International Business Machines Corp. Uncoupling a central processing unit from its associated hardware for interaction with data handling apparatus alien to the operating system controlling said unit and hardware
US5113522A (en) * 1989-05-17 1992-05-12 International Business Machines Corporation Data processing system with system resource management for itself and for an associated alien processor
US5144692A (en) * 1989-05-17 1992-09-01 International Business Machines Corporation System for controlling access by first system to portion of main memory dedicated exclusively to second system to facilitate input/output processing via first system
US5369749A (en) * 1989-05-17 1994-11-29 Ibm Corporation Method and apparatus for the direct transfer of information between application programs running on distinct processors without utilizing the services of one or both operating systems
US5369767A (en) * 1989-05-17 1994-11-29 International Business Machines Corp. Servicing interrupt requests in a data processing system without using the services of an operating system
RU1777148C (en) * 1989-05-30 1992-11-23 Институт Точной Механики И Вычислительной Техники Им.С.А.Лебедева Computing system
US5353243A (en) * 1989-05-31 1994-10-04 Synopsys Inc. Hardware modeling system and method of use
JPH0314161A (en) * 1989-06-13 1991-01-22 Toshiba Corp Processor monitoring processing system
US5146574A (en) * 1989-06-27 1992-09-08 Sf2 Corporation Method and circuit for programmable selecting a variable sequence of element using write-back
FR2649224B1 (en) * 1989-06-30 1995-09-01 Nec Corp INFORMATION PROCESSING SYSTEM CAPABLE OF EASILY SUPPORTING PROCESSING OF A FAULTY PROCESSOR
US5036455A (en) * 1989-07-25 1991-07-30 Tandem Computers Incorporated Multiple power supply sensor for protecting shared processor buses
US5068780A (en) * 1989-08-01 1991-11-26 Digital Equipment Corporation Method and apparatus for controlling initiation of bootstrap loading of an operating system in a computer system having first and second discrete computing zones
US5153881A (en) * 1989-08-01 1992-10-06 Digital Equipment Corporation Method of handling errors in software
US5068851A (en) * 1989-08-01 1991-11-26 Digital Equipment Corporation Apparatus and method for documenting faults in computing modules
US5065312A (en) * 1989-08-01 1991-11-12 Digital Equipment Corporation Method of converting unique data to system data
US5163138A (en) * 1989-08-01 1992-11-10 Digital Equipment Corporation Protocol for read write transfers via switching logic by transmitting and retransmitting an address
US5048022A (en) * 1989-08-01 1991-09-10 Digital Equipment Corporation Memory device with transfer of ECC signals on time division multiplexed bidirectional lines
US5251227A (en) * 1989-08-01 1993-10-05 Digital Equipment Corporation Targeted resets in a data processor including a trace memory to store transactions
ATE139632T1 (en) * 1989-08-01 1996-07-15 Digital Equipment Corp SOFTWARE ERROR HANDLING PROCEDURES
US5347637A (en) * 1989-08-08 1994-09-13 Cray Research, Inc. Modular input/output system for supercomputers
US5159551A (en) * 1989-08-09 1992-10-27 Picker International, Inc. Prism architecture for ct scanner image reconstruction
US5133078A (en) * 1989-08-11 1992-07-21 International Business Machines Corporation Serial frame processing system in which validation and transfer of a frame's data from input buffer to output buffer proceed concurrently
US5179662A (en) * 1989-08-31 1993-01-12 International Business Machines Corporation Optimized i/o buffers having the ability to increase or decrease in size to meet system requirements
US5204951A (en) * 1989-10-02 1993-04-20 International Business Machines Corporation Apparatus and method for improving the communication efficiency between a host processor and peripheral devices connected by an scsi bus
US5212789A (en) * 1989-10-12 1993-05-18 Bell Communications Research, Inc. Method and apparatus for updating application databases used in a distributed transaction processing environment
EP0450052A1 (en) * 1989-10-17 1991-10-09 MITCHELL, Maurice E. A microcomputer with disconnected, open, independent, bimemory architecture
US5201055A (en) * 1989-11-03 1993-04-06 Compaq Computer Corporation Multiprocessing system includes interprocessor encoding and decoding logic used for communication between two cards through reduced addressing lines
DE58908975D1 (en) * 1989-11-21 1995-03-16 Itt Ind Gmbh Deutsche Two-way data transfer facility.
US5278974A (en) * 1989-12-04 1994-01-11 Digital Equipment Corporation Method and apparatus for the dynamic adjustment of data transfer timing to equalize the bandwidths of two buses in a computer system having different bandwidths
US5729708A (en) * 1989-12-04 1998-03-17 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Portable data buffer apparatus with manually controlled reception/transmission
US5687396A (en) * 1989-12-04 1997-11-11 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Data buffer apparatus with interrupted transmission/reception
KR940002905B1 (en) * 1989-12-15 1994-04-07 Ibm Apparatus for conditioning priority arbitration in buffered direct memory addressing
AU7142091A (en) * 1989-12-19 1991-07-18 E-Systems Incorporated Method and apparatus for dispersed end-entity flow control in computer networks
US5295258A (en) * 1989-12-22 1994-03-15 Tandem Computers Incorporated Fault-tolerant computer system with online recovery and reintegration of redundant components
FR2656441B1 (en) * 1989-12-22 1993-12-10 Bull Sa SECURE METHOD FOR FAST WRITING OF INFORMATION FOR MASS MEMORY DEVICE.
DE69032508T2 (en) 1989-12-22 1999-03-25 Tandem Computers Inc Fault-tolerant computer system with online reinsert and shutdown / start
US5193187A (en) * 1989-12-29 1993-03-09 Supercomputer Systems Limited Partnership Fast interrupt mechanism for interrupting processors in parallel in a multiprocessor system wherein processors are assigned process ID numbers
US5197130A (en) * 1989-12-29 1993-03-23 Supercomputer Systems Limited Partnership Cluster architecture for a highly parallel scalar/vector multiprocessor system
US5239629A (en) * 1989-12-29 1993-08-24 Supercomputer Systems Limited Partnership Dedicated centralized signaling mechanism for selectively signaling devices in a multiprocessor system
US5203004A (en) * 1990-01-08 1993-04-13 Tandem Computers Incorporated Multi-board system having electronic keying and preventing power to improperly connected plug-in board with improperly configured diode connections
US5123094A (en) * 1990-01-26 1992-06-16 Apple Computer, Inc. Interprocessor communications includes second CPU designating memory locations assigned to first CPU and writing their addresses into registers
JPH03235152A (en) * 1990-02-13 1991-10-21 Fujitsu Ltd Bus control system
KR950008837B1 (en) * 1990-03-09 1995-08-08 후지쓰 가부시끼가이샤 Control system for multiprocessor system
DE69132300T2 (en) * 1990-03-12 2000-11-30 Hewlett Packard Co Direct memory access defined by the user using virtual addresses
US5201044A (en) * 1990-04-16 1993-04-06 International Business Machines Corporation Data processing method for file status recovery includes providing a log file of atomic transactions that may span both volatile and non volatile memory
US5164944A (en) * 1990-06-08 1992-11-17 Unisys Corporation Method and apparatus for effecting multiple error correction in a computer memory
US5261077A (en) * 1990-06-29 1993-11-09 Digital Equipment Corporation Configurable data path arrangement for resolving data type incompatibility
AU630299B2 (en) * 1990-07-10 1992-10-22 Fujitsu Limited A data gathering/scattering system in a parallel computer
GB9015363D0 (en) * 1990-07-12 1990-08-29 Marconi Gec Ltd Optical networks
US5341496A (en) * 1990-08-29 1994-08-23 The Foxboro Company Apparatus and method for interfacing host computer and computer nodes using redundant gateway data lists of accessible computer node data
US5255372A (en) * 1990-08-31 1993-10-19 International Business Machines Corporation Apparatus for efficiently interconnecing channels of a multiprocessor system multiplexed via channel adapters
US5289589A (en) * 1990-09-10 1994-02-22 International Business Machines Corporation Automated storage library having redundant SCSI bus system
US5475770A (en) * 1990-09-24 1995-12-12 Cgk Computer Gesellschaft Konstanz Mbh Parallel recognition of document images with a time-elapsed processing abortion to improve overall throughput
US5255388A (en) * 1990-09-26 1993-10-19 Honeywell Inc. Synchronizing slave processors through eavesdrop by one on a write request message directed to another followed by comparison of individual status request replies
US5293377A (en) * 1990-10-05 1994-03-08 International Business Machines, Corporation Network control information without reserved bandwidth
US5339397A (en) * 1990-10-12 1994-08-16 International Business Machines Corporation Hardware primary directory lock
US6453406B1 (en) 1990-10-17 2002-09-17 Compaq Computer Corporation Multiprocessor system with fiber optic bus interconnect for interprocessor communications
JP2575557B2 (en) * 1990-11-13 1997-01-29 インターナショナル・ビジネス・マシーンズ・コーポレイション Super computer system
US5182800A (en) * 1990-11-16 1993-01-26 International Business Machines Corporation Direct memory access controller with adaptive pipelining and bus control features
US5210829A (en) * 1990-12-12 1993-05-11 Digital Equipment Corporation Adjustable threshold for buffer management
CA2059143C (en) 1991-01-25 2000-05-16 Takeshi Miyao Processing unit for a computer and a computer system incorporating such a processing unit
US5537624A (en) * 1991-02-12 1996-07-16 The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Navy Data repacking circuit having toggle buffer for transferring digital data from P1Q1 bus width to P2Q2 bus width
US5481707A (en) * 1991-05-19 1996-01-02 Unisys Corporation Dedicated processor for task I/O and memory management
US5297282A (en) * 1991-05-29 1994-03-22 Toshiba America Information Systems, Inc. Resume processing function for the OS/2 operating system
US5355490A (en) * 1991-06-14 1994-10-11 Toshiba America Information Systems, Inc. System and method for saving the state for advanced microprocessor operating modes
EP0528538B1 (en) * 1991-07-18 1998-12-23 Tandem Computers Incorporated Mirrored memory multi processor system
GB2258069B (en) * 1991-07-25 1995-03-29 Intel Corp High speed computer graphics bus
WO1993003439A1 (en) * 1991-07-26 1993-02-18 Tandem Computers Incorporated Apparatus and method for frame switching
US5454082A (en) * 1991-09-18 1995-09-26 Ncr Corporation System for preventing an unselected controller from transferring data via a first bus while concurrently permitting it to transfer data via a second bus
US5237658A (en) * 1991-10-01 1993-08-17 Tandem Computers Incorporated Linear and orthogonal expansion of array storage in multiprocessor computing systems
US5758052A (en) * 1991-10-02 1998-05-26 International Business Machines Corporation Network management method using redundant distributed control processors
AU2656892A (en) * 1991-10-04 1993-05-03 Wellfleet Communications, Inc. Method and apparatus for concurrent packet bus
GB2260631B (en) * 1991-10-17 1995-06-28 Intel Corp Microprocessor 2X core design
US5935253A (en) * 1991-10-17 1999-08-10 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for powering down an integrated circuit having a core that operates at a speed greater than the bus frequency
US5842029A (en) * 1991-10-17 1998-11-24 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for powering down an integrated circuit transparently and its phase locked loop
WO1993009494A1 (en) * 1991-10-28 1993-05-13 Digital Equipment Corporation Fault-tolerant computer processing using a shadow virtual processor
DE69230093T2 (en) * 1991-11-19 2000-04-13 Ibm Multiprocessor system
EP0544279B1 (en) * 1991-11-27 1999-10-13 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Reproducing apparatus
US5708784A (en) * 1991-11-27 1998-01-13 Emc Corporation Dual bus computer architecture utilizing distributed arbitrators and method of using same
US5297287A (en) * 1992-03-02 1994-03-22 S-Mos Systems, Incorporated System and method for resetting a microprocessor system
GB2264794B (en) * 1992-03-06 1995-09-20 Intel Corp Method and apparatus for automatic power management in a high integration floppy disk controller
WO1993018456A1 (en) * 1992-03-13 1993-09-16 Emc Corporation Multiple controller sharing in a redundant storage array
US5317751A (en) * 1992-03-18 1994-05-31 Aeg Westinghouse Transportation Systems, Inc. Method and apparatus for placing a trainline monitor system in a layup mode
US6794060B2 (en) 1992-03-27 2004-09-21 The Louis Berkman Company Corrosion-resistant coated metal and method for making the same
US5428769A (en) * 1992-03-31 1995-06-27 The Dow Chemical Company Process control interface system having triply redundant remote field units
US5506964A (en) * 1992-04-16 1996-04-09 International Business Machines Corporation System with multiple interface logic circuits including arbitration logic for individually linking multiple processing systems to at least one remote sub-system
US5434870A (en) * 1992-04-17 1995-07-18 Unisys Corporation Apparatus and method for verifying the authenticity of a circuit board
US5493663A (en) * 1992-04-22 1996-02-20 International Business Machines Corporation Method and apparatus for predetermining pages for swapping from physical memory in accordance with the number of accesses
JPH05314075A (en) * 1992-05-07 1993-11-26 Nec Corp On-line computer system
US5325363A (en) * 1992-05-11 1994-06-28 Tandem Computers Incorporated Fault tolerant power supply for an array of storage devices
US6134655A (en) * 1992-05-13 2000-10-17 Comverge Technologies, Inc. Method and apparatus for initializing a microprocessor to insure fault-free operation
US6435737B1 (en) * 1992-06-30 2002-08-20 Discovision Associates Data pipeline system and data encoding method
EP0582535A1 (en) * 1992-07-07 1994-02-09 International Business Machines Corporation Communication system and method utilizing picoprocessors for performing complex functions out of main communication data path
JP2952112B2 (en) * 1992-07-15 1999-09-20 株式会社日立製作所 Multi-wire fieldbus system
EP0596144A1 (en) * 1992-10-07 1994-05-11 International Business Machines Corporation Hierarchical memory system for microcode and means for correcting errors in the microcode
US6098113A (en) * 1992-10-22 2000-08-01 Ncr Corporation Apparatus and method for address translation and allocation for a plurality of input/output (I/O) buses to a system bus
US5473767A (en) * 1992-11-03 1995-12-05 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for asynchronously stopping the clock in a processor
JPH0760395B2 (en) * 1992-11-06 1995-06-28 日本電気株式会社 Fault tolerant computer system
US5392437A (en) * 1992-11-06 1995-02-21 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for independently stopping and restarting functional units
US5751932A (en) * 1992-12-17 1998-05-12 Tandem Computers Incorporated Fail-fast, fail-functional, fault-tolerant multiprocessor system
US5675579A (en) * 1992-12-17 1997-10-07 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method for verifying responses to messages using a barrier message
US5513354A (en) * 1992-12-18 1996-04-30 International Business Machines Corporation Fault tolerant load management system and method
EP0610950A3 (en) * 1993-02-12 1998-04-22 Siemens Aktiengesellschaft Circuit arrangement for telecommunication
US5491786A (en) * 1993-03-12 1996-02-13 International Business Machines Corporation Method and system for management of units within a data processing system
CN1092538A (en) * 1993-03-16 1994-09-21 Ht研究公司 A kind of casing that is used for multicomputer system
US5559980A (en) * 1993-03-18 1996-09-24 Lucent Technologies Inc. Method and apparatus for detecting references to deallocated memory in a dynamic memory allocation system
US5586332A (en) * 1993-03-24 1996-12-17 Intel Corporation Power management for low power processors through the use of auto clock-throttling
US5919266A (en) * 1993-04-02 1999-07-06 Centigram Communications Corporation Apparatus and method for fault tolerant operation of a multiprocessor data processing system
US5664195A (en) * 1993-04-07 1997-09-02 Sequoia Systems, Inc. Method and apparatus for dynamic installation of a driver on a computer system
GB2277816B (en) * 1993-05-04 1997-09-03 Motorola Inc Data communication system
JP2750315B2 (en) * 1993-05-14 1998-05-13 インターナショナル・ビジネス・マシーンズ・コーポレイション Method of specifying identifier and computer system
US5490279A (en) * 1993-05-21 1996-02-06 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for operating a single CPU computer system as a multiprocessor system
US5426736A (en) * 1993-05-26 1995-06-20 Digital Equipment Corporation Method and apparatus for processing input/output commands in a storage system having a command queue
US5861894A (en) * 1993-06-24 1999-01-19 Discovision Associates Buffer manager
US5446848A (en) * 1993-06-25 1995-08-29 Unisys Corp Entry level data processing system which is expandable by a factor of two to a partitionable upgraded system with low overhead
US5471625A (en) * 1993-09-27 1995-11-28 Motorola, Inc. Method and apparatus for entering a low-power mode and controlling an external bus of a data processing system during low-power mode
US5812757A (en) * 1993-10-08 1998-09-22 Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha Processing board, a computer, and a fault recovery method for the computer
US5448723A (en) * 1993-10-15 1995-09-05 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method and apparatus for fault tolerant connection of a computing system to local area networks
JP3370155B2 (en) * 1993-12-01 2003-01-27 富士通株式会社 Data processing system
DE69435165D1 (en) * 1993-12-01 2008-12-18 Marathon Techn Corp Error-safe / fault-tolerant computer operating method
JP3161189B2 (en) * 1993-12-03 2001-04-25 株式会社日立製作所 Storage system
US5771397A (en) * 1993-12-09 1998-06-23 Quantum Corporation SCSI disk drive disconnection/reconnection timing method for reducing bus utilization
EP0666525B1 (en) * 1994-02-04 2001-09-12 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for control of power consumption in a computer system
CA2142510A1 (en) * 1994-02-24 1995-08-25 Robert W. Horst Massively parallel multiprocessor system with fault-tolerant interprocessor network
US5600576A (en) * 1994-03-11 1997-02-04 Northrop Grumman Corporation Time stress measurement device
CA2145363C (en) * 1994-03-24 1999-07-13 Anthony Mark Jones Ram interface
US5664089A (en) * 1994-04-26 1997-09-02 Unisys Corporation Multiple power domain power loss detection and interface disable
JP2679674B2 (en) * 1994-05-02 1997-11-19 日本電気株式会社 Semiconductor production line controller
US5557738A (en) * 1994-05-09 1996-09-17 Apple Computer, Inc. Power system configuration and recovery from a power fault condition in a computer system having multiple power supplies
US5623596A (en) * 1994-05-09 1997-04-22 Apple Computer, Inc. Power fault protection in a computer system having multiple power supplies
WO1995034860A1 (en) * 1994-06-10 1995-12-21 Sequoia Systems, Inc. Main memory system and checkpointing protocol for fault-tolerant computer system
US5566297A (en) * 1994-06-16 1996-10-15 International Business Machines Corporation Non-disruptive recovery from file server failure in a highly available file system for clustered computing environments
US5928368A (en) * 1994-06-23 1999-07-27 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method and apparatus for fault-tolerant multiprocessing system recovery from power failure or drop-outs
GB2291571A (en) * 1994-07-19 1996-01-24 Ibm Text to speech system; acoustic processor requests linguistic processor output
US5835953A (en) * 1994-10-13 1998-11-10 Vinca Corporation Backup system that takes a snapshot of the locations in a mass storage device that has been identified for updating prior to updating
US5649152A (en) * 1994-10-13 1997-07-15 Vinca Corporation Method and system for providing a static snapshot of data stored on a mass storage system
US6131153A (en) * 1994-10-31 2000-10-10 Nkk Corporation Multiprocessor system having a plurality of gateway units and wherein each gateway unit controls memory access requests and interferences from one hierchical level to another
US5724554A (en) * 1994-11-30 1998-03-03 Intel Corporation Apparatus for dual serial and parallel port connections for computer peripherals using a single connector
US5740359A (en) * 1994-12-27 1998-04-14 Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba Program execution system having a plurality of program versions
CA2167634A1 (en) * 1995-01-23 1996-07-24 Michael E. Fisher Method and apparatus for maintaining network connections across a voluntary process switchover
US5978914A (en) * 1995-01-23 1999-11-02 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method and apparatus for preventing inadvertent changes to system-critical files in a computing system
CA2167632A1 (en) 1995-01-23 1996-07-24 Leonard R. Fishler Apparatus and method for efficient transfer of data and events between processes and between processes and drivers in a parallel, fault tolerant message based operating system
US5630140A (en) * 1995-01-23 1997-05-13 Tandem Computers Incorporated Ordered and reliable signal delivery in a distributed multiprocessor
CA2167633A1 (en) * 1995-01-23 1996-07-24 Leonard R. Fishler Apparatus and method for efficient modularity in a parallel, fault tolerant, message based operating system
US5576945A (en) * 1995-01-23 1996-11-19 Tandem Computers Incorporated Transaction monitor process with pre-arranged modules for a multiprocessor system
EP0730237A1 (en) * 1995-02-28 1996-09-04 Nec Corporation Multi-processor system with virtually addressable communication registers and controlling method thereof
JPH08256155A (en) * 1995-03-17 1996-10-01 Fujitsu Ltd Method and device for rolling of digital processor
US5864654A (en) * 1995-03-31 1999-01-26 Nec Electronics, Inc. Systems and methods for fault tolerant information processing
US5564027A (en) * 1995-04-20 1996-10-08 International Business Machines Corporation Low latency cadence selectable interface for data transfers between busses of differing frequencies
US6185010B1 (en) * 1995-04-25 2001-02-06 Ricoh Company, Ltd. Image forming system having separate printer unit and scanner unit, the printer unit including a power supply for both the printer and scanner units
US5848230A (en) * 1995-05-25 1998-12-08 Tandem Computers Incorporated Continuously available computer memory systems
US5673416A (en) * 1995-06-07 1997-09-30 Seiko Epson Corporation Memory request and control unit including a mechanism for issuing and removing requests for memory access
US5687308A (en) * 1995-06-07 1997-11-11 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method to improve tolerance of non-homogeneous power outages
US5687372A (en) * 1995-06-07 1997-11-11 Tandem Computers, Inc. Customer information control system and method in a loosely coupled parallel processing environment
US5826043A (en) * 1995-06-07 1998-10-20 Ast Research, Inc. Docking station with serially accessed memory that is powered by a portable computer for identifying the docking station
US5734843A (en) * 1995-06-07 1998-03-31 Advanced Micro Devices Inc. Reverse data channel as a bandwidth modulator
US5790868A (en) * 1995-06-07 1998-08-04 Tandem Computers, Inc. Customer information control system and method with transaction serialization control functions in a loosely coupled parallel processing environment
US5630133A (en) * 1995-06-07 1997-05-13 Tandem Computers, Incorporated Customer information control system and method with API start and cancel transaction functions in a loosely coupled parallel processing environment
US5682507A (en) * 1995-06-07 1997-10-28 Tandem Computers, Incorporated Plurality of servers having identical customer information control procedure functions using temporary storage file of a predetermined server for centrally storing temporary data records
JP3086779B2 (en) * 1995-06-19 2000-09-11 株式会社東芝 Memory state restoration device
US5812861A (en) * 1995-06-22 1998-09-22 Intel Corporation Override signal for forcing a powerdown of a flash memory
US5740350A (en) * 1995-06-30 1998-04-14 Bull Hn Information Systems Inc. Reconfigurable computer system
US5752251A (en) * 1995-08-07 1998-05-12 Ncr Corporation Method and apparatus for recovering aborted file (or data) transmission
WO1997011426A1 (en) 1995-09-18 1997-03-27 Cyberstorage Systems, Inc. Universal storage management system
JP3628777B2 (en) 1995-10-30 2005-03-16 株式会社日立製作所 External storage device
US5745672A (en) * 1995-11-29 1998-04-28 Texas Micro, Inc. Main memory system and checkpointing protocol for a fault-tolerant computer system using a read buffer
US5751939A (en) * 1995-11-29 1998-05-12 Texas Micro, Inc. Main memory system and checkpointing protocol for fault-tolerant computer system using an exclusive-or memory
US5737514A (en) * 1995-11-29 1998-04-07 Texas Micro, Inc. Remote checkpoint memory system and protocol for fault-tolerant computer system
US5864657A (en) * 1995-11-29 1999-01-26 Texas Micro, Inc. Main memory system and checkpointing protocol for fault-tolerant computer system
US5954794A (en) 1995-12-20 1999-09-21 Tandem Computers Incorporated Computer system data I/O by reference among I/O devices and multiple memory units
US5931903A (en) 1995-12-20 1999-08-03 Tandem Computers Incorporated Computer system data I/O by reference among multiple CPUS
US5790807A (en) 1995-12-20 1998-08-04 Tandem Computers Incorporated Computer sysem data I/O by reference among CPUS and I/O devices
US5852719A (en) 1995-12-20 1998-12-22 Tandem Computers Incorporated System for transferring data over a network in which a data source sends only a descriptor which a data sink uses to retrieve data
US5941959A (en) 1995-12-20 1999-08-24 Tandem Computers Incorporated System for transferring a data stream to a requestor without copying data segments to each one of multiple data source/sinks during data stream building
US6130878A (en) * 1995-12-27 2000-10-10 Compaq Computer Corporation Method and apparatus for rate-based scheduling using a relative error approach
US5941994A (en) * 1995-12-22 1999-08-24 Lsi Logic Corporation Technique for sharing hot spare drives among multiple subsystems
US5821784A (en) * 1995-12-29 1998-10-13 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for generating 2/N mode bus clock signals
US5834956A (en) 1995-12-29 1998-11-10 Intel Corporation Core clock correction in a 2/N mode clocking scheme
US5802132A (en) * 1995-12-29 1998-09-01 Intel Corporation Apparatus for generating bus clock signals with a 1/N characteristic in a 2/N mode clocking scheme
US5978933A (en) * 1996-01-11 1999-11-02 Hewlett-Packard Company Generic fault tolerant platform
US5784628A (en) * 1996-03-12 1998-07-21 Microsoft Corporation Method and system for controlling power consumption in a computer system
KR970072676A (en) * 1996-04-19 1997-11-07 김광호 Redundant Module Switching Device
US6141769A (en) 1996-05-16 2000-10-31 Resilience Corporation Triple modular redundant computer system and associated method
US6662286B2 (en) * 1996-06-28 2003-12-09 Sony Corporation Information processing method and information processing apparatus
US5845296A (en) * 1996-07-10 1998-12-01 Oracle Corporation Method and apparatus for implementing segmented arrays in a database
US5826067A (en) * 1996-09-06 1998-10-20 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for preventing logic glitches in a 2/n clocking scheme
US5862373A (en) * 1996-09-06 1999-01-19 Intel Corporation Pad cells for a 2/N mode clocking scheme
JP2830857B2 (en) * 1996-09-09 1998-12-02 三菱電機株式会社 Data storage system and data storage management method
US6038620A (en) * 1996-09-09 2000-03-14 International Business Machines Corporation Method and system for optimal high speed match in a high performance controller which ensures an input/output interface stays ahead of a host interface
TW379298B (en) * 1996-09-30 2000-01-11 Toshiba Corp Memory updating history saving device and memory updating history saving method
US5805798A (en) * 1996-10-29 1998-09-08 Electronic Data Systems Corporation Fail-safe event driven transaction processing system and method
US6038621A (en) * 1996-11-04 2000-03-14 Hewlett-Packard Company Dynamic peripheral control of I/O buffers in peripherals with modular I/O
US5887160A (en) * 1996-12-10 1999-03-23 Fujitsu Limited Method and apparatus for communicating integer and floating point data over a shared data path in a single instruction pipeline processor
US5860116A (en) * 1996-12-11 1999-01-12 Ncr Corporation Memory page location control for multiple memory-multiple processor system
US5778218A (en) * 1996-12-19 1998-07-07 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. Method and apparatus for clock synchronization across an isochronous bus by adjustment of frame clock rates
US6005920A (en) * 1997-01-03 1999-12-21 Ncr Corporation Call center with fault resilient server-switch link
US5884018A (en) * 1997-01-28 1999-03-16 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method and apparatus for distributed agreement on processor membership in a multi-processor system
US6230245B1 (en) 1997-02-11 2001-05-08 Micron Technology, Inc. Method and apparatus for generating a variable sequence of memory device command signals
US5920703A (en) * 1997-02-19 1999-07-06 International Business Machines Corp. Systems and methods for managing the processing of relatively large data objects in a communications stack
US5983259A (en) * 1997-02-19 1999-11-09 International Business Machines Corp. Systems and methods for transmitting and receiving data in connection with a communications stack in a communications system
US5813042A (en) * 1997-02-19 1998-09-22 International Business Machines Corp. Methods and systems for control of memory
US5909553A (en) * 1997-02-19 1999-06-01 International Business Machines Corporation Systems and methods for controlling the transmission of relatively large data objects in a communications system
US6175894B1 (en) 1997-03-05 2001-01-16 Micron Technology, Inc. Memory device command buffer apparatus and method and memory devices and computer systems using same
US6289447B1 (en) * 1997-03-24 2001-09-11 Intel Corporation Topology dependent compensation to improve performance of self-compensated components including processors based on physical relationship with other system components
US5903717A (en) * 1997-04-02 1999-05-11 General Dynamics Information Systems, Inc. Fault tolerant computer system
US6094696A (en) * 1997-05-07 2000-07-25 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. Virtual serial data transfer mechanism
US5916309A (en) * 1997-05-12 1999-06-29 Lexmark International Inc. System for dynamically determining the size and number of communication buffers based on communication parameters at the beginning of the reception of message
US6046817A (en) * 1997-05-12 2000-04-04 Lexmark International, Inc. Method and apparatus for dynamic buffering of input/output ports used for receiving and transmitting print data at a printer
US6138250A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-10-24 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for reading system log
US6269417B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-07-31 Micron Technology, Inc. Method for determining and displaying the physical slot number of an expansion bus device
US6292905B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-09-18 Micron Technology, Inc. Method for providing a fault tolerant network using distributed server processes to remap clustered network resources to other servers during server failure
US6145098A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-11-07 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for displaying system status
US6247079B1 (en) * 1997-05-13 2001-06-12 Micron Electronics, Inc Apparatus for computer implemented hot-swap and hot-add
US6499073B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2002-12-24 Micron Electronics, Inc. System using programmable processor for selectively enabling or disabling power to adapter in response to respective request signals
US6173346B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-01-09 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for hot swapping a programmable storage adapter using a programmable processor for selectively enabling or disabling power to adapter slot in response to respective request signals
US5892928A (en) * 1997-05-13 1999-04-06 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for the hot add of a network adapter on a system including a dynamically loaded adapter driver
US6170028B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-01-02 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for hot swapping a programmable network adapter by using a programmable processor to selectively disabling and enabling power thereto upon receiving respective control signals
US5987554A (en) * 1997-05-13 1999-11-16 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of controlling the transfer of information across an interface between two buses
US6182180B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-01-30 Micron Electronics, Inc. Apparatus for interfacing buses
US6249834B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-06-19 Micron Technology, Inc. System for expanding PCI bus loading capacity
US6163849A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-12-19 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of powering up or powering down a server to a maintenance state
US6134673A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-10-17 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for clustering software applications
US6247080B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-06-12 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for the hot add of devices
US6073255A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-06-06 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of reading system log
US6266721B1 (en) * 1997-05-13 2001-07-24 Micron Electronics, Inc. System architecture for remote access and control of environmental management
US6195717B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-02-27 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of expanding bus loading capacity
US6272648B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-08-07 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for communicating a software-generated pulse waveform between two servers in a network
US6526333B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2003-02-25 Micron Technology, Inc. Computer fan speed control system method
US6253334B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-06-26 Micron Electronics, Inc. Three bus server architecture with a legacy PCI bus and mirrored I/O PCI buses
US6338150B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2002-01-08 Micron Technology, Inc. Diagnostic and managing distributed processor system
US6192434B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-02-20 Micron Electronics, Inc System for hot swapping a programmable adapter by using a programmable processor to selectively disabling and enabling power thereto upon receiving respective control signals
US6170067B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-01-02 Micron Technology, Inc. System for automatically reporting a system failure in a server
US6219734B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-04-17 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for the hot add of a mass storage adapter on a system including a statically loaded adapter driver
US6282673B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-08-28 Micron Technology, Inc. Method of recording information system events
US6202160B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-03-13 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for independent powering of a computer system
US6134668A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-10-17 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of selective independent powering of portion of computer system through remote interface from remote interface power supply
US6179486B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-01-30 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for hot add of a mass storage adapter on a system including a dynamically loaded adapter driver
US6243773B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-06-05 Micron Electronics, Inc. Configuration management system for hot adding and hot replacing devices
US6249885B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-06-19 Karl S. Johnson Method for managing environmental conditions of a distributed processor system
US6324608B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-11-27 Micron Electronics Method for hot swapping of network components
US6304929B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-10-16 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for hot swapping a programmable adapter by using a programmable processor to selectively disabling and enabling power thereto upon receiving respective control signals
US6363497B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2002-03-26 Micron Technology, Inc. System for clustering software applications
US6249828B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-06-19 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for the hot swap of a mass storage adapter on a system including a statically loaded adapter driver
US6148355A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-11-14 Micron Electronics, Inc. Configuration management method for hot adding and hot replacing devices
US6122758A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-09-19 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for mapping environmental resources to memory for program access
US6122746A (en) * 1997-05-13 2000-09-19 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for powering up and powering down a server
US6247898B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-06-19 Micron Electronics, Inc. Computer fan speed control system
US6243838B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-06-05 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for automatically reporting a system failure in a server
US6330690B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-12-11 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of resetting a server
US6202111B1 (en) 1997-05-13 2001-03-13 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for the hot add of a network adapter on a system including a statically loaded adapter driver
US5996043A (en) 1997-06-13 1999-11-30 Micron Technology, Inc. Two step memory device command buffer apparatus and method and memory devices and computer systems using same
US6484244B1 (en) 1997-06-17 2002-11-19 Micron Technology, Inc. Method and system for storing and processing multiple memory commands
US7080385B1 (en) * 1997-08-18 2006-07-18 Tibco Software Inc. Certified message delivery and queuing in multipoint publish/subscribe communications
JP3860966B2 (en) * 1997-08-18 2006-12-20 ティブコ ソフトウエア,インコーポレイテッド Delivery and queuing of certified messages in multipoint publish / subscribe communication
US6031624A (en) * 1997-09-08 2000-02-29 Lexmark International, Inc. Method and apparatus for adaptive data buffering in a parallelized printing system
US5968147A (en) * 1997-09-26 1999-10-19 Adaptec, Inc. Method and apparatus for improved peripheral bus utilization
US5974574A (en) * 1997-09-30 1999-10-26 Tandem Computers Incorporated Method of comparing replicated databases using checksum information
US6092213A (en) * 1997-09-30 2000-07-18 Tandem Computers Incorporated Fault tolerant method of maintaining and distributing configuration information in a distributed processing system
US5974571A (en) * 1997-09-30 1999-10-26 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for avoiding deadlock in the issuance of commands that are reordered and require data movement according to an original command order
US6212585B1 (en) 1997-10-01 2001-04-03 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of automatically configuring a server after hot add of a device
US6035420A (en) * 1997-10-01 2000-03-07 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of performing an extensive diagnostic test in conjunction with a bios test routine
US6154835A (en) * 1997-10-01 2000-11-28 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for automatically configuring and formatting a computer system and installing software
US6009541A (en) * 1997-10-01 1999-12-28 Micron Electronics, Inc. Apparatus for performing an extensive diagnostic test in conjunction with a bios test routine
US6065053A (en) * 1997-10-01 2000-05-16 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for resetting a server
US6138179A (en) * 1997-10-01 2000-10-24 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for automatically partitioning and formatting a primary hard disk for installing software in which selection of extended partition size is not related to size of hard disk
US6088816A (en) * 1997-10-01 2000-07-11 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method of displaying system status
US6199173B1 (en) 1997-10-01 2001-03-06 Micron Electronics, Inc. Method for mapping environmental resources to memory for program access
US6175490B1 (en) 1997-10-01 2001-01-16 Micron Electronics, Inc. Fault tolerant computer system
US6263387B1 (en) 1997-10-01 2001-07-17 Micron Electronics, Inc. System for automatically configuring a server after hot add of a device
US6219672B1 (en) * 1997-12-11 2001-04-17 Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba Distributed shared memory system and method of controlling distributed shared memory
US6202119B1 (en) 1997-12-19 2001-03-13 Micron Technology, Inc. Method and system for processing pipelined memory commands
US6148352A (en) * 1997-12-24 2000-11-14 International Business Machines Corporation Scalable modular data storage system
US6272573B1 (en) 1997-12-24 2001-08-07 International Business Machines Corporation Scalable modular data storage system
JP3603577B2 (en) * 1997-12-26 2004-12-22 富士ゼロックス株式会社 Image processing system
US6119248A (en) * 1998-01-26 2000-09-12 Dell Usa L.P. Operating system notification of correctable error in computer information
DE19815263C2 (en) * 1998-04-04 2002-03-28 Astrium Gmbh Device for fault-tolerant execution of programs
US6216051B1 (en) 1998-05-04 2001-04-10 Nec Electronics, Inc. Manufacturing backup system
US6167330A (en) * 1998-05-08 2000-12-26 The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Air Force Dynamic power management of systems
US6289467B1 (en) * 1998-05-08 2001-09-11 Sun Microsystems, Inc. Installation of processor and power supply modules in a multiprocessor system
US6178522B1 (en) 1998-06-02 2001-01-23 Alliedsignal Inc. Method and apparatus for managing redundant computer-based systems for fault tolerant computing
US6202164B1 (en) * 1998-07-02 2001-03-13 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. Data rate synchronization by frame rate adjustment
US6279058B1 (en) 1998-07-02 2001-08-21 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. Master isochronous clock structure having a clock controller coupling to a CPU and two data buses
US6223234B1 (en) 1998-07-17 2001-04-24 Micron Electronics, Inc. Apparatus for the hot swap and add of input/output platforms and devices
US6205503B1 (en) 1998-07-17 2001-03-20 Mallikarjunan Mahalingam Method for the hot swap and add of input/output platforms and devices
US6145033A (en) * 1998-07-17 2000-11-07 Seiko Epson Corporation Management of display FIFO requests for DRAM access wherein low priority requests are initiated when FIFO level is below/equal to high threshold value
US6175905B1 (en) 1998-07-30 2001-01-16 Micron Technology, Inc. Method and system for bypassing pipelines in a pipelined memory command generator
US6119207A (en) * 1998-08-20 2000-09-12 Seiko Epson Corporation Low priority FIFO request assignment for DRAM access
US6178488B1 (en) 1998-08-27 2001-01-23 Micron Technology, Inc. Method and apparatus for processing pipelined memory commands
US6154845A (en) * 1998-09-11 2000-11-28 Intel Corporation Power failure safe computer architecture
US6209088B1 (en) 1998-09-21 2001-03-27 Microsoft Corporation Computer hibernation implemented by a computer operating system
US6356962B1 (en) * 1998-09-30 2002-03-12 Stmicroelectronics, Inc. Network device and method of controlling flow of data arranged in frames in a data-based network
US6301670B1 (en) 1998-10-06 2001-10-09 Ricoh Corporation Method and apparatus for erasing data when a problem is identified
US6304948B1 (en) * 1998-10-06 2001-10-16 Ricoh Corporation Method and apparatus for erasing data after expiration
US7325052B1 (en) * 1998-10-06 2008-01-29 Ricoh Company, Ltd. Method and system to erase data after expiration or other condition
US6321335B1 (en) 1998-10-30 2001-11-20 Acqis Technology, Inc. Password protected modular computer method and device
US6078957A (en) * 1998-11-20 2000-06-20 Network Alchemy, Inc. Method and apparatus for a TCP/IP load balancing and failover process in an internet protocol (IP) network clustering system
US6006259A (en) * 1998-11-20 1999-12-21 Network Alchemy, Inc. Method and apparatus for an internet protocol (IP) network clustering system
US6449733B1 (en) 1998-12-07 2002-09-10 Compaq Computer Corporation On-line replacement of process pairs in a clustered processor architecture
US6389551B1 (en) 1998-12-17 2002-05-14 Steeleye Technology, Inc. Method of preventing false or unnecessary failovers in a high availability cluster by using a quorum service
DE19910069A1 (en) * 1999-03-08 2000-11-23 Peter Renner Process automation
US6636977B1 (en) * 1999-03-10 2003-10-21 Shin Jiuh Corp. Control device for use in a power supplying apparatus including multiple processors adapted to perform separate functions associated with status monitoring and load balancing
US6671704B1 (en) * 1999-03-11 2003-12-30 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. Method and apparatus for handling failures of resource managers in a clustered environment
US6295548B1 (en) 1999-03-12 2001-09-25 Compaq Computer Corporation Detection of an imported transaction for finding the global transaction identifier
US6496825B1 (en) 1999-03-12 2002-12-17 Compaq Computer Corporation Systems and methods for the detection of a loop-back of a transaction
US6411981B1 (en) 1999-03-12 2002-06-25 Compaq Computer Corporation Method and apparatus for conducting a transaction between homogeneous and/or heterogeneous transaction processing systems using asynchronous pull of a transaction transfer
US6470342B1 (en) 1999-03-12 2002-10-22 Compaq Computer Corporation Process of maintaining a distributed map of transaction identifiers and using hashing to access these maps
US6618820B1 (en) * 2000-01-10 2003-09-09 Imagex.Com, Inc. Method for configuring an application server system
US6618742B1 (en) 2000-01-10 2003-09-09 Imagex.Com, Inc. Method for job impact learning
US6643777B1 (en) 1999-05-14 2003-11-04 Acquis Technology, Inc. Data security method and device for computer modules
US6718415B1 (en) 1999-05-14 2004-04-06 Acqis Technology, Inc. Computer system and method including console housing multiple computer modules having independent processing units, mass storage devices, and graphics controllers
US6169669B1 (en) * 1999-07-15 2001-01-02 Texas Instruments Incorporated Digital signal processor controlled uninterruptable power supply
AT407582B (en) * 1999-08-13 2001-04-25 Fts Computertechnik Gmbh MESSAGE DISTRIBUTION UNIT WITH INTEGRATED GUARDIAN TO PREVENT '' BABBLING IDIOT '' ERRORS
US6408348B1 (en) 1999-08-20 2002-06-18 International Business Machines Corporation System, method, and program for managing I/O requests to a storage device
US6928073B2 (en) * 1999-10-01 2005-08-09 Stmicroelectronics Ltd. Integrated circuit implementing packet transmission
ATE390788T1 (en) 1999-10-14 2008-04-15 Bluearc Uk Ltd APPARATUS AND METHOD FOR HARDWARE EXECUTION OR HARDWARE ACCELERATION OF OPERATING SYSTEM FUNCTIONS
GB9927372D0 (en) * 1999-11-20 2000-01-19 Ncr Int Inc Self-service terminal
US6564274B1 (en) * 1999-12-17 2003-05-13 Omnicluster Technologies, Inc. Modular architecture for small computer networks
US6862613B1 (en) * 2000-01-10 2005-03-01 Sun Microsystems, Inc. Method and apparatus for managing operations of clustered computer systems
JP4462697B2 (en) 2000-01-31 2010-05-12 株式会社日立製作所 Storage controller
US7085237B1 (en) 2000-03-31 2006-08-01 Alcatel Method and apparatus for routing alarms in a signaling server
US6977926B1 (en) * 2000-03-31 2005-12-20 Alcatel Method and system for providing a feedback signal in a telecommunications network
US6687851B1 (en) 2000-04-13 2004-02-03 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Method and system for upgrading fault-tolerant systems
US6691257B1 (en) 2000-04-13 2004-02-10 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Fault-tolerant maintenance bus protocol and method for using the same
US6633996B1 (en) 2000-04-13 2003-10-14 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Fault-tolerant maintenance bus architecture
US6820213B1 (en) 2000-04-13 2004-11-16 Stratus Technologies Bermuda, Ltd. Fault-tolerant computer system with voter delay buffer
US6735715B1 (en) 2000-04-13 2004-05-11 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. System and method for operating a SCSI bus with redundant SCSI adaptors
US6708283B1 (en) 2000-04-13 2004-03-16 Stratus Technologies, Bermuda Ltd. System and method for operating a system with redundant peripheral bus controllers
US6802022B1 (en) 2000-04-14 2004-10-05 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Maintenance of consistent, redundant mass storage images
US6691225B1 (en) 2000-04-14 2004-02-10 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Method and apparatus for deterministically booting a computer system having redundant components
US6901481B2 (en) 2000-04-14 2005-05-31 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Method and apparatus for storing transactional information in persistent memory
US6862689B2 (en) 2001-04-12 2005-03-01 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Method and apparatus for managing session information
US6865157B1 (en) * 2000-05-26 2005-03-08 Emc Corporation Fault tolerant shared system resource with communications passthrough providing high availability communications
US6525926B1 (en) * 2000-07-11 2003-02-25 Racklogic Technologies, Inc. Multinode high density computing apparatus
US7016992B2 (en) * 2000-08-17 2006-03-21 Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. Electronic mail system
US6718474B1 (en) 2000-09-21 2004-04-06 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Methods and apparatus for clock management based on environmental conditions
US6904505B1 (en) * 2000-10-12 2005-06-07 Emulex Design & Manufacturing Corporation Method for determining valid bytes for multiple-byte burst memories
US8185615B1 (en) 2000-11-28 2012-05-22 Verizon Business Global Llc Message, control and reporting interface for a distributed network access system
US7046680B1 (en) 2000-11-28 2006-05-16 Mci, Inc. Network access system including a programmable access device having distributed service control
US7657628B1 (en) 2000-11-28 2010-02-02 Verizon Business Global Llc External processor for a distributed network access system
US8180870B1 (en) 2000-11-28 2012-05-15 Verizon Business Global Llc Programmable access device for a distributed network access system
US6948010B2 (en) * 2000-12-20 2005-09-20 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Method and apparatus for efficiently moving portions of a memory block
US6886171B2 (en) * 2001-02-20 2005-04-26 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Caching for I/O virtual address translation and validation using device drivers
US6766479B2 (en) 2001-02-28 2004-07-20 Stratus Technologies Bermuda, Ltd. Apparatus and methods for identifying bus protocol violations
US6766413B2 (en) 2001-03-01 2004-07-20 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Systems and methods for caching with file-level granularity
US6874102B2 (en) 2001-03-05 2005-03-29 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Coordinated recalibration of high bandwidth memories in a multiprocessor computer
US6950893B2 (en) * 2001-03-22 2005-09-27 I-Bus Corporation Hybrid switching architecture
US7065672B2 (en) 2001-03-28 2006-06-20 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Apparatus and methods for fault-tolerant computing using a switching fabric
US20020178313A1 (en) * 2001-03-30 2002-11-28 Gary Scott Paul Using software interrupts to manage communication between data processors
US6928583B2 (en) * 2001-04-11 2005-08-09 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Apparatus and method for two computing elements in a fault-tolerant server to execute instructions in lockstep
US6971043B2 (en) * 2001-04-11 2005-11-29 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd Apparatus and method for accessing a mass storage device in a fault-tolerant server
US7047522B1 (en) * 2001-04-30 2006-05-16 General Electric Capital Corporation Method and system for verifying a computer program
US6996750B2 (en) 2001-05-31 2006-02-07 Stratus Technologies Bermuda Ltd. Methods and apparatus for computer bus error termination
JP2003016400A (en) * 2001-06-28 2003-01-17 Sankyo Seiki Mfg Co Ltd Power failure detecting device and card reader equipped with the same power failure detecting device
JP4382310B2 (en) * 2001-08-17 2009-12-09 株式会社リコー Image forming apparatus and control method thereof
FR2828972A1 (en) * 2001-08-21 2003-02-28 Koninkl Philips Electronics Nv DATA PROCESSING AND ROUTING DEVICE
US6909659B2 (en) * 2001-08-30 2005-06-21 Micron Technology, Inc. Zero power chip standby mode
US6661410B2 (en) 2001-09-07 2003-12-09 Microsoft Corporation Capacitive sensing and data input device power management
US7337333B2 (en) * 2001-09-19 2008-02-26 Dell Products L.P. System and method for strategic power supply sequencing in a computer system with multiple processing resources and multiple power supplies
US7325050B2 (en) * 2001-09-19 2008-01-29 Dell Products L.P. System and method for strategic power reduction in a computer system
US7287187B2 (en) * 2001-10-15 2007-10-23 Sun Microsystems, Inc. Method and apparatus for supplying redundant power
US20050038705A1 (en) * 2001-11-01 2005-02-17 Tokuhiro Yamada Pos system, pos server, shop terminal, sales managing method, and recording medium
US6954877B2 (en) * 2001-11-29 2005-10-11 Agami Systems, Inc. Fault tolerance using logical checkpointing in computing systems
US6879523B1 (en) * 2001-12-27 2005-04-12 Cypress Semiconductor Corporation Random access memory (RAM) method of operation and device for search engine systems
US7301961B1 (en) 2001-12-27 2007-11-27 Cypress Semiconductor Corportion Method and apparatus for configuring signal lines according to idle codes
US6792516B2 (en) * 2001-12-28 2004-09-14 Intel Corporation Memory arbiter with intelligent page gathering logic
US7035984B2 (en) * 2001-12-31 2006-04-25 Intel Corporation Memory arbiter with grace and ceiling periods and intelligent page gathering logic
US6856045B1 (en) * 2002-01-29 2005-02-15 Hamilton Sundstrand Corporation Power distribution assembly with redundant architecture
US6703599B1 (en) 2002-01-30 2004-03-09 Microsoft Corporation Proximity sensor with adaptive threshold
US20030212473A1 (en) * 2002-02-25 2003-11-13 General Electric Company Processing system for a power distribution system
US20040078652A1 (en) * 2002-03-08 2004-04-22 Tapper Gunnar D. Using process quads to enable continuous services in a cluster environment
US20030208750A1 (en) * 2002-03-29 2003-11-06 Tapper Gunnar D. Information exchange for process pair replacement in a cluster environment
US7096213B2 (en) * 2002-04-08 2006-08-22 Oracle International Corporation Persistent key-value repository with a pluggable architecture to abstract physical storage
US7058639B1 (en) 2002-04-08 2006-06-06 Oracle International Corporation Use of dynamic multi-level hash table for managing hierarchically structured information
US7136867B1 (en) 2002-04-08 2006-11-14 Oracle International Corporation Metadata format for hierarchical data storage on a raw storage device
US8271530B2 (en) * 2002-04-08 2012-09-18 Oracale International Corporation Method and mechanism for managing and accessing static and dynamic data
US7672945B1 (en) 2002-04-08 2010-03-02 Oracle International Corporation Mechanism for creating member private data in a global namespace
US7209492B2 (en) * 2002-04-15 2007-04-24 Alcatel DSO timing source transient compensation
US7111228B1 (en) 2002-05-07 2006-09-19 Marvell International Ltd. System and method for performing parity checks in disk storage system
US20030212761A1 (en) * 2002-05-10 2003-11-13 Microsoft Corporation Process kernel
US20050060608A1 (en) * 2002-05-23 2005-03-17 Benoit Marchand Maximizing processor utilization and minimizing network bandwidth requirements in throughput compute clusters
US7305585B2 (en) * 2002-05-23 2007-12-04 Exludus Technologies Inc. Asynchronous and autonomous data replication
US20080222234A1 (en) * 2002-05-23 2008-09-11 Benoit Marchand Deployment and Scaling of Virtual Environments
US20050216910A1 (en) * 2002-05-23 2005-09-29 Benoit Marchand Increasing fault-tolerance and minimizing network bandwidth requirements in software installation modules
US6954867B2 (en) * 2002-07-26 2005-10-11 Microsoft Corporation Capacitive sensing employing a repeatable offset charge
US7313706B2 (en) * 2002-09-17 2007-12-25 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. System and method for managing power consumption for a plurality of processors based on a supply voltage to each processor, temperature, total power consumption and individual processor power consumption
US20040054938A1 (en) * 2002-09-17 2004-03-18 Belady Christian L. Controlling a computer system based on an environmental condition
US7280620B2 (en) * 2002-10-18 2007-10-09 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Electronic device including image forming apparatus
US8041735B1 (en) 2002-11-01 2011-10-18 Bluearc Uk Limited Distributed file system and method
US7457822B1 (en) 2002-11-01 2008-11-25 Bluearc Uk Limited Apparatus and method for hardware-based file system
JP3757204B2 (en) * 2002-12-06 2006-03-22 ファナック株式会社 Error detection / correction method and control device using the method
US7206972B2 (en) * 2003-01-09 2007-04-17 Alcatel Path commissioning analysis and diagnostic tool
US7007114B1 (en) * 2003-01-31 2006-02-28 Qlogic Corporation System and method for padding data blocks and/or removing padding from data blocks in storage controllers
US7287102B1 (en) 2003-01-31 2007-10-23 Marvell International Ltd. System and method for concatenating data
US7099963B2 (en) * 2003-03-10 2006-08-29 Qlogic Corporation Method and system for monitoring embedded disk controller components
US7870346B2 (en) * 2003-03-10 2011-01-11 Marvell International Ltd. Servo controller interface module for embedded disk controllers
US7219182B2 (en) * 2003-03-10 2007-05-15 Marvell International Ltd. Method and system for using an external bus controller in embedded disk controllers
US7492545B1 (en) 2003-03-10 2009-02-17 Marvell International Ltd. Method and system for automatic time base adjustment for disk drive servo controllers
US7039771B1 (en) 2003-03-10 2006-05-02 Marvell International Ltd. Method and system for supporting multiple external serial port devices using a serial port controller in embedded disk controllers
US7064915B1 (en) 2003-03-10 2006-06-20 Marvell International Ltd. Method and system for collecting servo field data from programmable devices in embedded disk controllers
JP4242682B2 (en) * 2003-03-26 2009-03-25 パナソニック株式会社 Memory device
US6823347B2 (en) * 2003-04-23 2004-11-23 Oracle International Corporation Propagating commit times
US7210069B2 (en) * 2003-05-13 2007-04-24 Lucent Technologies Inc. Failure recovery in a multiprocessor configuration
US7240130B2 (en) * 2003-06-12 2007-07-03 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. Method of transmitting data through an 12C router
US7406641B2 (en) * 2003-06-30 2008-07-29 Intel Corporation Selective control of test-access ports in integrated circuits
US7530108B1 (en) 2003-09-15 2009-05-05 The Directv Group, Inc. Multiprocessor conditional access module and method for using the same
US7577806B2 (en) * 2003-09-23 2009-08-18 Symantec Operating Corporation Systems and methods for time dependent data storage and recovery
US7296008B2 (en) * 2004-08-24 2007-11-13 Symantec Operating Corporation Generation and use of a time map for accessing a prior image of a storage device
US7409587B2 (en) * 2004-08-24 2008-08-05 Symantec Operating Corporation Recovering from storage transaction failures using checkpoints
US7827362B2 (en) * 2004-08-24 2010-11-02 Symantec Corporation Systems, apparatus, and methods for processing I/O requests
US7577807B2 (en) * 2003-09-23 2009-08-18 Symantec Operating Corporation Methods and devices for restoring a portion of a data store
US7239581B2 (en) * 2004-08-24 2007-07-03 Symantec Operating Corporation Systems and methods for synchronizing the internal clocks of a plurality of processor modules
US7631120B2 (en) * 2004-08-24 2009-12-08 Symantec Operating Corporation Methods and apparatus for optimally selecting a storage buffer for the storage of data
US7730222B2 (en) * 2004-08-24 2010-06-01 Symantec Operating System Processing storage-related I/O requests using binary tree data structures
US7725760B2 (en) * 2003-09-23 2010-05-25 Symantec Operating Corporation Data storage system
US7904428B2 (en) * 2003-09-23 2011-03-08 Symantec Corporation Methods and apparatus for recording write requests directed to a data store
US7287133B2 (en) * 2004-08-24 2007-10-23 Symantec Operating Corporation Systems and methods for providing a modification history for a location within a data store
US7991748B2 (en) * 2003-09-23 2011-08-02 Symantec Corporation Virtual data store creation and use
US7209809B2 (en) * 2003-10-15 2007-04-24 The Boeing Company Method and apparatus for obtaining high integrity and availability in multi-channel systems
US7526691B1 (en) 2003-10-15 2009-04-28 Marvell International Ltd. System and method for using TAP controllers
US7225356B2 (en) * 2003-11-06 2007-05-29 Siemens Medical Solutions Health Services Corporation System for managing operational failure occurrences in processing devices
US20050125486A1 (en) * 2003-11-20 2005-06-09 Microsoft Corporation Decentralized operating system
EP1542181A1 (en) * 2003-12-11 2005-06-15 Banksys S.A. Electronic data processing device
US8898339B2 (en) * 2003-12-12 2014-11-25 Napatech A/S Method of transferring data implying a network analyser card
JP4441286B2 (en) * 2004-02-10 2010-03-31 株式会社日立製作所 Storage system
US7139150B2 (en) * 2004-02-10 2006-11-21 Marvell International Ltd. Method and system for head position control in embedded disk drive controllers
US20060020852A1 (en) * 2004-03-30 2006-01-26 Bernick David L Method and system of servicing asynchronous interrupts in multiple processors executing a user program
US20050240806A1 (en) * 2004-03-30 2005-10-27 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. Diagnostic memory dump method in a redundant processor
US7304996B1 (en) 2004-03-30 2007-12-04 Extreme Networks, Inc. System and method for assembling a data packet
US7822032B1 (en) * 2004-03-30 2010-10-26 Extreme Networks, Inc. Data structures for supporting packet data modification operations
US7921419B2 (en) * 2004-05-12 2011-04-05 Oracle International Corporation Method and mechanism for managing incompatible changes in a distributed system
US8086800B2 (en) * 2004-05-18 2011-12-27 Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. Integrated circuit and method for buffering to optimize burst length in networks on chips
US7120084B2 (en) * 2004-06-14 2006-10-10 Marvell International Ltd. Integrated memory controller
US7392426B2 (en) * 2004-06-15 2008-06-24 Honeywell International Inc. Redundant processing architecture for single fault tolerance
US8166217B2 (en) * 2004-06-28 2012-04-24 Marvell International Ltd. System and method for reading and writing data using storage controllers
JP4353005B2 (en) * 2004-06-29 2009-10-28 株式会社日立製作所 System switching method for clustered computer systems
US7472129B2 (en) * 2004-06-29 2008-12-30 Microsoft Corporation Lossless recovery for computer systems with map assisted state transfer
US7360111B2 (en) * 2004-06-29 2008-04-15 Microsoft Corporation Lossless recovery for computer systems with remotely dependent data recovery
JP4490751B2 (en) 2004-07-16 2010-06-30 セイレイ工業株式会社 Outrigger hydraulic cylinder
US7757009B2 (en) 2004-07-19 2010-07-13 Marvell International Ltd. Storage controllers with dynamic WWN storage modules and methods for managing data and connections between a host and a storage device
US9201599B2 (en) * 2004-07-19 2015-12-01 Marvell International Ltd. System and method for transmitting data in storage controllers
US8032674B2 (en) * 2004-07-19 2011-10-04 Marvell International Ltd. System and method for controlling buffer memory overflow and underflow conditions in storage controllers
US7308605B2 (en) * 2004-07-20 2007-12-11 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. Latent error detection
US8230252B2 (en) 2004-07-20 2012-07-24 Hewlett-Packard Development Company, L.P. Time of day response
US7467324B1 (en) 2004-09-30 2008-12-16 Ayaya Inc. Method and apparatus for continuing to provide processing on disk outages
US7386661B2 (en) 2004-10-13 2008-06-10 Marvell International Ltd. Power save module for storage controllers
US7240267B2 (en) * 2004-11-08 2007-07-03 Marvell International Ltd. System and method for conducting BIST operations
US7802026B2 (en) * 2004-11-15 2010-09-21 Marvell International Ltd. Method and system for processing frames in storage controllers
US7337357B2 (en) * 2004-11-16 2008-02-26 International Business Machines Corporation Apparatus, system, and method for limiting failures in redundant signals
US7685400B2 (en) * 2004-12-15 2010-03-23 International Business Machines Corporation Storage of data blocks of logical volumes in a virtual disk storage subsystem
JP4117684B2 (en) * 2004-12-20 2008-07-16 日本電気株式会社 Fault-tolerant / duplex computer system and its control method
US20060156381A1 (en) * 2005-01-12 2006-07-13 Tetsuro Motoyama Approach for deleting electronic documents on network devices using document retention policies
US7334140B2 (en) * 2005-03-03 2008-02-19 International Business Machines Corporation Apparatus and method to selectively provide power to one or more components disposed in an information storage and retrieval system
US7707131B2 (en) * 2005-03-08 2010-04-27 Microsoft Corporation Thompson strategy based online reinforcement learning system for action selection
US7885817B2 (en) * 2005-03-08 2011-02-08 Microsoft Corporation Easy generation and automatic training of spoken dialog systems using text-to-speech
US7734471B2 (en) * 2005-03-08 2010-06-08 Microsoft Corporation Online learning for dialog systems
US8522253B1 (en) 2005-03-31 2013-08-27 Guillermo Rozas Hardware support for virtual machine and operating system context switching in translation lookaside buffers and virtually tagged caches
US20060227145A1 (en) * 2005-04-06 2006-10-12 Raymond Chow Graphics controller having a single display interface for two or more displays
US7609468B2 (en) * 2005-04-06 2009-10-27 Marvell International Ltd. Method and system for read gate timing control for storage controllers
US7797394B2 (en) * 2005-04-18 2010-09-14 Dell Products L.P. System and method for processing commands in a storage enclosure
US8001297B2 (en) * 2005-04-25 2011-08-16 Microsoft Corporation Dynamic adjusting send rate of buffered data
US7590819B2 (en) * 2005-05-09 2009-09-15 Lsi Logic Corporation Compact memory management unit
DE102005059593A1 (en) * 2005-05-25 2006-11-30 Robert Bosch Gmbh Method and device for switching to a memory for a control unit
US7877350B2 (en) * 2005-06-27 2011-01-25 Ab Initio Technology Llc Managing metadata for graph-based computations
JP4732823B2 (en) * 2005-07-26 2011-07-27 株式会社日立産機システム Inter-module communication device
US20070027485A1 (en) * 2005-07-29 2007-02-01 Kallmyer Todd A Implantable medical device bus system and method
US7536583B2 (en) 2005-10-14 2009-05-19 Symantec Operating Corporation Technique for timeline compression in a data store
TWI297237B (en) * 2005-10-28 2008-05-21 Hon Hai Prec Ind Co Ltd Power switching circuit and power supply system using the same
US7428602B2 (en) * 2005-11-29 2008-09-23 International Business Machines Corporation Method for executing initialization code to configure connected devices and executing segments of configuration code from a failed segment
US7526674B2 (en) * 2005-12-22 2009-04-28 International Business Machines Corporation Methods and apparatuses for supplying power to processors in multiple processor systems
GB0601849D0 (en) * 2006-01-30 2006-03-08 Ttp Communications Ltd Method of maintaining software integrity
CN103646009B (en) 2006-04-12 2016-08-17 索夫特机械公司 The apparatus and method that the instruction matrix of specifying parallel and dependent operations is processed
US7480827B2 (en) 2006-08-11 2009-01-20 Chicago Mercantile Exchange Fault tolerance and failover using active copy-cat
US7434096B2 (en) 2006-08-11 2008-10-07 Chicago Mercantile Exchange Match server for a financial exchange having fault tolerant operation
US8041985B2 (en) 2006-08-11 2011-10-18 Chicago Mercantile Exchange, Inc. Match server for a financial exchange having fault tolerant operation
US8225320B2 (en) * 2006-08-31 2012-07-17 Advanced Simulation Technology, Inc. Processing data using continuous processing task and binary routine
US7464230B2 (en) * 2006-09-08 2008-12-09 Jiun-In Guo Memory controlling method
CN107368285B (en) 2006-11-14 2020-10-09 英特尔公司 Multi-threaded architecture
US20080141063A1 (en) * 2006-12-12 2008-06-12 Ridgeway Curtis A Real time elastic FIFO latency optimization
US7990724B2 (en) 2006-12-19 2011-08-02 Juhasz Paul R Mobile motherboard
US7702933B2 (en) * 2007-01-30 2010-04-20 Inventec Corporation Multiprocessor power-on switch circuit
TW200847087A (en) * 2007-05-18 2008-12-01 Beyond Innovation Tech Co Ltd Method and system for protecting information between a master terminal and a slave terminal
US8313432B2 (en) * 2007-06-20 2012-11-20 Surgmatix, Inc. Surgical data monitoring and display system
US7773504B2 (en) * 2007-11-13 2010-08-10 Intel Corporation Bandwidth allocation for network packet traffic
US7917806B2 (en) * 2007-12-18 2011-03-29 International Business Machines Corporation System and method for indicating status of an on-chip power supply system
US8028195B2 (en) * 2007-12-18 2011-09-27 International Business Machines Corporation Structure for indicating status of an on-chip power supply system
US20090259786A1 (en) * 2008-04-10 2009-10-15 Chu-Ming Lin Data transfer system and method for host-slave interface with automatic status report
US8027168B2 (en) * 2008-08-13 2011-09-27 Delphi Technologies, Inc. Electrical center with vertical power bus bar
JP4892526B2 (en) * 2008-08-26 2012-03-07 本田技研工業株式会社 Tandem master cylinder
US8139583B1 (en) 2008-09-30 2012-03-20 Extreme Networks, Inc. Command selection in a packet forwarding device
US8272028B2 (en) * 2008-10-15 2012-09-18 Ricoh Company, Ltd. Approach for managing access to electronic documents on network devices using document retention policies and document security policies
US20100138618A1 (en) * 2008-12-03 2010-06-03 Vns Portfolio Llc Priority Encoders
US8561052B2 (en) * 2008-12-08 2013-10-15 Harris Corporation Communications device with a plurality of processors and compatibility synchronization module for processor upgrades and related method
WO2010093879A1 (en) 2009-02-13 2010-08-19 Ab Initio Technology Llc Managing task execution
WO2010113165A1 (en) * 2009-04-01 2010-10-07 Kaminario Tehnologies Ltd. System and method for storage unit building while catering to i/o operations
US9461930B2 (en) * 2009-04-27 2016-10-04 Intel Corporation Modifying data streams without reordering in a multi-thread, multi-flow network processor
EP2464053A4 (en) * 2009-09-02 2014-01-22 Zte Corp Power-down protection method and system, power controller for the communication device
US20110179303A1 (en) 2010-01-15 2011-07-21 Microsoft Corporation Persistent application activation and timer notifications
US20110296437A1 (en) * 2010-05-28 2011-12-01 Devendra Raut Method and apparatus for lockless communication between cores in a multi-core processor
CN103069385B (en) 2010-06-15 2016-12-28 起元技术有限责任公司 System and method for dynamic load calculating based on figure
JP5559616B2 (en) * 2010-06-17 2014-07-23 ラピスセミコンダクタ株式会社 Semiconductor memory device
US8549378B2 (en) 2010-06-24 2013-10-01 International Business Machines Corporation RAIM system using decoding of virtual ECC
US8898511B2 (en) * 2010-06-24 2014-11-25 International Business Machines Corporation Homogeneous recovery in a redundant memory system
US8631271B2 (en) 2010-06-24 2014-01-14 International Business Machines Corporation Heterogeneous recovery in a redundant memory system
EP2616928B1 (en) 2010-09-17 2016-11-02 Soft Machines, Inc. Single cycle multi-branch prediction including shadow cache for early far branch prediction
US20120110562A1 (en) * 2010-10-27 2012-05-03 David Heinrich Synchronized firmware update
CN108376097B (en) 2011-03-25 2022-04-15 英特尔公司 Register file segments for supporting code block execution by using virtual cores instantiated by partitionable engines
CN108108188B (en) 2011-03-25 2022-06-28 英特尔公司 Memory fragments for supporting code block execution by using virtual cores instantiated by partitionable engines
TWI533129B (en) 2011-03-25 2016-05-11 軟體機器公司 Executing instruction sequence code blocks by using virtual cores instantiated by partitionable engines
WO2012162188A2 (en) 2011-05-20 2012-11-29 Soft Machines, Inc. Decentralized allocation of resources and interconnect structures to support the execution of instruction sequences by a plurality of engines
CN103649931B (en) 2011-05-20 2016-10-12 索夫特机械公司 For supporting to be performed the interconnection structure of job sequence by multiple engines
US20120317356A1 (en) * 2011-06-09 2012-12-13 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. Systems and methods for sharing memory between a plurality of processors
US9032269B2 (en) 2011-07-22 2015-05-12 Sandisk Technologies Inc. Systems and methods of storing data
KR101703401B1 (en) 2011-11-22 2017-02-06 소프트 머신즈, 인크. An accelerated code optimizer for a multiengine microprocessor
US20150039859A1 (en) 2011-11-22 2015-02-05 Soft Machines, Inc. Microprocessor accelerated code optimizer
US8930674B2 (en) 2012-03-07 2015-01-06 Soft Machines, Inc. Systems and methods for accessing a unified translation lookaside buffer
US9055069B2 (en) * 2012-03-19 2015-06-09 Xcelemor, Inc. Hardware computing system with software mediation and method of operation thereof
US8938551B2 (en) * 2012-04-10 2015-01-20 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH Data processing device
US9710399B2 (en) 2012-07-30 2017-07-18 Intel Corporation Systems and methods for flushing a cache with modified data
US9229873B2 (en) 2012-07-30 2016-01-05 Soft Machines, Inc. Systems and methods for supporting a plurality of load and store accesses of a cache
US9740612B2 (en) 2012-07-30 2017-08-22 Intel Corporation Systems and methods for maintaining the coherency of a store coalescing cache and a load cache
US9430410B2 (en) 2012-07-30 2016-08-30 Soft Machines, Inc. Systems and methods for supporting a plurality of load accesses of a cache in a single cycle
US9916253B2 (en) 2012-07-30 2018-03-13 Intel Corporation Method and apparatus for supporting a plurality of load accesses of a cache in a single cycle to maintain throughput
US9678882B2 (en) 2012-10-11 2017-06-13 Intel Corporation Systems and methods for non-blocking implementation of cache flush instructions
KR101905055B1 (en) 2012-10-22 2018-10-08 인텔 코포레이션 High performance interconnect physical layer
US9507682B2 (en) 2012-11-16 2016-11-29 Ab Initio Technology Llc Dynamic graph performance monitoring
US10108521B2 (en) 2012-11-16 2018-10-23 Ab Initio Technology Llc Dynamic component performance monitoring
JP6036578B2 (en) * 2013-03-08 2016-11-30 株式会社デンソー Data processing device
US9442559B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2016-09-13 Intel Corporation Exploiting process variation in a multicore processor
US9891924B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2018-02-13 Intel Corporation Method for implementing a reduced size register view data structure in a microprocessor
US9811342B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2017-11-07 Intel Corporation Method for performing dual dispatch of blocks and half blocks
US9886279B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2018-02-06 Intel Corporation Method for populating and instruction view data structure by using register template snapshots
CN105210040B (en) 2013-03-15 2019-04-02 英特尔公司 For executing the method for being grouped blocking multithreading instruction
US9569216B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2017-02-14 Soft Machines, Inc. Method for populating a source view data structure by using register template snapshots
WO2014150971A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2014-09-25 Soft Machines, Inc. A method for dependency broadcasting through a block organized source view data structure
US9904625B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2018-02-27 Intel Corporation Methods, systems and apparatus for predicting the way of a set associative cache
CN105247484B (en) 2013-03-15 2021-02-23 英特尔公司 Method for emulating a guest centralized flag architecture using a locally distributed flag architecture
WO2014150806A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2014-09-25 Soft Machines, Inc. A method for populating register view data structure by using register template snapshots
US10275255B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2019-04-30 Intel Corporation Method for dependency broadcasting through a source organized source view data structure
US10140138B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2018-11-27 Intel Corporation Methods, systems and apparatus for supporting wide and efficient front-end operation with guest-architecture emulation
WO2014150991A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2014-09-25 Soft Machines, Inc. A method for implementing a reduced size register view data structure in a microprocessor
US9594612B2 (en) * 2013-06-28 2017-03-14 Arista Networks, Inc. System and method of a hardware shadow for a network element
JP6236996B2 (en) * 2013-08-28 2017-11-29 富士通株式会社 Information processing apparatus and information processing apparatus control method
CA2932763C (en) 2013-12-05 2022-07-12 Ab Initio Technology Llc Managing interfaces for dataflow graphs composed of sub-graphs
US9459972B2 (en) 2014-06-20 2016-10-04 International Business Machines Corporation Alternative port error recovery with limited system impact
US10542125B2 (en) * 2014-09-03 2020-01-21 The Boeing Company Systems and methods for configuring a computing device to use a communication protocol
US9043638B1 (en) 2014-11-14 2015-05-26 Quanta Computer Inc. Method for enhancing memory fault tolerance
US10657134B2 (en) 2015-08-05 2020-05-19 Ab Initio Technology Llc Selecting queries for execution on a stream of real-time data
US9633155B1 (en) * 2015-11-10 2017-04-25 International Business Machines Corporation Circuit modification
CN108475189B (en) 2015-12-21 2021-07-09 起元技术有限责任公司 Method, system and computer readable medium for sub-graph interface generation
US10073718B2 (en) 2016-01-15 2018-09-11 Intel Corporation Systems, methods and devices for determining work placement on processor cores
US9792975B1 (en) * 2016-06-23 2017-10-17 Mediatek Inc. Dram and access and operating method thereof
FR3053564B1 (en) * 2016-07-04 2018-07-27 Kerlink MODULAR COMMUNICATION DEVICE
FR3057086B1 (en) 2016-10-04 2018-11-23 Stmicroelectronics (Rousset) Sas METHOD FOR MANAGING UPDATING AT LEAST ONE MICROCODE WITHIN A PROCESSING UNIT, FOR EXAMPLE A MICROCONTROLLER, AND CORRESPONDING PROCESSING UNIT
US10020012B1 (en) 2017-10-31 2018-07-10 Seagate Technology Llc Data storage drive with low-latency ports coupling multiple servo control processors
JP6955163B2 (en) * 2017-12-26 2021-10-27 富士通株式会社 Information processing equipment, information processing methods and programs
US20210396354A1 (en) 2018-11-12 2021-12-23 Jfe Steel Corporation High-pressure hydrogen tank
US11841776B2 (en) * 2019-06-12 2023-12-12 Intel Corporation Single chip multi-die architecture having safety-compliant cross-monitoring capability
US20230175646A1 (en) 2020-04-20 2023-06-08 Jfe Steel Corporation High-pressure hydrogen container
CN113722770A (en) * 2021-08-18 2021-11-30 上海励驰半导体有限公司 End-to-end protection method and system based on hierarchical data integrity

Citations (7)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3555517A (en) * 1968-10-30 1971-01-12 Ibm Early error detection system for data processing machine
US3768074A (en) * 1972-05-12 1973-10-23 Burroughs Corp Multiprocessing system having means for permissive coupling of different subsystems
US3810120A (en) * 1971-02-12 1974-05-07 Honeywell Inf Systems Automatic deactivation device
US3882460A (en) * 1973-11-02 1975-05-06 Burroughs Corp Serial transfer error detection logic
US4012717A (en) * 1972-04-24 1977-03-15 Compagnie Internationale Pour L'informatique Bi-processor data handling system including automatic control of exchanges with external equipment and automatically activated maintenance operation
US4020459A (en) * 1975-10-28 1977-04-26 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated Parity generation and bus matching arrangement for synchronized duplicated data processing units
US4051355A (en) * 1976-04-29 1977-09-27 Ncr Corporation Apparatus and method for increasing the efficiency of random access storage

Family Cites Families (83)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3059221A (en) * 1956-12-03 1962-10-16 Rca Corp Information storage and transfer system
NL297037A (en) * 1962-08-23
US3303474A (en) * 1963-01-17 1967-02-07 Rca Corp Duplexing system for controlling online and standby conditions of two computers
US3292156A (en) * 1963-05-28 1966-12-13 Bell Telephone Labor Inc Data signal storage circuit
US3400372A (en) * 1965-02-16 1968-09-03 Ibm Terminal for a multi-data processing system
US3480914A (en) * 1967-01-03 1969-11-25 Ibm Control mechanism for a multi-processor computing system
DE1549397B2 (en) * 1967-06-16 1972-09-14 Chemische Werke Hüls AG, 4370 Mari PROCEDURE FOR THE AUTOMATIC CONTROL OF CHEMICAL PLANTS
US3581286A (en) * 1969-01-13 1971-05-25 Ibm Module switching apparatus with status sensing and dynamic sharing of modules
US3641505A (en) * 1969-06-25 1972-02-08 Bell Telephone Labor Inc Multiprocessor computer adapted for partitioning into a plurality of independently operating systems
US3623014A (en) * 1969-08-25 1971-11-23 Control Data Corp Computer communications system
US3577185A (en) * 1969-10-02 1971-05-04 Ibm On-line system for measuring the efficiency of replacement algorithms
US3710324A (en) * 1970-04-01 1973-01-09 Digital Equipment Corp Data processing system
JPS513463B1 (en) * 1970-09-25 1976-02-03
DE2108836A1 (en) * 1971-02-25 1972-09-07 Licentia Gmbh Arrangement for a dual computer system
US3725864A (en) * 1971-03-03 1973-04-03 Ibm Input/output control
GB1394431A (en) * 1971-06-24 1975-05-14 Plessey Co Ltd Multiprocessor data processing system
US3786427A (en) * 1971-06-29 1974-01-15 Ibm Dynamic address translation reversed
US3749845A (en) * 1971-08-27 1973-07-31 Bell Telephone Labor Inc Digital data communication system
JPS5147298B2 (en) * 1971-08-30 1976-12-14
US3749897A (en) * 1971-09-03 1973-07-31 Collins Radio Co System failure monitor title
GB1412246A (en) * 1971-09-29 1975-10-29 Kent Automation Systems Ltd Computer control arrangements
US3820079A (en) * 1971-11-01 1974-06-25 Hewlett Packard Co Bus oriented,modular,multiprocessing computer
JPS5147502B2 (en) * 1971-12-29 1976-12-15
US3810114A (en) * 1971-12-29 1974-05-07 Tokyo Shibaura Electric Co Data processing system
US3753234A (en) * 1972-02-25 1973-08-14 Reliance Electric Co Multicomputer system with simultaneous data interchange between computers
FR2176279A5 (en) * 1972-03-17 1973-10-26 Materiel Telephonique
JPS553735B2 (en) * 1972-03-29 1980-01-26
GB1434186A (en) * 1972-04-26 1976-05-05 Gen Electric Co Ltd Multiprocessor computer systems
JPS4965103U (en) * 1972-09-20 1974-06-07
IT971304B (en) * 1972-11-29 1974-04-30 Honeywell Inf Systems DYNAMICALLY VARIABLE PRIORITY ACCESS SYSTEM
JPS566015B2 (en) * 1972-12-12 1981-02-09
US3827030A (en) * 1973-01-29 1974-07-30 Gulf & Western Industries Programmable controller using a random access memory
JPS5633435B2 (en) * 1973-02-21 1981-08-04
JPS49114845A (en) * 1973-02-28 1974-11-01
US3828321A (en) * 1973-03-15 1974-08-06 Gte Automatic Electric Lab Inc System for reconfiguring central processor and instruction storage combinations
JPS532296B2 (en) * 1973-03-19 1978-01-26
US3893084A (en) * 1973-05-01 1975-07-01 Digital Equipment Corp Memory access control system
US3859638A (en) * 1973-05-31 1975-01-07 Intersil Inc Non-volatile memory unit with automatic standby power supply
US3836891A (en) * 1973-07-05 1974-09-17 Bendix Corp Tape reader system with buffer memory
US3905023A (en) * 1973-08-15 1975-09-09 Burroughs Corp Large scale multi-level information processing system employing improved failsaft techniques
US3921141A (en) * 1973-09-14 1975-11-18 Gte Automatic Electric Lab Inc Malfunction monitor control circuitry for central data processor of digital communication system
CA1026850A (en) * 1973-09-24 1978-02-21 Smiths Industries Limited Dual, simultaneously operating control system with fault detection
US3886524A (en) * 1973-10-18 1975-05-27 Texas Instruments Inc Asynchronous communication bus
US4099241A (en) * 1973-10-30 1978-07-04 Telefonaktiebolaget L M Ericsson Apparatus for facilitating a cooperation between an executive computer and a reserve computer
JPS5324261B2 (en) * 1973-11-20 1978-07-19
FR2258112A5 (en) * 1973-11-30 1975-08-08 Honeywell Bull Soc Ind
GB1474385A (en) * 1973-12-14 1977-05-25 Int Computers Ltd Multiprocessor data processing systems
GB1481393A (en) * 1974-02-28 1977-07-27 Burroughs Corp Information processing systems
JPS5812608B2 (en) * 1974-03-05 1983-03-09 日本電気株式会社 Denshikei Sanki System
JPS50133738A (en) * 1974-04-08 1975-10-23
JPS537332B2 (en) * 1974-04-22 1978-03-16
US4040026A (en) * 1974-05-08 1977-08-02 Francois Gernelle Channel for exchanging information between a computer and rapid peripheral units
FR2273317B1 (en) * 1974-05-28 1976-10-15 Philips Electrologica
US4004277A (en) * 1974-05-29 1977-01-18 Gavril Bruce D Switching system for non-symmetrical sharing of computer peripheral equipment
US4130865A (en) * 1974-06-05 1978-12-19 Bolt Beranek And Newman Inc. Multiprocessor computer apparatus employing distributed communications paths and a passive task register
GB1510464A (en) * 1974-06-24 1978-05-10 Shell Int Research N,n-disubstituted amino-acid derivatives and their use as herbicides
JPS5438844B2 (en) * 1974-07-19 1979-11-24
US3908099A (en) * 1974-09-27 1975-09-23 Gte Automatic Electric Lab Inc Fault detection system for a telephone exchange
GB1505535A (en) * 1974-10-30 1978-03-30 Motorola Inc Microprocessor system
US4050096A (en) * 1974-10-30 1977-09-20 Motorola, Inc. Pulse expanding system for microprocessor systems with slow memory
US4004283A (en) * 1974-10-30 1977-01-18 Motorola, Inc. Multiple interrupt microprocessor system
US3919533A (en) * 1974-11-08 1975-11-11 Westinghouse Electric Corp Electrical fault indicator
JPS564936B2 (en) * 1974-12-02 1981-02-02
JPS5169308A (en) * 1974-12-13 1976-06-15 Hitachi Ltd BOORINGUHOSHIKI
US4009470A (en) * 1975-02-18 1977-02-22 Sperry Rand Corporation Pre-emptive, rotational priority system
US4006466A (en) * 1975-03-26 1977-02-01 Honeywell Information Systems, Inc. Programmable interface apparatus and method
US3991407A (en) * 1975-04-09 1976-11-09 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Computer redundancy interface
NL165859C (en) * 1975-04-25 1981-05-15 Philips Nv STATION FOR TRANSFER OF INFORMATION.
CH584488A5 (en) * 1975-05-05 1977-01-31 Ibm
US4015243A (en) * 1975-06-02 1977-03-29 Kurpanek Horst G Multi-processing computer system
US3995258A (en) * 1975-06-30 1976-11-30 Honeywell Information Systems, Inc. Data processing system having a data integrity technique
US4001790A (en) * 1975-06-30 1977-01-04 Honeywell Information Systems, Inc. Modularly addressable units coupled in a data processing system over a common bus
US4034347A (en) * 1975-08-08 1977-07-05 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated Method and apparatus for controlling a multiprocessor system
US4034794A (en) * 1975-10-31 1977-07-12 Nalco Chemical Company Casting process with lignosulfonate-humate-graphite mold coatings
US4038644A (en) * 1975-11-19 1977-07-26 Ncr Corporation Destination selection apparatus for a bus oriented computer system
US4014005A (en) * 1976-01-05 1977-03-22 International Business Machines Corporation Configuration and control unit for a heterogeneous multi-system
US4048672A (en) * 1976-01-05 1977-09-13 T-Bar Incorporated Switch matrix control and display
US4067059A (en) * 1976-01-29 1978-01-03 Sperry Rand Corporation Shared direct memory access controller
US4041472A (en) * 1976-04-29 1977-08-09 Ncr Corporation Data processing internal communications system having plural time-shared intercommunication buses and inter-bus communication means
US4038642A (en) * 1976-04-30 1977-07-26 International Business Machines Corporation Input/output interface logic for concurrent operations
US4042911A (en) * 1976-04-30 1977-08-16 International Business Machines Corporation Outer and asynchronous storage extension system
US4059851A (en) * 1976-07-12 1977-11-22 Ncr Corporation Priority network for devices coupled by a common bus
US4089052A (en) * 1976-12-13 1978-05-09 Data General Corporation Data processing system

Patent Citations (7)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3555517A (en) * 1968-10-30 1971-01-12 Ibm Early error detection system for data processing machine
US3810120A (en) * 1971-02-12 1974-05-07 Honeywell Inf Systems Automatic deactivation device
US4012717A (en) * 1972-04-24 1977-03-15 Compagnie Internationale Pour L'informatique Bi-processor data handling system including automatic control of exchanges with external equipment and automatically activated maintenance operation
US3768074A (en) * 1972-05-12 1973-10-23 Burroughs Corp Multiprocessing system having means for permissive coupling of different subsystems
US3882460A (en) * 1973-11-02 1975-05-06 Burroughs Corp Serial transfer error detection logic
US4020459A (en) * 1975-10-28 1977-04-26 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Incorporated Parity generation and bus matching arrangement for synchronized duplicated data processing units
US4051355A (en) * 1976-04-29 1977-09-27 Ncr Corporation Apparatus and method for increasing the efficiency of random access storage

Cited By (87)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5603049A (en) * 1981-01-05 1997-02-11 Texas Instruments Incorporated Bus system servicing plural module requestors with module access identification known to system user
US4872106A (en) * 1983-04-06 1989-10-03 New Forney Corp. Industrial process control system with back-up data processors to take over from failed primary data processors
US5157595A (en) * 1985-07-19 1992-10-20 El Paso Technologies, Company Distributed logic control system and method
US4885699A (en) * 1986-12-26 1989-12-05 Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba Data processing apparatus for editing, filing, and printing image data by means of visual observation of the data on a display screen
US5136500A (en) * 1987-02-27 1992-08-04 Honeywell Information Systems Inc. Multiple shared memory arrangement wherein multiple processors individually and concurrently access any one of plural memories
US4855899A (en) * 1987-04-13 1989-08-08 Prime Computer, Inc. Multiple I/O bus virtual broadcast of programmed I/O instructions
US5023774A (en) * 1987-11-13 1991-06-11 Hitachi Software Engineering Co., Ltd. Data I/O transaction method and system
US5287483A (en) * 1988-07-06 1994-02-15 Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba Prefetched operand storing system for an information processor
US5303351A (en) * 1988-12-30 1994-04-12 International Business Machines Corporation Error recovery in a multiple 170 channel computer system
US5097410A (en) * 1988-12-30 1992-03-17 International Business Machines Corporation Multimode data system for transferring control and data information in an i/o subsystem
US5548743A (en) * 1990-05-18 1996-08-20 Fujitsu Limited Data processing system with duplex common memory having physical and logical path disconnection upon failure
US5568609A (en) * 1990-05-18 1996-10-22 Fujitsu Limited Data processing system with path disconnection and memory access failure recognition
US5471586A (en) * 1992-09-22 1995-11-28 Unisys Corporation Interface system having plurality of channels and associated independent controllers for transferring data between shared buffer and peripheral devices independently
US5434997A (en) * 1992-10-02 1995-07-18 Compaq Computer Corp. Method and apparatus for testing and debugging a tightly coupled mirrored processing system
US5717852A (en) * 1993-03-10 1998-02-10 Hitachi, Ltd. Multiple bus control method and a system thereof
US5784394A (en) * 1996-11-15 1998-07-21 International Business Machines Corporation Method and system for implementing parity error recovery schemes in a data processing system
US6330701B1 (en) * 1997-12-10 2001-12-11 Telefonaktiebolaget Lm Ericsson (Publ) Method relating to processors, and processors adapted to function in accordance with the method
US6594735B1 (en) 1998-12-28 2003-07-15 Nortel Networks Limited High availability computing system
US6807514B2 (en) * 2000-07-27 2004-10-19 Infineon Technologies Ag Apparatus for monitoring the proper operation of components of an electrical system carrying out the same or mutually corresponding actions
US20040244011A1 (en) * 2000-11-30 2004-12-02 Microsoft Corporation Operating system event tracker
US7818754B2 (en) * 2000-11-30 2010-10-19 Microsoft Corporation Operating system event tracking and logging
US7177267B2 (en) * 2001-11-09 2007-02-13 Adc Dsl Systems, Inc. Hardware monitoring and configuration management
US20030091002A1 (en) * 2001-11-09 2003-05-15 Adc Dsl Systems, Inc. Hardware controller and monitor
DE10249592A1 (en) * 2002-10-24 2004-06-17 Abb Research Ltd. Fail-silent data processing node configuration design for a replicated data network, whereby each partial node only transmits if all other partial nodes transmit at the same time
US20040230861A1 (en) * 2003-05-15 2004-11-18 International Business Machines Corporation Autonomic recovery from hardware errors in an input/output fabric
US7134052B2 (en) * 2003-05-15 2006-11-07 International Business Machines Corporation Autonomic recovery from hardware errors in an input/output fabric
US7549090B2 (en) 2003-05-15 2009-06-16 International Business Machines Corporation Autonomic recovery from hardware errors in an input/output fabric
US20060279264A1 (en) * 2005-03-31 2006-12-14 O2Micro International Limited Method Circuitry and Electronic Device for Controlling a Variable Output DC Power Source
US20070050672A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Power consumption management
US7739524B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2010-06-15 The Invention Science Fund I, Inc Power consumption management
US20070050558A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Bran Ferren Multiprocessor resource optimization
US20070050660A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Handling processor computational errors
US20070050556A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Multiprocessor resource optimization
US20070050659A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Hardware-error tolerant computing
US20070050581A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Power sparing synchronous apparatus
US20070050661A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Bran Ferren Adjusting a processor operating parameter based on a performance criterion
US20070050609A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc Cross-architecture execution optimization
US20070050604A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Fetch rerouting in response to an execution-based optimization profile
US20070050775A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Processor resource management
US20070050606A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Runtime-based optimization profile
US20070050605A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Bran Ferren Freeze-dried ghost pages
US20070050776A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Predictive processor resource management
US20070050607A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Bran Ferren Alteration of execution of a program in response to an execution-optimization information
US20070055848A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-08 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Processor resource management
US20070067611A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-22 Bran Ferren Processor resource management
US7493516B2 (en) * 2005-08-29 2009-02-17 Searete Llc Hardware-error tolerant computing
US9274582B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2016-03-01 Invention Science Fund I, Llc Power consumption management
US7512842B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2009-03-31 Searete Llc Multi-voltage synchronous systems
US20090132853A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2009-05-21 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Hardware-error tolerant computing
US7539852B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2009-05-26 Searete, Llc Processor resource management
US20090150713A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2009-06-11 William Henry Mangione-Smith Multi-voltage synchronous systems
US20070050608A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporatin Of The State Of Delaware Hardware-generated and historically-based execution optimization
US7607042B2 (en) * 2005-08-29 2009-10-20 Searete, Llc Adjusting a processor operating parameter based on a performance criterion
US7627739B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2009-12-01 Searete, Llc Optimization of a hardware resource shared by a multiprocessor
US7647487B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2010-01-12 Searete, Llc Instruction-associated processor resource optimization
US7653834B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2010-01-26 Searete, Llc Power sparing synchronous apparatus
US7725693B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2010-05-25 Searete, Llc Execution optimization using a processor resource management policy saved in an association with an instruction group
US20070050555A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Multiprocessor resource optimization
US8516300B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2013-08-20 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Multi-votage synchronous systems
US7774558B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2010-08-10 The Invention Science Fund I, Inc Multiprocessor resource optimization
US7779213B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2010-08-17 The Invention Science Fund I, Inc Optimization of instruction group execution through hardware resource management policies
US20100228402A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2010-09-09 William Henry Mangione-Smith Power sparing synchronous apparatus
US20070050582A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2007-03-01 Searete Llc, A Limited Liability Corporation Of The State Of Delaware Multi-voltage synchronous systems
US20100318818A1 (en) * 2005-08-29 2010-12-16 William Henry Mangione-Smith Power consumption management
US7877584B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2011-01-25 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Predictive processor resource management
US8051255B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2011-11-01 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Multiprocessor resource optimization
US8181004B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2012-05-15 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Selecting a resource management policy for a resource available to a processor
US8209524B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2012-06-26 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Cross-architecture optimization
US8214191B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2012-07-03 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Cross-architecture execution optimization
US8423824B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2013-04-16 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Power sparing synchronous apparatus
US8255745B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2012-08-28 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Hardware-error tolerant computing
US8375247B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2013-02-12 The Invention Science Fund I, Llc Handling processor computational errors
US8402257B2 (en) 2005-08-29 2013-03-19 The Invention Science Fund I, PLLC Alteration of execution of a program in response to an execution-optimization information
US20090076628A1 (en) * 2007-09-18 2009-03-19 David Mark Smith Methods and apparatus to upgrade and provide control redundancy in process plants
US20100174967A1 (en) * 2009-01-07 2010-07-08 Hitachi, Ltd. Control apparatus and control method
US8255769B2 (en) * 2009-01-07 2012-08-28 Hitachi, Ltd. Control apparatus and control method
US8443230B1 (en) * 2010-12-15 2013-05-14 Xilinx, Inc. Methods and systems with transaction-level lockstep
CN105518547A (en) * 2013-09-10 2016-04-20 施耐德电器工业公司 Automation system
WO2015036338A1 (en) 2013-09-10 2015-03-19 Schneider Electric Industries Sas Automation system
FR3010540A1 (en) * 2013-09-10 2015-03-13 Schneider Electric Ind Sas AUTOMATION SYSTEM COMPRISING MULTIPLE PROGRAMMABLE LOGIC CONTROLLERS CONNECTED ON A COMMUNICATION NETWORK
CN105518547B (en) * 2013-09-10 2018-07-20 施耐德电器工业公司 Automated system
US10310469B2 (en) 2013-09-10 2019-06-04 Schneider Electric Industries Sas Automation system
US20170345233A1 (en) * 2016-05-25 2017-11-30 Caterpillar Inc. Model generation and monitoring system for a machine
US9984182B2 (en) * 2016-05-25 2018-05-29 Caterpillar Inc. Model generation system for a machine
US10008052B2 (en) * 2016-05-25 2018-06-26 Caterpillar Inc. Model generation and monitoring system for a machine
US10528413B2 (en) 2017-04-03 2020-01-07 Intel Corporation Criticality-based error detection
CN111274237A (en) * 2020-01-20 2020-06-12 重庆亚德科技股份有限公司 Medical data checking and correcting system and method

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
HK62481A (en) 1981-12-17
GB1588805A (en) 1981-04-29
JPS60100254A (en) 1985-06-04
US4672535A (en) 1987-06-09
JPS60100256A (en) 1985-06-04
FR2485228B1 (en) 1985-11-29
MY8200206A (en) 1982-12-31
JPS6120016B2 (en) 1986-05-20
FR2547082A1 (en) 1984-12-07
US4807116A (en) 1989-02-21
JPS61286962A (en) 1986-12-17
US4639864A (en) 1987-01-27
JPS6122335B2 (en) 1986-05-31
JPS60100257A (en) 1985-06-04
DE2740056A1 (en) 1978-03-16
JPS6120018B2 (en) 1986-05-20
JPS6120017B2 (en) 1986-05-20
FR2473197A1 (en) 1981-07-10
US4817091A (en) 1989-03-28
MY8200205A (en) 1982-12-31
FR2485227A1 (en) 1981-12-24
FR2485227B1 (en) 1985-11-29
US4378588A (en) 1983-03-29
JPS60100258A (en) 1985-06-04
GB1588803A (en) 1981-04-29
DE2740056C2 (en) 1992-03-19
JPS6122336B2 (en) 1986-05-31
GB1588804A (en) 1981-04-29
FR2473197B1 (en) 1985-12-13
MY8200208A (en) 1982-12-31
US4356550A (en) 1982-10-26
JPS5850062A (en) 1983-03-24
US4484275A (en) 1984-11-20
US4365295A (en) 1982-12-21
FR2485228A1 (en) 1981-12-24
HK62381A (en) 1981-12-24
HK62281A (en) 1981-12-24
JPS60100255A (en) 1985-06-04
JPS5925257B2 (en) 1984-06-15
MY8200207A (en) 1982-12-31
GB1588806A (en) 1981-04-29
JPS5333027A (en) 1978-03-28
JPS60100253A (en) 1985-06-04
BE892627Q (en) 1982-07-16
MY8200209A (en) 1982-12-31
US4228496A (en) 1980-10-14
JPS6129028B2 (en) 1986-07-03
CA1121481A (en) 1982-04-06
JPS6124740B2 (en) 1986-06-12
HK62581A (en) 1981-12-24
GB1588807A (en) 1981-04-29
JPS6218951B2 (en) 1987-04-25
JPS60100252A (en) 1985-06-04
HK62681A (en) 1981-12-24

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US4672537A (en) Data error detection and device controller failure detection in an input/output system
US4099234A (en) Input/output processing system utilizing locked processors
US6505305B1 (en) Fail-over of multiple memory blocks in multiple memory modules in computer system
EP0422103B1 (en) I/o bus to system bus interface
EP0099620B1 (en) Memory controller with data rotation arrangement
GB1595438A (en) Computer input/output system with memory selection
US7143206B2 (en) Method for controlling data transfer unit having channel control unit, storage device control unit, and DMA processor
JPS63208151A (en) Interface between processor of digital data processing system and special instruction processor
CA1147824A (en) Multiprocessor with stress responsive buffer
CA1147474A (en) Memory system in a multiprocessor system
CA1137582A (en) Multiprocessor system
CA1147417A (en) Multiprocessor polling system
CA1176338A (en) Input/output system for a multiprocessor system
CA1135809A (en) Multiprocessor system
CA1136728A (en) Multiprocessor system
JP2001007893A (en) Information processing system and fault processing system used for it
CA1142619A (en) Multiprocessor system
JP3141948B2 (en) Computer system
CA1185670A (en) Multiprocessor system
CA1336459C (en) I/o bus to system bus interface
JPH01191248A (en) Error retry system of channel controller

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCF Information on status: patent grant

Free format text: PATENTED CASE

FEPP Fee payment procedure

Free format text: PAYOR NUMBER ASSIGNED (ORIGINAL EVENT CODE: ASPN); ENTITY STATUS OF PATENT OWNER: LARGE ENTITY

FPAY Fee payment

Year of fee payment: 4

FPAY Fee payment

Year of fee payment: 8

FPAY Fee payment

Year of fee payment: 12